PG Music Band in a Box - 2010.5 (Macintosh) User Guide

Add to my manuals
307 Pages

advertisement

PG Music Band in a Box - 2010.5 (Macintosh) User Guide | Manualzz
®
Version 2010.5 for Macintosh
©Copyright 1989-2010 PG Music Inc. All rights reserved.
PG Music Inc. License Agreement
CAREFULLY READ THE FOLLOWING TERMS AND CONDITIONS BEFORE COMPLETING THE
INSTALLATION OF THIS SOFTWARE. USAGE OF THE SOFTWARE INDICATES YOUR ACCEPTANCE
OF THE FOLLOWING TERMS AND CONDITIONS.
LICENSE
A. The program may only be used on a single machine.
B. You may transfer the program and license to another party if the other party agrees to accept the terms of
this Agreement. If you transfer the program, you must either transfer all copies, whether in printed or
machine readable form, to the same party, or, destroy all copies not transferred. This includes all
modifications and/or portions of the program merged into other programs.
C. You may receive the program in more than one media. Regardless of the type or size of media you receive,
you may install or use the media on a single machine.
D. The program (including any images, “applets,” photographs, animations, video, audio, music, and text
incorporated into the program) is owned by PG Music Inc. or its suppliers, and is protected by international
copyright laws and international treaty provisions.
You may not use, copy, or transfer the program, or any copy, modification or merged portion of the program, in
whole or in part, except as expressly provided for in this license. If you transfer possession of any copy,
modification or merged portion of the program to another party, your license is automatically terminated.
LIMITATION OF REMEDIES
PG Music Inc.’s entire liability and your exclusive remedy shall be:
A. The replacement of any media not meeting PG Music Inc.’s “Limited Warranty,” which are returned to PG
Music Inc., or an authorized PG Music Inc. dealer, with a copy of your receipt.
B. If PG Music Inc. or the authorized dealer is unable to deliver replacement media that is free of defects in
materials or workmanship, you may terminate this agreement, and your money will be refunded.
In no event will PG Music Inc. be liable to you for any damages, including but not limited to lost profits, lost
savings, or other incidental or consequential damages arising out of the use or the inability to use such program,
even if PG Music Inc. or an authorized PG Music Inc. dealer has been advised of the possibility of such damages, or
for any claim by any other party.
TRADEMARKS
Band-in-a-Box®, CloudTracks™, CopyMe®, GuitarStar®, JazzU®, PG Music®, PowerTracks Pro®, RealBand®,
RealDrums®, RealSolos®, and RealTracks® are either the trademarks or registered trademarks of PG Music Inc. in
the United States, Canada, and other countries. Microsoft® and Windows® are either registered trademarks or
trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. Apple®, the Apple logo,
Leopard®, Macintosh®, Mac®, Panther®, Power Mac®, QuickTime®, Snow Leopard®, Tiger®, and TrueType®
are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. IBM® is the registered
trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. Roland® and “Roland” Logo, EDIROL® and
“EDIROL” Logo, GS® and “GS” Logo, are registered trademarks and “MIDI2” Logo, EDIROL Virtual Sound
Canvas Multi Pack, VSC-MP1™ are trademarks of Roland Corporation. ASIO is a trademark and software of
Steinberg Media Technologies GmbH. VST is a trademark of Steinberg Media Technologies GmbH. Other brands
and their products are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective holders and should be noted as such.
PATENTS
Band-in-a-Box is protected under US Patent 5990407. The TC-Helicon Harmony feature in Band-in-a-Box and
PowerTracks Pro Audio is protected under US Patents 5567901, 5641926, 5986198, 34583, 296.80.173.9,
PI9603819.5, 0368046, 0750776, 6,046,395, and patents pending.
Printed in Canada
2
PG Music Inc. License Agreement
Table of Contents
PG Music Inc. License Agreement .............................................................................................. 2
Table of Contents .......................................................................................................................... 3
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box! ..................................................................................... 6
What is Band-in-a-Box?.................................................................................................................................................... 6
System Requirements........................................................................................................................................................ 7
Installation ........................................................................................................................................................................ 7
Setup ................................................................................................................................................................................. 8
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial................................................................................................. 13
Step 1 – Enter the Chords ............................................................................................................................................... 13
Step 2 – Choose a Style................................................................................................................................................... 15
Step 3 – Play your song! ................................................................................................................................................. 16
More fun with Band-in-a-Box......................................................................................................................................... 17
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh..................................................................... 18
Welcome to Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 ................................................................................................................................ 18
New Features in Band-in-a-Box 2010............................................................................................................................. 19
More New RealTracks .................................................................................................................................................... 20
QuickStart Tutorial ......................................................................................................................................................... 21
Quick Song Settings........................................................................................................................................................ 21
Save Default Mix ............................................................................................................................................................ 21
Improved Audio Rendering............................................................................................................................................. 21
DAW Plug-in Mode ........................................................................................................................................................ 22
Freeze Tracks.................................................................................................................................................................. 22
RealTracks Enhancements .............................................................................................................................................. 24
New Favorite Songs/Styles Dialog ................................................................................................................................. 28
Rendering Tracks ............................................................................................................................................................ 29
StylePicker Enhancements.............................................................................................................................................. 29
New in the StyleMaker ................................................................................................................................................... 30
Chapter 4: The Main Screen..................................................................................................... 31
Main Screen Overview.................................................................................................................................................... 31
Status Bar........................................................................................................................................................................ 32
Synth Window / Piano Keyboard.................................................................................................................................... 32
Toolbars .......................................................................................................................................................................... 35
Title Window .................................................................................................................................................................. 38
Chordsheet Area.............................................................................................................................................................. 40
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box .............................................................................. 43
Loading and Playing Songs............................................................................................................................................. 43
View and Print Notation ................................................................................................................................................. 55
Play the Jukebox ............................................................................................................................................................. 59
Automatic Songs - “The Melodist”................................................................................................................................. 59
Make Your Own Songs................................................................................................................................................... 61
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide.................................................................................... 69
RealTracks ...................................................................................................................................................................... 69
RealDrums ...................................................................................................................................................................... 78
Table of Contents
3
Song Settings .................................................................................................................................................................. 85
The Chordsheet ............................................................................................................................................................... 89
Chord Preview/Builder ................................................................................................................................................. 101
MIDI file “Chord Wizard” ............................................................................................................................................ 103
Applying Styles............................................................................................................................................................. 104
The StylePicker............................................................................................................................................................. 106
Playing, Pausing, and Stopping Songs .......................................................................................................................... 111
Changing Volume, Panning, Reverb, Chorus, Bank ..................................................................................................... 112
Freeze Tracks................................................................................................................................................................ 113
Saving Songs................................................................................................................................................................. 115
Preferences – User Settings........................................................................................................................................... 117
Other Editing Features .................................................................................................................................................. 128
MIDI Setup ................................................................................................................................................................... 130
The JukeBox ................................................................................................................................................................. 135
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing ........................................................................................... 137
Notation ........................................................................................................................................................................ 137
Printing ......................................................................................................................................................................... 145
Printing ......................................................................................................................................................................... 147
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features.................................................................................... 149
Automatic Songs - “The Melodist”............................................................................................................................... 149
Automatic Solo Generation – “The Soloist” ................................................................................................................. 155
Automatic Guitar Chord Solos – “The Guitarist” ......................................................................................................... 159
Melody Embellisher...................................................................................................................................................... 164
The Reharmonist........................................................................................................................................................... 169
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks .................................................................................................. 172
Real Time Recording .................................................................................................................................................... 172
Step Edit Notes ............................................................................................................................................................. 174
Entering Notes Manually in the Notation Window ....................................................................................................... 175
Recording with the Wizard Feature .............................................................................................................................. 175
Importing Pre-Recorded MIDI Data ............................................................................................................................. 175
Record using The Melodist ........................................................................................................................................... 176
Additional Options for Melody/Soloist Track............................................................................................................... 177
Chapter 10: Audio Features..................................................................................................... 179
RealTracks and RealDrums........................................................................................................................................... 179
Render MIDI Track to AIFF File.................................................................................................................................. 180
Rendering Audio Files .................................................................................................................................................. 180
Audio Reverb Control................................................................................................................................................... 181
Reverb Settings ............................................................................................................................................................. 182
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun................................................................................... 185
The Wizard ................................................................................................................................................................... 185
Audio Chord Wizard (“Chords from MP4”) ................................................................................................................. 186
MIDI File Chord Interpretation Wizard ........................................................................................................................ 196
The Reharmonist........................................................................................................................................................... 202
Chord Breaks ................................................................................................................................................................ 204
The Guitarist ................................................................................................................................................................. 205
Guitar Tutor .................................................................................................................................................................. 208
Chord Substitution Wizard............................................................................................................................................ 209
4
Table of Contents
Chord Builder ............................................................................................................................................................... 213
Animated Drum Kit ...................................................................................................................................................... 213
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions .......................................................................... 218
The StyleMaker............................................................................................................................................................. 218
The Harmony Maker..................................................................................................................................................... 240
The Soloist Maker......................................................................................................................................................... 243
The Melodist Maker...................................................................................................................................................... 245
The Guitarist Maker...................................................................................................................................................... 249
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth ...................................................................... 253
CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth Tutorial.................................................................................................................... 253
Chapter 14: Reference.............................................................................................................. 258
File Menu...................................................................................................................................................................... 259
Edit Menu ..................................................................................................................................................................... 262
Song Menu.................................................................................................................................................................... 264
Styles Menu .................................................................................................................................................................. 268
User Menu .................................................................................................................................................................... 269
Melody Menu................................................................................................................................................................ 271
Soloist Menu ................................................................................................................................................................. 276
Harmony Menu ............................................................................................................................................................. 280
MIDI Menu ................................................................................................................................................................... 281
GS Menu ....................................................................................................................................................................... 289
Windows Menu............................................................................................................................................................. 291
Help Menu .................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Keystroke Commands – “Hot Keys” ............................................................................................................................ 292
Chord List ..................................................................................................................................................................... 295
Files and Folders ........................................................................................................................................................... 296
PG Music Inc. ............................................................................................................................ 299
Index........................................................................................................................................... 300
Registration Form..................................................................................................................... 307
How to Register ............................................................................................................................................................ 307
5
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
Congratulations on your purchase of Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh, the favorite of musicians, students, and
songwriters everywhere. Get ready to have fun!
What is Band-in-a-Box?
Band-in-a-Box is an intelligent automatic accompaniment program for your multimedia
computer.
You can hear and play along to many song ideas and go from “nothing” to “something” in a
very short period of time with Band-in-a-Box as your “on demand” backup band.
Band-in-a-Box is so easy to use!
Just type in the chords for any song using standard chord symbols (like C, Fm7, or C13b9), choose the style you’d
like, and Band-in-a-Box does the rest, automatically generating a complete professional-quality arrangement of
piano, bass, drums, guitar, and strings or horns in a wide variety of popular styles plus optional live audio tracks
with RealDrums and RealTracks.
Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh introduces exciting new features like RealDrums, RealTracks and the
amazing Audio Chord Wizard!
First of all, this new version is designed for the MacIntel machines, not the older PowerPC Macs. This means that
the program is running directly on the Intel chip, instead of emulation mode, which speeds up operations.
We've added RealTracks - audio instruments that replace the MIDI track with actual recordings of top studio
Jazz/Rock/Country musicians! These are not “samples” of single instrument hits; they are full recordings, lasting
from 1 to 8 bars at a time, playing along in perfect sync with the other Band-in-a-Box tracks. We have a huge
library of over 170 RealTracks available, including lots of Jazz, Rock, Blues, Country, Folk and Bluegrass styles.
Best of all, you use these instruments like regular styles.
By simply choosing a RealStyle, you will hear your new or existing songs played by real instruments, with a
dramatic improvement in sound and musicality. For example, choose a Country MIDI style that includes
RealPedalSteel, and you will now hear a studio pedal steel player, exactly as if he was in the room with you. To
hear the differences, listen to the audio demos of RealTracks at www.pgmusic.com.
Many of the RealTracks have RealCharts; this allows you to see notation and correct guitar tab/fretboard display, a
great help for learning to play from the masters performing on the RealTracks.
And we've added RealDrums - audio drum styles that replace the MIDI Drum track with actual recordings of top
studio Jazz/Rock/Country drummers! Again, these are not “samples” of single drum hits; they are full recordings,
lasting from 1 to 8 bars at a time, playing along in perfect sync with the other Band-in-a-Box tracks. Hundreds of
RealDrums styles are available.
And we've added an amazing “Chords from MP4” feature (Audio Chord Wizard). This amazing feature
automatically figures out the chords from any AIFF, MP4, M4A, or other audio file, and displays them in Bandin-a-Box. Just load in any audio file and you’ll instantly see the chords in Band-in-a-Box. The Audio Wizard also
figures out tempo, bar lines, key and fine-tuning from the audio file.
With the new Direct Render to Disk feature, you can save your files directly as audio files (AIFF, M4A, WAV),
for use in other programs (GarageBand, Cubase, etc.), or in Internet formats.
And much more …
People familiar with the previous versions of Band-in-a-Box will be pleased to know that we have kept the same
functionality of our previous releases. The new features are optional and don't interfere with familiar methods of
using the program. All songs, styles etc. are completely compatible with previous versions, so that you can upgrade
without losing any of your existing work.
6
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
System Requirements
-
Mac OS X 10.4 or later.
Intel Processor.
512 MB RAM.
About 2.5 GB free hard disk space if you wish to install and run the Band-in-a-Box program from your internal
hard drive. 40 GB if you wish to install all the RealTracks and RealDrums audio files as well.
- 1024x768 or higher screen resolution recommended.
- Hard drive versions require an available USB port.
Installation
Band-in-a-Box is available on discs (CD-R and DVD-ROM) and for Internet download. Premium versions are
optionally available pre-installed on an external hard drive. The hard drive version includes installation files that
can also be installed to the Macintosh HD.
The Band-in-a-Box program installs by default to its own Band-in-a-Box folder inside the /Applications folder.
Unless there is an important reason to install it to a different location, we suggest that you accept the default
location.
The /Band-in-a-Box folder has a clean look with only one application file in the folder - Band-in-a-Box. The rest of
the files are in subfolders.
The folders include the Drums folder for RealDrums files and the RealTracks folder for RealTracks files. If either
of these folders is moved or the files are installed in a custom location, the new location must be entered in the
RealDrums Settings dialog or the RealTracks Settings dialog so that Band-in-a-Box knows where to find them.
The Preferences you set in the program are saved in the Preferences folder, and this folder also has a file named
Intrface_X86.BBW with all the program settings including MIDI and audio driver setup. If this file is removed to
the trash the program will open like a new installation the next time it runs. It will prompt for all of the initial setup
selections. This is useful as a “global reset” if there are system settings that have been changed by accident.
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
7
Band-in-a-Box External USB Hard Drive
Band-in-a-Box, RealTracks, and RealDrums are pre-installed on the portable hard drive. You have three basic
choices for how to run Band-in-a-Box.
1. Run Band-in-a-Box directly from hard drive.
You can run Band-in-a-Box directly from this hard drive, and not copy anything to your computer's internal
hard drive. (0 GB disk space required.)
To do this, first run the "Band-in-a-Box Setup" installer located on the root level of the hard drive. This will
install the PG Music fonts on your computer, necessary for viewing the Notation Window. You don't need to
select the option to install BIAB to your internal hard drive.
You can use Band-in-a-Box simply by double-clicking on the Band-in-a-Box application in the
\Applications\Band-in-a-Box folder on this hard drive. You can make an alias for it (Command+L) or add it to
the dock if you wish.
2. Install only the Band-in-a-Box program to your computer.
You can install Band-in-a-Box on your computer's hard drive, but leave the RealTracks and RealDrums on the
USB hard drive. (4 GB free disk space required.)
To do this, run the "Band-in-a-Box Setup" installer located on the root level of the hard drive, and select the
option to install BIAB to your internal hard drive. Band-in-a-Box will be installed to the /Applications/Bandin-a-Box folder. Note that you will need to specify a custom location in the RealTracks and RealDrums
Settings dialogs within Band-in-a-Box - that is, point to the 'Drums' and 'RealTracks' folders in the Band-in-aBox folder on the USB drive.
This choice is useful because it allows you to keep a backup of the factory Band-in-a-Box program files on the
USB drive, but save space on your Macintosh hard drive by not copying the 'real files'.
3. Install the full program with RealTracks and RealDrums to your computer.
You can install Band-in-a-Box, RealTracks, and RealDrums on your computer's hard drive, and leave the USB
hard drive entirely for backup. (About 80 GB free disk space required.)
To do this, run the "Band-in-a-Box Setup" installer located on the root level of the hard drive, and select the
option to install BIAB to your internal hard drive. Band-in-a-Box will be installed to the /Applications/Bandin-a-Box folder, like option #2.
You'll then need to copy the 'RealTracks' and 'Drums' folders manually from the USB drive. They aren't
installed automatically. Note that you only need to copy those two folders - 'Drums', and 'RealTracks' - nothing
else. The Band-in-a-Box Setup installer will have taken care of all the other files.
Note that copying the RealDrums and RealTracks to your Macintosh hard drive may take 60 minutes or longer to complete,
depending on how fast your computer is, and requires over 80 GB of free hard disk space.
Using the USB Hard Drive
When you plug the hard drive into a USB port, it should be mounted on your desktop automatically. Before
disconnecting the drive, make sure to “eject” it first. To do this, either drag the icon to the trash, or click on it and
press Command+E.
The hard drive may have a “Y” cable with two USB connectors on one end. The large connector is the main data
connector and needs to be plugged in. The smaller connector is for extra power, in case a single USB port on your
computer doesn't supply enough power for the drive. If you are having trouble with the drive, and you have another
empty USB port, plug that second cable in.
Setup
Band-in-a-Box automatically sets up to default settings that use the built-in Macintosh audio input and output, and
the Apple DLS Music Device as the General MIDI synthesizer. For many users, these settings do not need to
change.
For users with more elaborate setups and additional outboard audio or MIDI equipment, Band-in-a-Box offers the
ability to customize both audio and MIDI settings through the Apple Audio MIDI Setup dialog and through its own
dialogs.
MIDI and Audio Setup
The MIDI and audio settings for playing your music in Band-in-a-Box are made in the MIDI menu.
MIDI Settings
8
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
The first item in this menu is MIDI Settings, but they may not require any changes. We suggest that you start with
the default settings, and see the MIDI Setup section if you find that changes to MIDI channels, patches, volume
levels or effects levels are needed.
Apple Audio MIDI Setup
The MIDI | CoreMIDI Audio MIDI Setup menu item opens the Apple Audio MIDI Setup dialog, which controls the
system settings for audio and MIDI.
There are two separate windows for Audio Devices and MIDI Devices, selected by clicking on the one you want in
the bar at the top of the dialog.
Each window has its own Apple Help topic, which opens by clicking on the [?] button.
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
9
MIDI Drivers
Band-in-a-Box automatically detects the MIDI drivers installed in your system. The MIDI | **Select MIDI Driver
or Apple DLS Synth menu command opens the MIDI Drivers dialog, which lists the drivers that have been detected.
Selecting “Apple DLS Synth” plays your MIDI tracks through the high quality built-in Apple DLS Music Device, or
software synthesizer. No special configuration should be necessary.
“MacOS X CoreMIDI” lets you configure a custom setup with other software synths or external MIDI devices.
The CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth chapter gives detailed instructions for your MIDI setup.
Click on [MIDI Drivers Help] to go to the tutorial.
Select Ports / Instruments
When Mac OS X CoreMIDI has been selected in the MIDI Drivers dialog (MIDI | **Select MIDI Driver or Apple
DLS Synth) the Select Ports/Instruments dialog opens for your assignments.
10
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
Click on the [CoreMIDI Help] button for detailed instructions and see the
tutorial in the CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth chapter.
When CoreMIDI has been selected as the MIDI driver the selections in the MIDI menu changes to provide access to
CoreMIDI features.
CoreMIDI Audio MIDI Setup launches the Apple Audio MIDI Setup dialog.
**CoreMIDI (choose ports) opens the Select Ports/Instruments dialog.
**Select MIDI Driver or Apple DLS Synth returns to the MIDI Drivers dialog.
Just type in the chords for any song using standard chord symbols (like C, Fm7, or C13b9), choose the style you’d
like, and Band-in-a-Box does the rest, automatically generating a complete professional-quality arrangement of
piano, bass, drums, guitar, and strings or horns in a wide variety of popular styles plus optional live audio tracks
with RealDrums and RealTracks.
And that’s not all...
Band-in-a-Box is a powerful and creative music composition tool for exploring and developing musical ideas with
near-instantaneous feedback. Over the years, many powerful and practical features have been added to Band-in-aBox, earning it a reputation as the “one music program you can’t do without.” In addition to its basic ability to
“think” like a musician, the musical intelligence of Band-in-a-Box has grown to include improvisation,
harmonization, and even songwriting! Its musical content embraces literally thousand of musical idioms and styles,
all taken to new levels of quality and professionalism with the addition of RealDrums and RealTracks - live
recordings by top studio musicians that add the human element to Band-in-a-Box arrangements, bringing your work
to life.
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
11
As well as essential features like on-screen notation and professional lead sheet printouts, Band-in-a-Box supports
your music making with unique and powerful features of its own. The Audio Chord Wizard has the amazing ability
to analyze, extract, and show the chords from audio recordings on-screen for play along, and then write them to the
Band-in-a-Box chordsheet. The MIDI Chord Wizard does the same thing for MIDI files. The DAW Plug-in Mode
makes it easy to drag and drop tracks from Band-in-a-Box into your favorite sequencer (GarageBand, ProTools,
Logic, Nuendo, Reaper and more).
Output your Band-in-a-Box songs in print or as a graphics file for web publication or to e-mail to a friend. And
when you're ready to let others hear your composition, you can quickly and easily render your song to popular audio
formats for burning to CD or uploading to the Internet.
There are many, many more features for song creation, practice, study, and fun waiting for you in the one-and-only
Band-in-a-Box.
Let’s get started!
A note about this manual. This book is your everyday reference and guide to the program and its features. See Help|View Bandin-a-Box Manual for the full manual.
12
Chapter 1: Welcome to Band-in-a-Box!
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
Creating music with Band-in-a-Box is as easy as 1-2-3! In this tutorial, you’ll see just how easy it is to get Bandin-a-Box making music for you.
Step 1 – Enter the Chords
There are numerous ways of entering chords into Band-in-a-Box. We’ll discuss five fast ways of entering chords:
1. Using the Computer Keyboard
2. Playing directly on a MIDI Controller Keyboard
3. Using the Chord Builder
4. Importing Chords from a MIDI file
5. Loading an Existing Band-in-a-Box Format Song
On the main screen of the program, you’ll see an area called the Chordsheet.
Each of the numbered cells on the Chordsheet represents a bar. In this example, you can see that there is an F6
chord in the first bar of this song. Similarly, one row down, you can see an F6 chord in bar 5, and later in the song,
a G7 in bar 7.
Notice the box in the first half of bar 1. This is the highlight cell, and it represents the bar you are currently working
on. You can move the highlight cell around using the cursor keys, or select a specific bar using the mouse.
Enter Chords Using the Computer Keyboard
To enter a specific chord, move the highlight cell to where you want to place the chord. For example, if you wanted
to add (or change) a chord in bar 20, you would highlight bar 20 on the Chordsheet. Next, type in your chords. If
you want an F7 at bar 2, type F and 7 on your keyboard and press Return. Notice that when you use the Return
key, the highlight cell moves to the second half of the bar. You could then enter another chord at beat 3. Chords are
commonly typed using standard chord symbols (like C or Fm7 or Bb7 or Bb13#9/E), but you can enter them in any
of the supported chord symbol display formats like Roman Numerals, Nashville Notation, and Solfeggio.
Enter Chords Using a MIDI Controller Keyboard
If you have a MIDI controller keyboard, you can use it to enter chords into Band-in-a-Box. First, you must make
sure that your cables are properly connected and you have the correct input drivers selected.
If you play a chord on your MIDI keyboard, and then press Ctrl+Enter, the chord will be entered into the
Chordsheet at the current highlight cell position.
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
13
Enter Chords Using the Chord Builder
Press the Chord Builder button to open the Chord Builder dialog with a list of chord roots and
extensions.
Chord Builder Dialog
To enter a chord at the current bar, select the chord root from the left pane, and then the extension on the right pane.
Pressing [Enter Chord ___] enters the chord and advances the highlight cell to the next half bar.
Import Chords from a MIDI File
Band-in-a-Box can import chords from an existing MIDI file with the Chord Wizard.
Choose File | Import Chords from MIDI File on the File menu, or use the keystrokes Ctrl+Option+I, to open the
Chord Wizard dialog.
When the Chord Wizard dialog opens, press the [Open (Change)…] button to choose the MIDI file that you want
Band-in-a-Box to interpret the chords from.
To help Band-in-a-Box interpret the chords better, you can choose a preset for the song. Choose from among such
genres as Pop, Rock, or Jazz Standard.
14
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
Loading an existing Band-in-a-Box format song
Press the [song] button. The first time you use this button, Band-in-a-Box will offer to build a song
list for you. We’ve included many demo songs for you to use, and they are listed in the song list.
You could also load a pre-existing song by using the File | Open song… menu item, or by pressing the F3 function
key, which will launch the familiar Macintosh file dialog. Note that most songs will automatically load a “Style,”
which we’ll learn about in the next section.
Going to the next step …
Now that you have chords on your chordsheet, you are ready to move on to Step 2 – Choosing a Style.
Step 2 – Choose a Style
Band-in-a-Box creates backing arrangements based on the chords you type in, applied to a particular Style.
What’s a Style?
A style is a set of rules that determine how Band-in-a-Box creates music using your chords. By adjusting the rules,
we have created hundreds of styles that are appropriate for everything from Country to Bebop. Some style examples
would be Jazz Swing, Blues Shuffle, Hip Hop, Country 4/4, Pop Ballad, Waltz and Medium Rock to name just a
few. If you don’t find a pre-made style that suits your tastes, create one from scratch using the StyleMaker. Making
custom styles with the StyleMaker is explained in detail in the full documentation.
Four Fast ways to Open a Style
Method 1: From Disk
To open a user style from disk, you can use the menu command User | Load Style From Disk or type Command+U.
You will be presented with the Open Style dialog from which you can select a specific style from the Styles folder.
Method 2: The StylePicker
You can use the StylePicker window to select your style. Select the [Style] button above the
Chordsheet to open the Select Style window.
Selecting a Style using the StylePicker.
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
15
This window shows styles listed by categories. RealStyles are styles entirely made with RealTracks and
RealDrums. Styles with RealTracks use a combination of RealTracks and MIDI instruments. MultiStyles are styles
with more variations than the standard “a” and “b” substyles.
Select a Set or genre from the left pane, and choose the specific style on the right pane. There are memos and
examples for each of the styles. Styles with a similar feel and tempo range to the current selection (prototype) are
marked with an (*) asterisk. These styles are possible substitutes for the prototype. Styles marked with a (^) caret
symbol are similar in feel but have a different tempo range.
You can audition a style by clicking on the [Preview] button to hear your song played with
the style that is currently highlighted in the list.
The style of your song can be changed at any bar by pressing the F5 key to launch the Edit Bar Settings dialog.
Method 3: Recently Played Styles and Favorites
Styles that you’ve used previously show up in the Recently Played Styles dialog. Choose this from the menu User |
Load Favorite Styles… or click on the [F] button to the left of the [Style] StylePicker button. You can either choose
from recently played styles or go to your saved list of Favorites. You can add to or edit the Favorites list.
Method 4: Quick Pick
You can choose from among the 24 “built-in” styles. This list provides
a quick way to choose from among the most popular music genres.
Step 3 – Play your song!
Now that we’ve entered chords on the Chordsheet and chosen a style, it’s time to play the song! First we need to tell
Band-in-a-Box how long our song is, in what key and how fast, and how many times we want the program to play
through the chords, in what key, and how fast.
16
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
Framing the Song
To tell Band-in-a-Box where the start and end of the song is, look at the middle of the Band-in-a-Box main screen.
Locate the framing settings; there are three of them. The numbers (1-32) in brackets are the bar numbers for the
beginning and the end of the Chorus. The number 3 to the right of the brackets is the number of times the Chorus
repeats. In the example above, the Chorus starts at bar 1, ends on bar 32, and is going to play 3 times. You can
change these settings to play more choruses, or make the Chorus start later, for example in the case where you want
an intro to play.
Setting the Key
In the example shown, the key is set to C but you can choose any key by clicking on the key signature and choosing
from a list. If you do change the key, Band-in-a-Box will offer to transpose the Chordsheet for you. If you’ve
entered a progression that you intend for a particular key, and then choose the key afterward, you should say no
when asked to transpose the Chordsheet.
Setting the Tempo
If you know the tempo value of your song, you can enter it in the tempo box. The song example above has a tempo
of 120. There is an even faster way to enter a tempo. Locate the minus key [-] and the equals key [=] in the number
row of your computer keyboard, they are usually next to each other. If you tap the [-] key 4 times at your tempo,
Band-in-a-Box will set the tempo automatically for you. If you tap the [=] key four times, Band-in-a-Box will set
the tempo and begin song playback!
Press Play
When you’re ready, just press the [Play] button or the F4 function key and Band-in-a-Box will immediately
generate and play a professional arrangement of your song using the settings and the style you selected. You can
double click on any bar in the Chordsheet, including the tag or ending, to start playback from that bar.
More fun with Band-in-a-Box
Now you know how easy it is to start making music with Band-in-a-Box, but there are still many more powerful
features for you to discover. For a start, you could add a human element to your arrangement with RealTracks and
RealDrums.
Add RealTracks and RealDrums
RealDrums and RealTracks add accompaniment by top studio musicians to your songs. RealDrums replace the
MIDI Drum track with real recordings of top studio Jazz, Rock, and Country drummers. These are not “samples,”
but are full recordings, lasting from 1 to 8 bars at a time, and playing along in perfect sync with the other Band-in-aBox tracks.
RealTracks instruments include guitars, piano, bass, saxes, trumpet, trombone, pedal steel, fiddle, banjo, mandolin
and many more. These tracks replace the MIDI track for that instrument, and can be controlled just like the MIDI
instrument (volume changes, muting etc.). Best of all, they follow the chord progression that you have entered, so
that you hear an authentic audio accompaniment to your song.
Any track can be converted from a MIDI track into a Real track from the
contextual menu on the main screen. Just right click (or Control+click or
double click) on the part name to open the menu and then select “Generate
RealTrack” (or RealDrums).
You will then be shown a list of all the available instruments and styles to
make your selection.
Now it’s time to make music with Band-in-a-Box…
Have Fun!
Chapter 2: QuickStart Tutorial
17
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
Welcome to Band-in-a-Box 2010.5
There were over 50 cool new features added in Band-in-a-Box 2010, and now version 2010.5 adds 30 more! These
include user wish list requests and enhancements to existing features, plus some wish list requests of our own.
30 New Features!
- The StylePicker now has a filter to show/hide Real or MIDI styles. So if you only want to see MIDI styles, or if
you only want to see styles that use some/all RealTracks, you can set this.
- If you like the current mix (of volumes, panning, reverb), and you want this applied as a default for all songs, you
can now set this by right-clicking on the Combo radio control. Choose “Make Current Mix the Default,” “Load
Default Mix,” or “Reset Mix (to factory defaults).”
- RealTracks naturally occurring pushes are enhanced in many styles. This requires updating the ST2/XT2 files,
and these are included in the 2010.5 update.
- When rendering, you can now add a dB amount to the whole mix, so that the mix will be louder or softer. There is
automatic peak-limiting added, so that the music will not distort if you set it too high.
- Styles can now be made that are set to use Half Time and Double-Time RealTracks. For example, you can make a
Jazz Ballad style (tempo 65) that uses a Sax Soloist at tempo 140 (playing double time).
- If Band-in-a-Box cannot find your RealTracks folder or your Drums folder, a yellow hint message appears at boot
up to alert you to that, and tells you how to fix it, “Note: You have RealTracks installed, but none are found in
your RealTracks folder. You should point to your correct RealTracks folder in the RealTracks Settings.”
- RealTracks pushes are now played a little quieter (2 dB quieter), so that they don’t stand out as much.
- For RealTracks, many Jazz comping styles now play triads (instead of 7ths) when simple triads are entered,
instead of “jazzing them up” to 7ths chords (e.g. Guitar: Freddie, Wes. Piano: some Jazz, all Stride, Rehearsal). If
you prefer this “the old way,” where triads are automatically “jazzed up” when comping using Jazz RealTracks,
then you can set the RealTracks Settings option to force 7ths for triads.
- Enhancements for entering songs quickly: Typing special words, instead of chord names, will make these settings:
begin <Enter>
- sets the beginning of the chorus to the current bar
end <Enter>
- sets the end of the song to the current bar
chorusend <Enter> - sets the end of the chorus to the current bar
tkc <Enter>
- sets key signature to C, tkbb would set it to Bb
trc <Enter>
- transposes song to key of C
t125 <Enter>
- sets tempo to 125
- Enhancements for playing songs from the Chordsheet
- <spacebar> or double click on ending bar (or a bar in the tag), and it will play from the ending (or tag). This
only applies to the Chordsheet, since notation windows always play from the ending or tag already.
- Right-click on the Chordsheet (or notation) to quickly set Chorus Begin, Chorus End, or Song Ending.
- RealDrums button now has a menu (like RealTracks picker button) to choose RealDrums Preferences or the
RealDrums Picker dialog. Ctrl+click to choose the Preferences or Shift+click to choose the Picker directly.
- The auto-generated song memo now says if RealDrums come from the song or style.
- A message now appears if a frozen track is loaded, but the required RealTracks or RealDrums folders do not exist.
- Frozen tracks now start playing faster if played again.
- In the RealTracks picker, the sort feature for the Set # and Holds # columns is improved.
- Important change: The default for the tempo swapping feature for RealTracks is now true. It used to be false.
Tempo swapping is a nice feature that will automatically substitute a similar RealTracks that is recorded at a
tempo closer to the current tempo. For example, if you load a ballad style with a RealTracks piano at a tempo of
60, and then speed the song up to 200, BB’s tempo-swapping feature will choose a RealTracks piano that is closer
to 200, likely one that is 190. Go to the RealTracks Settings (RealTracks Preferences) to disable this feature.
- Band-in-a-Box will keep on generating RealTracks even if some wav files are missing.
- Changed: File-New gets volumes of 127, instead of 90.
18
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
New Features in Band-in-a-Box 2010
Band-in-a-Box 2010 added over 50 cool new features!
These exciting new features were added in Band-in-a-Box 2010. There’s a new “Plug-in” mode, allowing you to
simply drag and drop tracks between Band-in-a-Box and your favorite sequencer (GarageBand, ProTools, Logic,
Nuendo, Reaper and more). RealTracks generate much faster now, typically 3X faster. RealTracks now support
Shots, Holds, and Pushes. Time for generating MIDI arrangement is much faster - now “instantaneous” (less than 1
second). Endings are improved, and RealTracks endings are now 4 bars long, giving time for the natural decay of
the instruments. Individual tracks (MIDI or Real) can be frozen now, so the arrangements can be saved and fixed,
and will replay quickly without need for regeneration. Soloist RealTracks are now saved with the song. We’ve
added Multiple Undo support, up to 999 levels of Undo. There are new Reverb and Bass/Treble controls for each
track, allowing you to add these to individual RealTracks. All settings are now saved with each song. And many
more!
The New Features in Band-in-a-Box 2010 for Macintosh are...
There is a “Plug-in” mode for your favorite sequencer (GarageBand, ProTools, Logic, Nuendo, Reaper and
more). With the new plug-in mode, Band-in-a-Box is open as a small window, and acts as a plug-in for your
favorite DAW/sequencer, so that you can Drag-n-Drop MIDI and audio (AIFF) tracks from Band-in-a-Box to
your favorite sequencer. Work in your favorite sequencer, type a progression in Band-in-a-Box, and then simply
drag the track from Band-in-a-Box to your sequencer's track at the desired track and bar location.
No more long waits for RealTracks to generate! RealTracks generate much faster, 3X faster on average. A
typical song with RealTracks that took 20 seconds to generate will now generate in about 5 seconds. And if you
freeze some or all tracks in the song (see below), playback of RealTracks is almost instantaneous.
Time for generating MIDI arrangement is much faster - now “instantaneous” (less than 1 second)!
Freezing (locking) MIDI tracks or RealTracks/RealDrums. Any track (MIDI or Real) can now be frozen. When
frozen, it won't be changed or re-generated. This saves time when replaying previous songs, and allows you to
freeze an arrangement that you like. If you freeze the whole song, you don't have to wait at all for the song to
regenerate. Next time you play, it is ready to go.
All Tracks can be Edited and Saved. MIDI tracks for bass, drums, piano, guitar and strings can now be edited,
and saved with the file. If you freeze a track, edits can still be made to it, because it is only frozen from Band-in-aBox making changes to it (you can still edit it), so that the MIDI track will be saved to the file. So you can
customize the bass part to match a certain song, and save it with a frozen bass part, so Band-in-a-Box won’t
overwrite your edits. This includes RealCharts – if you wanted to edit the notation of a RealTracks solo for
example.
Soloist generated RealTracks are now saved with the song, so you will hear the RealTracks play the same solo
when you reload the song.
RealTracks now support new features, including Shots, Holds, and Pushes. Simply type in the chords as you
normally would, adding periods (…) for shots and holds, and the RealTracks will play them. Note for this, you need
the installer that creates a LibraryM/Holds folder in your RealTracks folder.
RealTracks endings have been enhanced, and are now 4-bar endings instead of 2-bar, allowing time for a
natural decay of the instruments.
Multiple Undo support. Up to 999 levels of undo (configurable).
Always save all song settings. Now all settings are saved with songs, including patches, reverbs, volume, etc., so
that the song will play the same way each time, without having to set this in the Save With Patches dialog.
Reverb control added for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can easily add reverb (0 to
127) for any RealTrack. Reverb type is also settable, and saved with the song.
Bass/Treble Tone Control added for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can easily adjust
the bass/treble EQ for any RealTrack. Settings save with the song.
Band-in-a-Box window is now sizable, when size changes, chordsheet, notation, and other windows redraw in
proportion to the new size. This allows you to have Band-in-a-Box open as a small window on screen with other
programs, and you still see a full chordsheet. The screen size is remembered between sessions.
New favorite songs/styles dialog, with separate lists of “recently played” and favorite songs or styles. The previous
“favorite” songs/styles dialog was a list of recently used songs/styles. Now there are 2 tabs in this dialog, showing
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
19
you both recently used songs/styles, and a new list of “favorites” that you select as a favorite songs or styles. You
can add an unlimited number of favorites.
Double time and half time support for RealTracks added. Now you can play any RealTracks at half time or
double-time. This allows you, for example, in a ballad at a tempo of 70, to add a RealTracks Sax solo with tempo of
140, and play it as a double-time, which will match the ballad tempo of 70. So now all of your existing RealTracks
can be used at 3 different tempos (normal time, half time, or double time).
Tempo swapping of similar RealTracks. You can use this feature either automatically or manually. If you set
“Auto RealTracks substitution based on tempo” to true in RealTracks Settings dialog or Additional Song Settings
dialog, Band-in-a-Box will automatically choose the best one to use. For example, if you have a ballad loaded, with
an Acoustic Bass RealTracks at a tempo of 60, and you speed up the tempo to 140, and press the [Play] button,
Band-in-a-Box will automatically choose an Acoustic Bass RealTracks closer to the tempo of 140, if it is the same
genre and feel. This means you can use a simple Jazz style, and play it at various tempos, without having to set the
best RealTracks based on tempos. If you don’t want this feature to work automatically, then set “Auto RealTracks
substitution based on tempo” to false. The RealTracks that support the Tempo Swapping are listed in the next to last
column of the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog.
RealTracks Picker dialog enhanced:
- Opens up faster.
- New columns are added (tempo swappable, holds type).
RealDrums Picker dialog has been enhanced, with information about Artist name, Artist bio, and RealDrums
Set number.
Rendering now has a Normalize option, to normalize individual tracks or the complete arrangement. Normalizing
boosts the volume to a maximum level without distortion. Most professional music tracks are normalized.
Songs that are “Saved-As” a different name now have the new name added to the Recently Played Song dialog.
Support enhanced for non-concert instruments (Bb/Eb sax, trumpet etc.). Now when the Chordsheet is
transposed, you can type in chords in the transposed key, and they will show up as you have entered them, instead
of requiring you to enter the chords in the concert key.
More Soloists are now available, up to 2000.
Many messages changed to “yellow alerts” at top right of screen, so you don’t have to respond to the message,
interrupting workflow.
Looped playback of any selected region. On the Chordsheet window (not the notation window), select a region of
bars, and press the [Loop] playback button on the toolbar. The selected region will loop. You can change the
looped section during playback. Pressing [Loop] button again will turn off looping.
Mouse scroll wheel support added to the main window, notation window, and many dialogs.
Ability to have endings use a “held chord,” (like C...). (RealTracks and MIDI)
For songs with no ending, the last chord of the song can be a held chord (like C...). (RealTracks and MIDI)
More New RealTracks
There are one hundred and one sets of RealTracks available for Band-in-a-Box!
The basic Band-in-a-Box Pro package includes a basic set of RealCombos for Pop, Country, and Jazz. In addition,
there are hundreds more RealTracks instruments available in one hundred and one different sets.
For a full listing with complete descriptions and demo songs, go to www.pgmusic.com and see the RealTracks page,
http://www.pgmusic.com/products_realtracks.htm.
While you’re there, be sure to check for new releases.
20
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
QuickStart Tutorial
Using the New Features in Band-in-a-Box 2010 and 2010.5
Quick Song Settings
These are enhancements for entering songs quickly. Typing special words, instead of chord names, will make the
following settings:
begin <Enter>
- sets the beginning of the chorus to the current bar
chorusend <Enter> - sets the end of the chorus to the current bar
end <Enter>
- sets the end of the song to the current bar
tkc <Enter>
- sets key signature to C, tkbb would set it to Bb
trc <Enter>
- transposes song to key of C
t125 <Enter>
- sets tempo to 125
Save Default Mix
If you like the current mix (of volumes, panning, reverb), and you want this applied as a default for all songs, you
can now set this by right-clicking on the Combo radio control and choosing Save Current Mix as Default.
Load Default Mix restores the default mix you have saved, and
Reset Mix sets the mix back to “factory defaults.”
New Chordsheet Controls
In the Chordsheet window, press the <spacebar> or double click on the ending bar (or a bar in the tag), and the song
will play from the ending (or tag). This only applies to the Chordsheet, since notation windows always play from
the ending or tag already.
You can right-click on a bar in the Chordsheet to set it as the beginning or end of the chorus or the end of the song
from the settings in the context menu.
For example, these settings are available with
a right-click on bar 16.
Improved Audio Rendering
When you click on the Audio button to render your song to audio files, there is now an option to boost
all files by a certain number of dB. “Boost All Render Files by” adds a dB amount to the whole mix, so
that the mix will be louder or softer. There is automatic peak limiting added, so that the music will not
distort if you set it too high.
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
21
DAW Plug-in Mode
There is a “Plug-in” mode for your favorite sequencer (GarageBand, ProTools, Logic, Nuendo, Reaper and
more). With the new plug-in mode, Band-in-a-Box is open as a small window, and acts as a plug-in for your
favorite DAW sequencer, so you can Drag-n-Drop MIDI and audio (AIFF, M4A) tracks from Band-in-a-Box to
your favorite sequencer. Work in your favorite sequencer, type a chord progression in Band-in-a-Box, drag the
track button to the drop station (blue rectangle) at top left of the screen, and then drag that to your sequencer's track
at the desired track and the bar location.
The DAW Plug-in mode is a mode within the regular Band-in-a-Box program. This mode allows you to transfer
tracks or parts of tracks, to other DAW sequencers or Finder.
You can enter and exit the DAW plug-in mode easily.
Press the [DAW Mode] button on the Toolbar, then choose the menu item “Start DAW Plug-in mode” (or go to
Windows menu and choose Plug-in Mode for Sequencer-DAW).
When you do this:
1. Window size of Band-in-a-Box changes to a small size (you can resize it to the size/position that you want, and it
will remember that).
2.
You can now easily drag tracks from Band-in-a-Box to your DAW in 2-steps. First, drag the track button to the
drop station (blue rectangle), and then when it turns green, drag that to your DAW’s track.
You can also drag files to other programs, besides DAW’s, if they accept a drop of audio files (AIFF, M4A) or
MIDI files. For example, Finder allows this.
Please see the DAW Plug-In Mode chapter for a full tutorial.
Freeze Tracks
Freezing (locking) MIDI or RealTracks/RealDrums
Any track (MIDI or RealTrack) can now be frozen. When frozen, it won’t be changed or re-generated. This saves
time when replaying previous songs, and allows you to freeze an arrangement that you like. If you freeze the whole
song, you don’t have to wait at all for the song to regenerate. Next time you play, it is ready to go.
You can make tracks Frozen by pressing the Freeze button (snowflake) on the toolbar, and then choosing which
tracks that you want to freeze or unfreeze.
There are a number of reasons that you would freeze a track.
Reasons to Freeze a RealTracks track (audio):
- Frozen tracks will play back instantly, not requiring time to generate.
22
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
- They play back the same way each time, so if you like a solo, you can “freeze it.”
- If you send a song to a friend as “frozen,” they will hear the same performance.
- For the Soloist track, if you generate a solo, it can now be saved (by freezing the track).
Reasons to Freeze a MIDI track:
- You can edit the MIDI data, to customize the performance to match a certain song, and this will be saved. Use
the Notation window or Piano Roll to edit the track.
More reasons to freeze any track:
- Frozen tracks play back instantly, without requiring time to regenerate.
- They play back the same way each time.
- You can change the chord progression of the song, and have one part playing a different chord progression than
the rest of the band. For example, type a “blowing” chord progression, generate a solo, freeze the solo track, then
type a normal chord progression and generate the rest of the instruments (bass, guitar etc.) that will play the
normal changes.
- Have different instruments play different styles. For example, the Bass could be generated using Reggae, then
Frozen, and then the rest of the instruments generated using a Techno style.
Un-Freezing a Track(s)
This is also done by the Freeze button. Choose a frozen track to un-freeze it, or choose “Un-Freeze all tracks.”
Forcing Generation of a Song that is Frozen
Band-in-a-Box won’t touch tracks that are frozen. But if you want to change that, without having to Un-Freeze the
tracks, you can do this easily.
Hold down the SHIFT key as you press the [Play] button (the fly-by hint will remind you of that), or go to the Song
menu and choose Generate (even if tracks are frozen).
When you do this, the song will regenerate, the tracks will be rewritten, and the song will stay frozen. So if you’re
freezing songs to get the instant playback with RealTracks, but get tired of the “same-old” frozen arrangement, just
press Shift+Play, generate a new arrangement, and press Save. Then the new “fresh-frozen” arrangement will play
instantly, even with many RealTracks.
A message appears if a frozen track is loaded, but the required RealTracks or RealDrums folders do not exist.
Tip: Obviously you wouldn’t use this feature to force regeneration of a frozen song if you have made custom edits to the song that
you don’t want to lose, unless you’ve saved the song and have a backup copy.
All Tracks can be Edited and Saved.
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
23
MIDI tracks for bass, drums, piano, guitar and strings can now be edited, and saved with the file. If you freeze a
track, edits can still be made to it, because it is only frozen from Band-in-a-Box making changes to it (you can still
edit it), so that the MIDI track will be saved to the file. So you can customize the bass part to match a certain song,
and save it with a frozen bass part, so that Band-in-a-Box won’t overwrite your edits. This includes RealCharts – if
you wanted to edit the notation of a RealTracks solo for example.
To edit a MIDI track (bass, drums, piano, guitar, strings), or the MIDI part of a RealTracks that has a
RealChart (MIDI transcribed solo), simply open up the Notation window (or Piano Roll window), and click on
the track and edit it. Make sure to Freeze the track by pressing the Freeze button and choosing Freeze for that track,
or right-clicking on the instrument at the top of the screen and choosing Freeze. Now your edited tracks will save
with the song.
Multiple Undo Support.
Up to 999 levels of Undo are supported (configurable). The default number of undos is 99. If you need to change
this, it can be done in Preferences “Number of Levels
of Undo.” The range can be 5 to 999. You can also
choose Edit | Redo to redo an undo.
RealTracks Enhancements
No more long waits for RealTracks to generate!
RealTracks generate much faster, 3X faster on average. A typical song with RealTracks that took 20 seconds to
generate will now generate in about 6 seconds. And if you freeze some or all tracks in the song (see below),
playback of RealTracks is almost instantaneous.
This “speedup” feature works “automatically;” you should just notice that generation of RealTracks is much faster.
This feature uses CPU resources during playback. If you have a multi-core machine, you may not notice this at all,
since it will use different cores than the main Band-in-a-Box thread. If you have an old machine, low on memory,
slow hard drive etc., you can disable this “speedup” feature. This will insure that your machine is doing less CPU
work during playback. This is done in RealTracks Settings dialog.
Optional Jazz Triads
For RealTracks, many Jazz comping styles now play triads (instead of 7ths) when simple triads are entered, instead
of “jazzing them up” to 7ths chords (e.g. Guitar: Freddie, Wes Piano: some Jazz, all Stride, Rehearsal).
If you prefer this “the old way,” where triads are automatically “jazzed up” when comping using Jazz RealTracks,
then you can set the Prefs-Realtracks settings option to force 7ths for triads.
Soloist generated RealTracks are now saved with the song, so you will hear the RealTracks play the same solo
when you reload the song.
When you generate a solo using RealTracks, Band-in-a-Box will remember this, and when you go to save the song,
Band-in-a-Box will ask you if you want to save that solo (and thereby freeze the Soloist track). If you say yes, then
the solo will play instantly the same way when the song is reloaded. Of course you can freeze the soloist track
yourself at any time. Note that only one solo can be saved. You can’t generate a bunch of different segments of
solos; only the last one will be saved.
Shots, Holds, and Pushes
RealTracks now support new features, including Shots, Holds, and Pushes. Simply type in the chords as you
normally would, adding periods (…) for shots and holds, and the RealTracks will play them.
Note: You need the installer that creates a LibraryM/Holds folder in your RealTracks folder.
The “H” column of the RealTracks Assign dialog tells whether the RealTrack styles supports Shots, Holds, and
Pushes. If the column is blank, the selected RealTracks style has Holds, Shots, and Pushes available. If there is an
“n,” holds are available from PG Music but not installed. If there is a “-,” no holds are available for this style.
24
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
Assuming that you have the Holds files for the RealTracks that you are generating, then you just use
Band-in-a-Box as you would normally, and type chords with shots (e.g. C..), holds (C…) or pushes
(^C or ^^C for 8th or 16th note push), or combinations of push and hold (^C…).
RealTracks naturally occurring pushes are enhanced in many styles. This requires updating the
ST2/XT2 files, and these are included in the 2010.5 update. RealTracks Pushes are now played a
little quieter (2 dB quieter), so that they don’t stand out as much.
4-bar Endings
RealTracks endings have been enhanced, and are now 4-bar endings instead of 2-bar, allowing time for a natural
decay of the instruments.
By “4-bar-endings” we are referring to a 2-bar ending that has two additional bars to allow for the natural decay of
the audio instrument (instead of being quickly faded out). To add the 4-bar ending support, you need to have
updated ST2 and XT2 files for the RealTracks. We are releasing many of these updated files with the 2010 release,
and will have free patches for the older RealTracks as they become available.
4-bar-endings are on by default. So if any of the RealTracks have 4-bar endings, then the arrangement will play as a
4-bar ending.
You can disable 4-bar endings:
- either globally using RealTracks Settings dialog,
- or on a song-by-song basis, using Additional Song Settings dialog (Song | Additional Song Settings.
Currently, the only way to tell if a RealTracks has a 4-bar ending, is to either try it and see, or to look in the Select
Soloist dialog (Soloist | Generate and Play a Solo), and see the name of the ST2 file (under the term database at the
top right). Then check the date of the ST2 file. If it is Nov. 2009 or newer, then it should have a 4-bar ending.
Check our pgmusic.com web site, as we are releasing free upgrade patches to add 4-bar endings to most of the
RealTracks styles.
Audio Reverb
Reverb control added for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can easily add reverb (0 to
127) for any RealTrack. Reverb type is also settable, and saved with the song.
At the top of the screen, there is an “A.REV” (Audio Reverb) control. Click on an instrument radio
button, and then set the Audio Reverb for it.
Note that this only applies to RealTracks, since MIDI tracks have MIDI Reverb, which is set via a
“REV” control.
The Audio Reverb varies from 0 to 127. Adjust the value by clicking a key on the on-screen piano keyboard. Or
right-click (or control-click) the control to enter a value. See the RealTracks and RealDrums chapter for more
about this feature.
There is also a feature that automatically adds reverb to RealTracks, according to instrument type. (No Reverb is
added to Bass for example, but most instruments get reverb.)
This feature defaults to on, but you can turn it off in RealTracks Settings or Reverb Settings dialog.
If you just want more or less added, you can adjust the “Strength %.” For example, the default adds a reverb of 40
to most tracks, but if you set the strength to 75%, then 30 will be added.
You can also set the type of reverb. The default is a “room” type of reverb.
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
25
To do this, press the Audio Reverb button, and adjust the various parameters.
You can then save your reverb types as presets, and the current settings will also be saved with the song. The
presets all are saved to a PGReverbSettings.bin file in Band-in-a-Box/Preferences folder.
You can enable/disable Reverb. If you disable it, this will save some CPU cycles, so this might be advisable on an
older/slower machine, if you hear that the audio is clicking or not keeping up.
Bass/Treble Tone Control has been added for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can
easily adjust the bass/treble EQ for any RealTrack. The settings are saved with the song. Choose an
instrument (bass/drums/piano/guitar/strings/melody) and then use the “TONE” control to adjust the
tone from -18 (maximum bass) to +18 (maximum treble). Default is 0.
Double time and half time support for RealTracks
Now you can play any RealTracks at half time or double time. This allows you, for example, in a ballad at a tempo
of 70, to add a RealTracks Sax solo with a tempo of 140, and play it as double time, which will match the ballad
tempo of 70. So now all of your existing RealTracks can be used at 3 different tempos (Normal Time, Half Time,
Double Time).
You can control when/how RealTracks would play. To do this, open the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog and
use the “Timebase” combo box.
26
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
Tempo swapping of similar RealTracks
You can use this feature either automatically or manually. If you set “Auto RealTracks substitution based on
tempo” to true in RealTracks Settings dialog or Additional Song Settings dialog, Band-in-a-Box will
automatically choose the best one to use.
The default for the tempo swapping feature for RealTracks is now true. It used to be false. Tempo swapping is a
nice feature that automatically substitutes a similar RealTracks recorded at a tempo closer to the current tempo.
For example, if you have a ballad loaded, with an Acoustic Bass RealTracks at a tempo of 60, and you speed up the
tempo to 140, and press the [Play] button, Band-in-a-Box will automatically choose an Acoustic Bass RealTracks
closer to the tempo of 140, if it is the same genre and feel. This means you can use a simple Jazz style, and play it at
various tempos, without having to select the best RealTracks based on tempos. The RealTracks that support the
Tempo Swapping are listed in the next to last column of the RealTracks Assign dialog.
For example, if we load in a Ballad Jazz style like _BALFRED.STY, we can see that the name of the Bass
RealTracks style has a tilde (~) symbol at the beginning. That indicates that it could be changed to a different
RealTracks at a higher tempo.
Now let’s increase the tempo of the song to a higher tempo, like 115.
We will see that the name of the RealTracks switches to a different RealTracks, suitable for tempo =110.
So when you press the [Play] button, you’ll hear the RealTracks closest to your tempo, without having to do
anything to make this happen.
If you don’t want this feature to happen automatically,
then set “Auto RealTracks substitution based on tempo” to false. Then, if you have similar RealTracks available at
different tempos, Band-in-a-Box will simply tell you there is a better one to choose.
The “T” column of the RealTracks Assign dialog shows which RealTracks are eligible for Tempo Swapping. The
tempo swapping only occurs if you have the RealTracks in your installation.
RealTracks Picker dialog enhanced.
- Opens up faster.
- New columns are added (tempo swappable, holds type).
RealDrums Picker dialog has been enhanced with information about Artist name, Artist bio, and RealDrums Set
number.
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
27
The RealDrums button now has a menu (like the RealTracks button) to choose the RealDrums Picker Dialog,
Shift+click, or the RealDrums Preferences, Ctrl+click.
New Favorite Songs/Styles Dialog
There’s a new dialog for these favorites with separate lists of “Recently Played” and “Favorite” songs or styles. The
previous Favorite Songs/Styles dialog was a list of recently used songs/styles. Now there are 2 tabs in this dialog,
showing you both recently used songs/styles, and a new list of “favorites” that you select as favorite songs or styles.
You can add an unlimited number of favorites.
The “F” button launches the Favorites / Recently Played dialog.
The “Favorites” and “Recently Played” Radio buttons toggle between a
list of your recently played songs (or styles), and your Favorite songs (or styles).
The favorites list will start off as an empty one, but you can add songs/styles as your
favorites, by clicking the [Add Favorite] button. (This button is also found in the StylePicker.)
Technical Note: The list of songs/style favorites is stored in a text file called SongFavorites.txt (or StyleFavorites.txt) in the
Band-in-a-Box folder.
Always save all song settings.
Now all settings are saved with songs, including patches, reverbs, volume etc., so the song will play the same way
each time, without having to set this in the Save Patches and Harmonies with Song dialog.
28
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
If you keep the default setting of “Save all settings with Songs,” you will
find that all settings are saved, and loaded with each song. You shouldn’t have to visit this dialog, unless you have
some custom items that you want to not-save with the song.
Note that if you set a MIDI patch for one of the bass/drums/piano/guitar/strings parts, that if you load in another
style, Band-in-a-Box will overwrite your patches with the style patches. If it didn’t do that, you would be stuck with
the same patches regardless of the style. So if you want a certain patch for a track, set it after you have loaded in the
style that you want.
Songs that are “Saved-As” with a different name now have the new name added to the Recently Played Song
dialog.
Rendering Tracks
When you click on the Audio button to render your song to audio files, there is now an option to boost
all files by a certain number of dB. “Boost All Render Files by” adds a dB amount to the whole mix, so
that the mix will be louder or softer. There is automatic peak limiting added, so that the music will not
distort if you set it too high.
Rendering now has a Normalize option, to normalize individual tracks or the complete arrangement. Normalizing
boosts the volume to a maximum level without distortion. Most professional music tracks are normalized.
To enable this, in the Render to Audio dialog, set the “Normalize Rendered
Files” option to true.
Rendering songs to audio is now much faster for songs with no MIDI, such as RealStyles.
StylePicker Enhancements
Favorites and Recent styles now appear in this dialog as separate lists. It now has the ability to add/remove styles
as favorites. A Favorite Style indication (F) shows up for each style. You can filter any list by only showing
favorite styles. You can build up a list of favorite styles, and only show them when needed.
The favorite styles are the ones that you’ve identified as favorites, either by pressing the [Add Favorite] button in
the Favorite Styles dialog, or the similar button in this StylePicker dialog. Note that an “F” appears beside the
name of any style that is a favorite.
You can make any style a favorite by clicking the [Add Favorite]
button. If you want to remove it, click the button again.
“Only Show favorites” will only show the favorite styles in any list that you have opened.
The StylePicker now has a filter to show/hide Real or MIDI
styles. So if you only want to see MIDI styles, or if you only
want to see styles that use some/all RealTracks, you can set this.
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
29
New in the StyleMaker
In the Misc. Style Settings dialog (User | Edit Existing User Style [Patch]) there is a new Timebase
option that allows styles to use Half Time and Double Time RealTracks.
For example, you can make a Jazz Ballad style (tempo 65) that uses a Sax Soloist at tempo 140 (playing double
time).
And much more…
Band-in-a-Box window is now sizable. When size changes, chordsheet, notation, and other windows redraw in
proportion to the new size. This allows you to have Band-in-a-Box open as a small window on screen with other
programs, and you still see a full chordsheet. The screen size is remembered between sessions.
To resize the window, just use the sizing control at the bottom-right corner of the window. Hold
down the mouse button while you drag the sizing control.
Support enhanced for non-concert instruments (Bb/Eb sax, trumpet etc.).
Now when the Chordsheet is transposed, you can type in chords in the transposed key, and they will show up as
you have entered them, instead of requiring you to enter the chords in the concert key.
More Soloists are now available, up to 2000.
Many messages changed to “yellow alerts” at top right of screen, so you don’t have to respond to the message,
interrupting workflow.
Have fun!
30
Chapter 3: Band-in-a-Box 2010.5 for Macintosh
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
Main Screen Overview
The main screen gives direct access to the major features and program settings of Band-in-a-Box for ease and
convenience during a session.
There are five different areas on the main screen.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1. The Status Bar is used to show program running status messages and path names of the currently loaded song.
2. The Synth Window is the area between the Menu Bar and the Piano Keyboard where Instruments patches are
set and levels are adjusted. It also includes buttons for adding harmonies to the Melody, Thru, or Soloist parts.
3. The Tool Bar area under the Piano Keyboard has buttons for direct access to important program features and
menus. Hold the mouse cursor on any button to see a pop-up hint that describes its function.
4. The Title Window shares the Tool Bar area. In addition to the song title, it includes all the other settings for
the song such as its Key Signature, Tempo, and Chorus settings.
5. The Chordsheet Area occupies the lower part of the screen. Chord changes for the song are typed into the
numbered bars (cells) in the sheet. Part markers (a, b, c, etc.) are entered here to switch between Band-in-a-Box
substyles.
To resize the window, just use the sizing control at the bottom-right corner of the window.
Hold down the mouse button while you drag the sizing control.
This allows you to have Band-in-a-Box open as a small window on screen with other programs, and you still see a
full chordsheet. The screen size is remembered between sessions.
Personalizing the Main Screen
Macintosh themes are supported.
You can choose different colors for the Chordsheet area of the screen, and you can also choose to use larger fonts
for the chord display. These two settings are found in the Preferences 2 dialog.
Support for larger screen sizes allows the program to fill the entire screen. There are also options to restrict the
screen size to a certain size. To force the screen size to a certain size, use the Preferences “Limit Screen size to”
item.
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
31
Status Bar
The first thing to note is that the name of the song that is open is identified in the window title at the top of the
screen along with the name of the style. This feature is handy when you want to know the status (and the title) of
your song and the style in use at a glance. You'll also see the length of the song in minutes and seconds, this updates
if you change the tempo and press the [Play] button.
The file name in the status bar will have an asterisk * added if the file has been changed.
Synth Window / Piano Keyboard
The Piano Keyboard
This keyboard displays the notes that are being played by all instruments on various parts of the piano keyboard
during playback (except drums). The name of the currently selected part is shown just above the keyboard.
When playing along or recording on the MIDI Thru the notes are displayed on the keyboard.
Synthesizer Window
Part Settings
The Bass/Piano/Drum/Guitar/Soloist/Strings/Melody and Thru buttons are referred to as Parts. Settings that can be
changed for an individual part include Reverb, Chorus, Pan, Bank, Volume, and Instrument. To change a setting for
one of the parts:
- Select the Part by mouse clicking on the part name.
- Change the desired parameter to affect the new setting.
The Instrument Panel shows the current instrument for the selected part.
You can access your patches with ease through the “patches popup” menu. To access this menu, simply click on
the instrument box you would like to change (i.e. Piano, Bass, Sol, etc.), move your mouse pointer over the
instrument panel box (i.e. Piano: (1) Acoustic Piano), and click anywhere on the instrument name. Then select the
new patch from the popup menu.
Clicking on the up ▲ and down ▼arrows will move up and down the list of instrument patches one at a time.
The Favorite Instrument panel allows you to assign up to 10 of your favorite instruments for each of the 8 parts
(Bass, Piano, Drums, Guitar, Strings, Melody, Soloist, and Thru). Once assigned, these instruments can be quickly
and easily set.
Always use General MIDI instrument numbers, even if you use a custom patch map. It will handle the conversion
to your synth’s non-GM patch numbers, so you should always enter GM patch numbers for the favorite instruments.
(Favorite Instruments)
32
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
Selecting Favorite Instruments (Patches)
To select a Favorite Instrument for a particular part, you need to select the instrument part by clicking on the desired
part.
Then click on one of the 10 Favorite buttons.
The Favorite Instrument that was assigned to one of the numbers between 1
and 10 will appear in the Instrument Panel.
Selecting Favorite Combos
To send one of the Favorite Combo patch changes, you need to select the “Combo” part by clicking on the Combo
button.
Then click on one of the 10 Favorite buttons.
The Favorite Combo that was assigned to one of the numbers between 1 and 10 will appear in the Instrument Panel.
This section allows you to adjust the settings for Reverb, Chorus, Panning, Bank, and Volume, Audio Reverb, and
Tone for instrument parts. Click on the top half of a number to raise it by one, and on the bottom half to reduce it by
one. Or click on the vertical bars to the right of the number box to raise/lower the setting in increments of 5.
You can also select a control and assign it a number value by
clicking a key on the piano keyboard. The value will correspond
to the MIDI note number, from 0 to 127, that you click.
Higher Bank Patches
The [+] button on the instrument selection panel will give you easy access to patches on higher banks.
These are selected from a .PAT file that corresponds to your synth or sound module.
We have included many .PAT files in the Synth Kits folder.
Press the [+] button to launch the Patches on Higher Banks dialog. To narrow your search you can do one or all of
the following:
- Open the Patch list and select an instrument (i.e. Electric Bass, Acoustic Piano, etc.)
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
33
-
Click on the “Include Family” checkbox to have other offerings of similar type shown. (i.e., all Bass family
patches, all keyboard family patches, etc.)
Find a patch by keyword by clicking the [Search..] button and typing some letters that you know are in the
name, e.g., “mando” will find your mandolin patch and any others containing “mando.”
Note: You can open a new patch file by pressing the [Open *.PAT…] button. You can also customize the names and descriptions
of the patch file list to suit your tastes by pressing the [Edit…] button and editing a small text file. Press the [Update] button for your
changes to take effect. You can also open this window by selecting the M | Choose Patch from Higher Bank… menu item at the
bottom of the menu.
Description of the Wizard
The Wizard is an intelligent play along feature that uses your QWERTY keyboard to play along with
Band-in-a-Box. This also allows you to record to the melody or soloist track without an external MIDI
keyboard,
and can even be used to trigger the Soloist Wizard. Also, play along using the Wizard can use the harmony feature,
so you can play along live from your QWERTY keyboard in 4-part Saxophone harmony for example.
Turning the Wizard On/Off
Click on the [Wz] box to turn the Wizard feature On/Off, or select the Wizard Playalong option from
the Song menu, or press Option+W. The Wizard is only active during playback.
Playing the Wizard
The Wizard keys are active during playback. The active keys are the lower 2 rows of the keyboard.
Changing Instruments / Settings For The Wizard
The Wizard is a play along instrument, so is treated just like the THRU instrument. Changing
Instruments/Volume/Reverb etc. for the Wizard is therefore the same as for the THRU instrument. (i.e., Click on
the THRU button, then select instrument etc.) You can record the Wizard and it will use THRU harmonies if
selected.
Play Regular Notes
There is now an option to play regular “non-smart” notes, for those of you up to the task of poking out actual
melodies on your QWERTY keys.
In the Song menu, toggle Wizard Uses 'Smart' Notes “Off” (unchecked) to have the Wizard provide you access to a
chromatic scale, and toggle “on” to have Band-in-a-Box provide you with notes based on the chord/key of the song.
Soloist Wizard
Additionally, you will find another great Wizard feature in the Soloist menu, the Solo Wizard. Toggling this option
“on” enables the Soloist Wizard. As you play notes on the MIDI or QWERTY keyboard, the program will play
“correct” notes in the style of the current Soloist! This means that you can play a perfect solo every time, simply by
pressing any key on your MIDI keyboard or QWERTY keys.
Beyond impressing your friends with your newfound improvisational prowess, this feature has practical implications
as well. For example, you can concentrate on practicing your solo phrasing and playing “in time” without
concerning yourself with which notes to play. (Band-in-a-Box will supply the correct notes; see the next section for
details.)
Recording Using the Wizard
To record the Wizard, press the [Record] button to record, and play the Wizard. This will be recorded. You can
use the feature of recording the Wizard to enter music without a MIDI keyboard that doesn't sound as stiff as most
music entered in step time. This is how it works:
- Press [Record] to record.
- As the song plays, play the melody that you want on any Wizard key, using the same key for each note, in the
rhythm of the melody. The Wizard notes won't be the exact melody, but don't worry about that as you record.
- When you're finished, go to the Notation window. You now have the notes with the correct durations and
times, but the wrong pitches.
34
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
-
One by one drag the notes up to the correct melody note, holding down the Shift, Control, and Command key
for sharps, flats, and naturals respectively. You'll then have entered a melody that sounds like it was recorded
from a keyboard, without the stiff sound of a melody entered in step time!
Note: If you have the wizard on, the SPACEBAR won't stop playback. You need to press ESCAPE to stop playback if the Wizard is
on. This is because people mistakenly hit the spacebar while playing the wizard, which would stop the song inadvertently.
The Embellisher
Click on the Embellisher checkbox to enable live embellishment of the Melody or Soloist part
during playback.
When musicians see a lead sheet that has a melody written out, they would almost never play it exactly as written.
They would change the timing to add syncopation, change durations to achieve staccato or legato playing, add grace
notes, slurs, extra notes, vibrato, and other effects.
If you enable the Embellisher, any Melody will get embellished as it is played so that you hear a livelier, more
realistic Melody - and it's different every time.
Click on the Embellisher
toolbar button to open the
Melody Embellisher dialog.
The Memo shows the current
embellishments that have been
applied. You can change
settings and redo the
embellishment, or you can
make the current
embellishment permanent.
The Embellisher is only active while the music is playing, it doesn't permanently affect the Melody track. There is
an option to make the Embellishment permanent, so that if you like a certain embellishment you can add it to the
Melody track. This is especially useful to spice up songs that have been entered in step time with “robotic”
velocities and durations of notes. Using the Embellisher makes it sound like a person was playing instead of a
computer!
Toolbars
The main toolbar extends the full width of the screen. (It is divided in two here.)
The [New] button clears the Chordsheet to start a new song. Band-in-a-Box reminds you to save your
work before it erases the chords.
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
35
The [Open] button is used to open (load) songs into the program from the Open File dialog.
The [Save] button is used to disk.
This saves the song, allowing you to choose or confirm the name and location for the file save.
The [Save +] button opens the Assign Instruments and Harmonies to Song dialog where custom
patches, harmonies, and other settings can be permanently saved with the song.
Use this button to Start/End DAW plug-in mode and choose options such as “Allow Drag and Drop.”
In plug-in mode, Band-in-a-Box is reduced to a small window and acts as a plug-in for your favorite
DAW/sequencer.
The [.MID] button allows you to make a Standard MIDI File and save it to disk as a file with extension
.MID. Type 0 and Type 1 MIDI files are supported, or you can also choose to save the song as a
Karaoke file with the .KAR extension.
This is the “Render to WAV file” button, which will convert (render) your MIDI arrangement to an
audio wave file. It includes a batch render feature to convert an entire folder of songs in a single
operation.
Transport Controls
These buttons are like the transport controls on a CD player or a media player.
[Play] button generates a new arrangement and plays the song.
[Loop] plays the selected (highlighted) section of the Chordsheet in a loop.
[Replay] plays the song from the beginning without creating a new arrangement.
[Stop] button stops the song or the Jukebox from playing.
[Pause] button pauses the song during playback.
[From] button is used to play a song starting anywhere in the song, including tags or endings.
[Rec] button records MIDI from an external keyboard or the Wizard to the Melody track.
This opens the RealDrums Picker, where you can assign audio drums to replace the MIDI drums
with a real drummer.
This opens the Assign RealTracks to Tracks dialog. RealTracks are audio instruments other than
drums, such as RealPedalSteel, RealAcousticGuitar, and RealSax.
The [Melodist] button opens the Generate Chords and/or Melody dialog, where you can choose
the type (or genre) of Melodist you wish to have generate a complete new song with chord changes
and melody as well as an improvised solo and an original song title.
The [Soloist] button opens the Select Soloist Dialog, where you can choose the Soloist you wish to
have play over any given chord changes.
This button opens the Notation window, where you can edit, view, and print MIDI notation.
36
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
Use the Print button to launch the Print Options dialog and print the currently selected track of
notation.
Displays the notes being played on a virtual guitar fretboard. Select the track that you want to
display.
The Drum button launches an animated virtual Drum Kit window. Play along or watch drums light
up as they are played.
The [Intro] feature creates a chord progression that gets inserted as an introduction for the song.
The Audio Chord Wizard program (/Applications/Band-in-a-Box/Audio Chord Wizard)
automatically figures out the chords from audio files such as MP4, M4A, AIFF, WAV, and CD
audio.
The [Pref] button will bring up a Preferences dialog where you can set various settings and access
program options.
This button sends out an “all notes off” message to your MIDI or software synthesizer. It functions
as a “panic” button to stop a hung or stuck note.
This opens up the pgmusic.com website to the page with video tutorials for learning Band-in-a-Box.
Opens the Band-in-a-Box PDF manual, which is in the /Manuals folder.
Additional Toolbar buttons
When playing songs in the Jukebox, this arrow will jump back to the previous song in the list.
The Jukebox plays a folder of songs according to the specified options. The [JukeBox] button is
used to start or stop the Jukebox.
When playing songs in the Jukebox, this arrow will jump ahead to the next song in the list.
This button resets General MIDI devices by sending a GM mode On message and then setting up
the Band-in-a-Box patches.
This launches a Finder folder in the current song folder. You can open up songs by doubleclicking on songs from the finder.
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
37
This opens the previous song in the folder in alphabetical order.
This opens the next song in the folder in alphabetical order.
This allows you to freeze any or all tracks so that Band-in-a-Box will not overwrite them
with new arrangements. Tracks play back instantly. You can still edit the tracks yourself.
This launches the Reverb Settings dialog with setting for the type and amount of reverb to
use. These settings apply only to the RealTracks, as there is a separate MIDI reverb control.
The Reharmonist creates a chord progression based only on the melody of the song. It can
also reharmonize existing chord progressions.
The grace note button opens the Melody Embellisher dialog for customizing the Melody
Embellisher.
Press the ChdSolo button to launch the Generate Guitar Chord Solo dialog. Based on the
existing Melody track, this generates a guitar chord solo using correct guitar fret positions.
This button connects to the www.pgmusic.com web site.
The Song Title button auto-generates a song title for the current song. Each time it is
pressed, a new title is generated.
This launches the Chord Builder window. Chords may be auditioned and then entered into
the Chordsheet by clicking in the menus in this dialog.
Use these buttons to jump to the next page in the Chordsheet. Each page is 64 bars, for a
total of 256 bars.
Title Window
In the Title window you can create a Song Title, change the Style of the song, change the Key Signature the song
is using, define the Tempo of the song, define where the Chorus begins and ends and how many Choruses the
song has. To change these settings, click on the setting you wish to change.
Favorite and Recently Played Songs and Styles
The [F] buttons beside the song title and style name launch the Favorites / Recently Played
dialog. This allows you to quickly load songs and styles that have been used in your last sessions
with Band-in-a-Box.
38
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
You may find this to be the best way to load songs into Band-in-a-Box, since the lists give you instant access to the
songs you are most likely to be playing, regardless of where the song is located on your hard drive. (File | Open
Favorite Songs... or Shift+F3 also opens this window.)
The dialog for these favorites has separate lists of “Recently Played” and “Favorite” songs or styles.
The “Favorites” and “Recently Played” Radio buttons toggle
between a list of your recently played songs (or styles), and a list you
create of your Favorite you select as favorite songs or styles. You can add an unlimited number of favorites.
The favorites list will start off as an empty one, but you can add songs/styles as your
favorites, by clicking the [Add Favorite] button. (This button is in the StylePicker too.)
Technical Note: The list of songs/style favorites is stored in a text file called SongFavorites.txt (or StyleFavorites.txt) in the
Band-in-a-Box folder.
If “Play When Chosen” is checked the program will load and play a song when you either double-click on its name
in the list or select the name and the click [OK].
Check “OK To Add recent files...” to allow your recently loaded songs to be added to this list.
The [Search] button lets you search the Favorite Songs list by typing in part of a file name.
Press the [Song] button (or Ctrl+F3) to launch the Select song by Title window, described in full
elsewhere in this manual.
Tip: Click the “Play when selected” checkbox at the bottom of the song list window to have Band-in-a-Box play your song
immediately upon selection.
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
39
Like the favorite songs button, the favorite styles button [F] activates dialogs with “Favorites” and “Recently
Played” Radio buttons that toggle between a list of your recently played styles and your favorite songs styles.
Click the “Play When Chosen” checkbox to have Band-in-a-Box play your song immediately upon selecting a style.
The menu command User | Open Favorite Styles... or hot keys Shift+F9 also open this window.
You get to the StylePicker window by pressing the [Style] button or with the keystrokes Ctrl+F9.
This feature is fully explained elsewhere in this manual.
This is the song memo button. A red border indicates that the song has a memo. There are
automatically generated memos describing the song, and you can type in your own memos too.
This opens the Additional Song Settings dialog with settings that apply to the current song for rests,
pushes, tags, endings, and fadeouts.
Harmony Area
The Harmony area displays the current Melody and Thru Harmony.
The [M] button is for Melody Harmony - in this case, it's set to trumpet/trombone (3rds) harmony. Whatever the
melody plays will come out with trumpet/trombone harmony in thirds. Pressing the [f] button allows you to choose
from a list of only your most frequently used harmonies. Pressing the [M] button allows you to choose from the full
list of harmonies. The F10 key disables the Melody harmony.
The [T] button is for Thru harmony. Whatever you play along on your MIDI keyboard while the song is playing
will be auto-harmonized in real time - in this case using a Tenor Banjo type harmony. Pressing the [f] button allows
you to choose from a list of only your most frequently used harmonies. Pressing the [T] button allows you to
choose from the full list of harmonies. The keystrokes Ctrl+F10 disable the Thru harmony.
Chordsheet Area
Chord Entry
The basic way of entering a song in Band-in-a-Box is by typing in the chords to the song using the computer
keyboard. Chords are typed in using standard chord symbols (like C or Fm7 or Bb7 or Bb13#9/E).
Chords can be cut, pasted, and copied from one location to another.
Another way of entering chords is through MIDI chord recognition. Play any chord on your MIDI keyboard; and
Band-in-a-Box will recognize it instantly and insert it onto the Chordsheet. This allows you to enter an entire song
without having to type in any of the chords!
To use this feature, select the Insert current MIDI chord from the MIDI menu. Ctrl+Enter is the keystroke
combination for this function.
The chord you choose will automatically be inserted into your song (Chordsheet or notation view) at the current
cursor location. Then, Band-in-a-Box is ready for the next chord. You can insert up to two chords per bar in this
fashion.
Chord Display Modes
In addition to the Standard Notation window, you can also enter or display chords in Roman Numeral notation,
Nashville notation, Solfeggio notation, or Fixed Do notation.
40
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
For example, the chord Gm7 in the key of F would be displayed as IIm7 (in Roman Numeral Notation), 2m7 (in
Nashville Notation), and Rem7 in Solfeggio. In Italy and other parts of Europe, chords like C7 are always referred to
by the Solfeggio name (“Do 7” for C7) regardless of the key signature.
These systems are very useful for learning or analyzing tunes, because they are independent of the key signature.
This setting is made in the “Chord Display Type” list box in the
Preferences dialog.
When a new notation mode is selected, a message will report the change
on the main screen. Click anywhere in the message box to close it.
Part Markers
Style variations for your arrangement are entered in the Chordsheet by clicking on a bar number to set a part marker.
Each click toggles to the next available substyle part marker (a, b, etc.) or removes the part marker. Regular styles
have two substyles, and Band-in-a-Box MultiStyles have four substyle variations – a, b, c, and d.
Adding Substyles in a Song
You can add more substyles to an individual song with a right-click on any bar number. This opens the Substyle
Change Menu where you can define up to 24 substyles, from “a” to “x.”
…
Making a MultiStyle
You can make your own MultiStyles from existing styles in the StyleMaker, which opens with the menu commands
User | Make A New Style (STYLE MAKER and User | Edit Existing User Style or with the hot keys Option+Y.
From within the StyleMaker, press the [PATCH] button. The Misc. Style Settings dialog box
opens. Look for the “Multistyle(s)” box.
Enter the name of a style, such as zzjazz, or multiple styles separated by semicolons, for example
zzjazz;zzbossa and these will appear as MultiStyles, substyles c/d/e/f etc.
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
41
You can click on the [STY] button to choose the styles for your MultiStyle from the StylePicker window.
Chordsheet Editing Features
The chordsheet has a contextual menu that opens with Control+click or a right-click in the Chordsheet area. This
menu is a very convenient way to access the features for editing song arrangements.
Chords can be copied, pasted, cut, or erased
and new chords can be entered from the Chord
Builder.
The Chord Settings allow pushes, rests, and
pedal bass to be applied.
The Bar Settings let you refine your
arrangement with changes in tempo, meter, key
signature, styles, RealDrums, volume levels,
patches, and harmonies.
Song Settings allow rests and pushes, and also
control tags, endings, and fadeouts.
Global system settings are accessed in the
Preferences.
You can also right-click on a bar in the
Chordsheet to set it as the beginning or end of
the chorus or the end of the song from the
settings in the context menu.
For example, these settings are available with a
right-click on bar 16.
This menu can be used to start playback from
the highlighted bar in any chorus of the song.
Play Song from Chordsheet
Songs can be played from any location in the Chordsheet with a double click on any bar. Playback will start at the
bar where the mouse is clicked.
If a tag or an ending is defined, press the <spacebar> or double click on the ending bar (or a bar in the tag), and the
song will play from the ending (or tag). This only applies to the Chordsheet, since notation windows always play
from the ending or tag already.
42
Chapter 4: The Main Screen
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
You can arrange, record, save, and print your own song ideas with Band-in-a-Box. Just type in the chords to any
song; choose a style and press [Play] to hear the “band” play a full arrangement. Have some fun by changing to
different styles. For even more fun record a MIDI Melody – or have Band-in-a-Box write a Melody for you. Add
Harmony, an automatically improvised Soloist, an Intro, and print out a lead sheet and play along.
Loading and Playing Songs
Band-in-a-Box has a number of menu commands to open song files, such as the File | Open song, with several
different filters, or Song | Go (Open and Play). The SongPicker opens with the File | Open Song by Title menu
command, which launches the Select Song by Title dialog.
Band-in-a-Box songs with the .SGU file extension are backup arrangements with no melodies. Songs with a MIDI
melody track have the file extension .MGU.
Select a folder and open a song in the Open Song dialog. It’s even more convenient to just
click on the main screen [Song] button to Select Song by Title from the list of songs in the
current folder. This SongPicker list can include up to 25,000 songs.
Use the [Folder] button to select another folder, for example, to select from all of your RealTracks demo songs.
The first time that you select the [Song] button Band-in-a-Box automatically writes the song list for the folder.
From then on, the song list opens when the [Song] button is selected.
If you’ve added some new songs to a folder just click on [Rebuild List] and the
SongPicker will add their titles to the list.
Check “Play when selected” to automatically play the song selected.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
43
There is also a Find feature to help you locate songs in the list.
Click on the [Find] button and then type in the word you want
to search for and click on Find.
[Find Again] repeats your search.
Start song playback. Alternative methods are to double click on any bar in the Chordsheet, including the
tag or ending if defined, or by pressing the spacebar.
Stop song playback. Pressing the spacebar also stops playback.
Pause the song with the [Pause] button; resume by pressing it again.
Jump to any bar in the song.
Press the [From] button to choose which chorus and bar number to jump to.
For even more fun, play along with the band! Once you have selected a song, you’ll see the chords in the
Chordsheet, so it’s easy to read and play along.
Play along with your MIDI Controller Keyboard
If you have an external MIDI keyboard controller connected to your computer system, you can use the MIDI THRU
features to play along with the program.
The Thru part is the part that you play along on your MIDI keyboard or with the Wizard feature. It can be
harmonized by pressing the [T] button in the Harmony area of the main screen.
44
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Select Thru Harmony
Press the [T] button or use the keystrokes Command+T to open the Select Thru Harmony dialog. Whatever you
play along on your MIDI keyboard while the song is playing will be auto-harmonized in real time - in this case using
a Tenor Banjo type harmony.
The Thru Harmony is also applied to Soloist parts when the option to Allow Soloist Harmony (on Thru) is selected
in the Soloist menu.
For example, you could add a SuperSax harmony to a saxophone soloist to create the effect of a full saxophone
section.
This button opens the Harmony Maker, where you can customize Harmonists.
This button is to turn off any notes that are stuck on. (There shouldn’t be any.)
Enter the number of the harmony you want to go to and press [Go To #].
Favorite Thru Harmony
This option brings up your favorite 50 Harmony styles (based on recent usage) and allows you to choose one to use
on the Thru or Soloist track. It opens from the Harmony | Favorite Thru Harmonies menu item or by pressing either
the [F] button next to the Thru Harmony box or the [Favs] button in the Select Thru Harmony dialog. Or you can
use the keystrokes Control+F11 to open the Favorite Thru Harmony dialog directly from the main screen.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
45
Pressing the [T] button allows you to choose from the full list of harmonies.
Normalize MIDI
If performing live, or at a jam session, it helps to have the volume of all of the songs be similar. With the
Normalize MIDI feature, you can level the volumes to a range set in the program options. For example, you can set
all volumes to be between 65 and 75, and the program will make each song play within those levels. This is done in
the Preferences 2 tab.
Transpose THRU Part (live playing on MIDI keyboard)
This feature opens with the menu command MIDI | Thru Transpose Settings.
When playing along on your MIDI keyboard, you can set Band-in-a-Box to "“Transpose by"” semitones and/or
octaves.
You can define a favorite key and “Each time a song is loaded” Band-in-a-Box will optionally transpose any and all
loaded songs to that key. This is a great feature for practicing in a certain key.
You can also automatically transpose the Thru part so that you can always play along in your favorite key regardless
of the actual key of the song.
The default is “No Transpose,” so the [Default] button sets all fields to 0.
If you are playing along while changing these settings, the [Update] button will apply the changes you have made
so you can hear the difference.
[Do it now] sends your transpose settings for either the song or the Thru part, as selected.
Change the Style
The hundreds of musical styles available for Band-in-a-Box include lots of variations for any style you choose. You
can even use several styles in the same song by pressing the F5 function key on the computer to open the “Edit Bar
Settings” dialog to change the style at any bar.
Try different styles by clicking on the [Style] button to choose from the StylePicker. The current
prototype style is shown in the title bar.
The prototype can be selected with the [Change Prototype Style] button. Another option is to have the prototype
default to the current style by selecting that checkbox.
Styles with a similar feel to the prototype will be indicated with an (*) asterisk. These would be styles that have the
same feel (triplets/ eighth/ sixteenths) and a similar tempo range. Styles that have a similar feel but a different
tempo range are marked by a (^) caret symbol. Choose the “Show Styles” filter to display all styles, or only styles
that match the prototype partially or fully. With the “Disk #” filter, you can view just the styles from on styles set
disk.
46
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Change the Sound
Band-in-a-Box has several instrument parts - Bass, Piano, Drums, Guitar, Solo, Strings, Melody, and Thru. You can
change patches on any part.
The easiest way to change patches on a part is to select the part by clicking on the desired part to change.
Click on the Instrument Panel box. You will then see a menu of 128 instrument names. This list is the General
MIDI patch list. Scroll down the list to find your patch.
Or click on the numbered buttons below the Instrument Panel box to
choose from the 10 most common instruments chosen for that particular
part.
If you have a General MIDI module, or any of the units that have a patch file for higher banks (*.PAT
file) listed for them, then press the '+' button on the main screen to choose the .PAT file from the
Synthkits folder. This is an especially useful feature if you have a synthesizer or sound source that has patches on
higher banks beyond the basic 128 General MIDI instruments. The window that appears when you click on this
button looks like this:
This will provide you with a list of all the patches available to you by name on the left, and where the patch is
located (patch #, bank) on the right.
Add RealDrums
The RealDrums feature replaces MIDI drums with audio drums recorded live by top studio drummers. RealDrums
can be set to replace MIDI drums in all songs, or they can be assigned to just one song at a time.
Click on the [RealDrms] toolbar button for a menu with options to go either to the RealDrums Picker
dialog or to the RealDrums Preferences.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
47
Use the RealDrums Picker to choose RealDrums for the current song only.
The RealDrums Picker opens from the toolbar menu or the Windows | RealDrums Picker menu
command.
It can also be opened from the RealDrums Settings dialog by selecting “For this song only, use this
RealDrum style” and a click on the [RD] button.
Another option is to right click (or Control+click or double click) on the Drums part to open the
contextual menu. Then select the Choose RealDrums menu command.
A filter is available. Type a filter text, (e.g. bossa) and press [Update], and
you will then see the list filtered to show only RealDrums that have the
word bossa somewhere in the title, memo, genre, etc.
Multiple search terms work with the RealDrums Picker. If you separate
terms with a space, each term will be searched separately.
So a search for "“Bossa Rock Ev 120” will find any Bossa Rock styles with an Even feel that would work with a
tempo of close to 120. Adding a search term that has a number will filter for RealTracks that match the tempo or
within a compatible range.
Pressing [Show All] will cancel the filter, and show all RealDrums again.
There are additional settings to define your selection in the RealDrums Picker.
“Show if Tempo is out of Range” will show styles that wouldn’t work well at the current song tempo. The
acceptable range is shown in the list of styles Lo/Hi (9th and 10th) columns.
48
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
“Show if Feel does not match” will show a song where the drums are in Even feel and the style is Swing (or vice
versa).
“Show RealDrums that are not favorites.” You can assign a style as one of your favorites by clicking in the first
column. Then you can sort by favorites or use this option to only see favorites.
“Show RealDrums that are N/A.” These are styles not found in the Drums folder, likely because they are add-on
styles not purchased yet. Press the [Rebuild] button and check the RealDrums Settings to confirm that you have the
correct drums folder selected.
“For this song only, force MIDI drums.” Set this if you want MIDI drums and want to override a RealDrums that
is set in the style.
“Memo” is a memo description of the style. These are stored in the Band-in-a-Box/Data/RDPGMemos.txt file. You
can also add your own memos in the User Comments box below.
This shows the current RealDrums for this song.
This sets the drums to no RealDrums override for the song, and optionally also forces MIDI drums (i.e., no
RealDrums for the style either).
The RealDrums list can be sorted by any of the column headings.
Click on this button to enter an asterisk beside the current selection in the list, indicating that this is a
favorite style.
Click on the name of the RealDrums style name that you want to select for the song. Names ending in a caret ^ have
variations available.
- ^ Clicking in the caret column will show the variations for the selected RealDrums style (if available).
- Genre is the type of music that the RealDrums style comes from, such as Jazz, Rock, or Country.
- Genre (more) suggests additional types of music that the RealDrums style might work for.
- /4 indicates the time signature, which is 4/4 by default. If the column is empty the time signature is 4/4, if
there is a 3 in this column the time signature is 3/4.
- Ev indicates the feel of the RealDrums style, either Even or Swing.
- The listing in the 8 column indicates whether the meter is based on eighth notes (8) or sixteenth notes (16).
- Lo is the slowest tempo for which the RealDrums style is suited.
- Hi is the fastest tempo recommended for the style.
- X indicates a style with a tempo that is out of range for the song.
- N/A are styles not found in the drums folder.
You can type in your own comments about any style in the
“User comments” field and they are saved.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
49
RealDrums styles ending in a caret (^) have variations available. They are
listed here. Where there are two instruments shown, such as
Brushes/Sticks, the first one plays in the “a” substyle and the second in the
“b” substyle.
[PlayNow] loads the selected RealDrums and starts playback.
The [Stop] button stops the song playback. Click on [PlayNow] to resume.
The [Audition] button doesn’t load the style but instead uses Media Player to play a demo .AIFF file for the style.
[Settings] opens the RealDrums Settings dialog.
[Rebuild] builds the list of RealDrums present as folders in the Drums folder. If you add new drum styles, press
this button to update the list. RealDrums made by you (or others) that are added by you add to the RealDrums folder
also appear in the RealDrums Picker dialog.
[Defaults] returns the dialog to default settings, which will show all available styles.
Press [OK] to make your selection and return to the song.
Press [Cancel] to return to the song without making a selection.
RealDrums Settings
RealDrums are enabled/disabled in the RealDrums Settings dialog, which opens by clicking on the
[RealDrms] toolbar button and choosing RealDrums Preferences from the menu.
This dialog also has settings for using RealDrums to replace MIDI drums in Band-in-a-Box styles. It is described
fully in the RealDrums topic.
Add RealTracks
Just as RealDrums replace the MIDI drum track with live audio recordings of top session drummers, RealTracks add
“real” instruments recorded by top studio players and recording artists.
RealTracks can play shots, holds, and pushes as entered in the Chordsheet. Many of them play 4-bar endings
(instead of 2-bar) to allow for the natural decay of the instrument, and there are free patches adding this feature to
earlier RealTracks sets. They are available at http://www.pgmusic.com/support_macintosh_realdrums.htm.
The RealTracks toolbar button opens the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog (RealTracks Picker).
This dialog also opens from the main screen contextual menus, which
open with a right click, Control+click, or double click on any part name.
Then click on the Choose RealTracks menu command to assign a
RealTracks instrument to the selected part.
50
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Click on the [Settings] button to open the RealTracks Settings dialog.
In the RealTracks Settings dialog you can Enable/Disable the RealTracks feature.
This is where the global settings are made that affect all RealTracks instruments and RealCharts notation.
Audio Reverb
There is a reverb control, labeled A.REV, for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can easily
add reverb (0 to 127) for any RealTrack.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
51
You’ll see the “A.REV” (Audio Reverb) control at the top of the screen. Click on an instrument
radio button to select a part, and then set the Audio Reverb for it.
Note that this only applies to RealTracks, since MIDI tracks have MIDI Reverb, which is set via a
“REV” control.
The Audio Reverb varies from 0 to 127. Adjust the value by clicking a key on the on-screen piano keyboard. Or
right-click (or Ctrl+click) the control to enter a value.
The Reverb type is also settable, and saved with the song. To do this, press the Audio Reverb button,
and adjust the various parameters.
The default is a “room” type of reverb.
Freeze Tracks
Freezing (locking) MIDI or RealTracks/RealDrums
Any track (MIDI or RealTrack) can be frozen. When frozen, it won’t be changed or re-generated.
You can make tracks Frozen by pressing the Freeze button (snowflake) on the toolbar, and then choosing
which tracks that you want to freeze or unfreeze.
52
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
This saves time when replaying previous songs, and allows you
to freeze an arrangement that you like. If you freeze the whole
song, you don’t have to wait at all for the song to regenerate.
Next time you play, it is ready to go.
Click on the snowflake button again to reopen the Freeze/UnFreeze menu when you want to un-freeze an individual track or
all tracks.
Add a Melody
Band-in-a-Box is much more than an arranger and accompanist. You can also record
your live MIDI performance to the Melody track, enter a Melody in the Notation noteby-note, or use the Wizard to record from your computer keyboard.
Enable the Embellisher, and the Melody will be embellished as it is played. You’ll hear a livelier,
more realistic Melody - and it's different every time.
The Embellisher is only active while the music is playing; it doesn't permanently affect the Melody track.
Harmonize the Melody
The Select Melody Harmony dialog box allows you to choose from any of the pre-defined harmonies and even
allows you to define your own.
Press the [M] button next to the piano keyboard
to add a harmony to the Melody track.
Press the [M] button next to the piano keyboard to add a harmony to the Melody track.
This dialog also opens with the Harmony | Melody Harmony menu item or with the keystrokes Command+H.
This button opens the Harmony Maker, where you can customize Harmonists.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
53
This button is to turn off any notes that are stuck on. (There shouldn’t be any.)
Enter the number of the harmony you want to go to and press [Go To #].
Favorite Melody Harmony
This option brings up your favorite 50 Harmony styles (based on recent usage) and allows you to choose one to use
on the Melody track. It opens from the Harmony | Favorite Melody Harmonies menu item or by pressing either the
[F] button next to the Melody Harmony box or the [Favs] button in the Select Melody Harmony dialog.
You can go directly to the Favorite Melody Harmony dialog from the main screen with the keystrokes
Control+F10.
Play along with the Wizard
The Wizard is an intelligent play along feature that is controlled with the bottom two rows your
computer’s QWERTY keyboard. The bottom row of keys plays chord tones, the second row plays passing tones you play any key in either row and never make a mistake!
Add a Solo
That’s right! Band-in-a-Box can “solo like a pro” in over 200 styles.
Use the [Soloist] button on the main screen to open the Select Soloist dialog box and choose from
hundreds of soloist profiles, including RealTracks for authentic live audio solos. The RealTracks
soloists start at #361 in the list.
54
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Use the preset Soloist settings, or choose your own Solo Mode and the Choruses where you want a solo. The
Soloist Maker [Edit…] button gives access to the advanced settings in the Soloist Editor where you can edit existing
profiles or create new Soloists of your own.
To see the Soloist part play in standard music notation open the Notation window and press the [S]
button at the far right of the row of instrument buttons.
View and Print Notation
The notation feature in Band-in-a-Box makes it possible to follow the music onscreen as it plays, but it also does
much more. We’ll use the song OLDFOLKS.MGU from the Songs folder to explore the Notation window.
Click on the [Open] button in the toolbar to launch the Open Song dialog. From the /Band-in-a-Box
/Songs folder select OLDFOLKS.MGU and load it into Band-in-a-Box
Let’s have a look at the Notation window!
Press the “note” button to launch the Notation (or press ^+N).
You’ll now see this Notation window.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
55
Chords Line
Just as in the Chordsheet, you can type in chords using the same keystrokes. The chords will be
entered at the location marked by the Current Time Indicator Line.
Use the Right /Left cursor keys to move back and forth from bar to bar, and the Up/ Down cursor keys to move from
screen to screen.
Change The Mode Of The Notation Window
There are 3 modes: Standard Notation, Editable Notation, and Staff Roll.
Band-in-a-Box offers multiple modes of notation for different purposes. The notation defaults to Standard Notation
mode, other modes are selected with the [N] button on the Notation window toolbar.
Pressing the button toggles through the three different modes.
Standard Notation is to display or print notation and enter chords. It shows the grand piano staff with notes and
chord symbols.
The Standard Notation window displays the notation for any individual track, and allows for the entry of chords.
Features include:
- Notation display for the Bass, Drums, Guitar, Piano, Strings, Melody, or Soloist track.
- As the notation plays, the notes that are sounding are highlighted in red. This helps with sight reading or
following the music.
- You can set the notation to scroll either 1 or 2 bars ahead of the music without interfering with your view of the
current notation.
- Standard notation handles Jazz eighth notes and triplet figures correctly.
- Automatic options such as auto durations, clean notation, mono display, minimize rests, hard rests, and engraver
spacing produce very musical and readable notation.
Enter the Editable Notation mode from the notation screen with a single mouse click on the [N] button. This is a
special staff with time divisions for mouse-based editing.
56
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
In the Editable Notation mode you can enter, move, and edit notes and rests using standard mouse techniques – point
and click, and drag and drop.
This is the screen for step-entry of a melody or for editing existing parts. The grid of vertical lines that sub-divides
each beat indicates where the notes will be placed according to the resolution of the song. Holding the Shift, Ctrl,
or Alt key as you click on a note forces a sharp, flat, or natural respectively.
Resolution
- Swing styles use 3 lines to divide each beat into eighth note swing triplets.
- Straight styles use 4 lines to divide each beat into sixteenth notes.
Band-in-a-Box has automatically sets the grid resolution to 3 per beat (triplets) or 4 per beat. This resolution can be
changed in the Notation Options dialog, but the program automatically sets the resolution to the correct value based
upon the Band-in-a-Box style that is currently in use.
Click the [N] button again to enter Staff Roll Notation. In this view, you can enter or edit notes, as well as the note
velocity and duration. The note heads are shown with editable velocity and duration lines.
This mode is similar to the Editable Notation mode, except that the beats begin right on the bar line. You can see
the duration of the note visually represented by a horizontal blue (or green) line and the note’s velocity displayed as
a vertical line of the same color.
Tip: If you can't see these lines, press the [Opt.] button to check that “Show Note Durations, Show Velocity Lines,” and
“Show Bar/Beat Lines” options are enabled.
Using the Mouse to Edit Velocity and Duration
Place the mouse cursor on the note head and hold down the Option button on the computer keyboard. Then,
starting at the note head, drag the cursor horizontally to set the note's duration, or vertically to set the note's velocity.
Let’s print the song OLDFOLKS.MGU.
Press the [Print] button on the Notation window, or the Print icon on the main screen, or press
Ctrl+P to launch the Print Options dialog box.
It is very likely that Band-in-a-Box has made all the correct settings for you.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
57
You should make sure to select the print range of first chorus, to print only the first chorus of the song.
Take a peek at your printer setup to ensure that you have the correct printer specified.
Then press [OK – Print]. You will then get a printout of OLDFOLKS.MGU. This printout
has been automatically scaled to fit on one page, and is done lead sheet style. You can of
course change the options.
Now, get back to the Notation window. As the song is playing, let’s display other instruments beside the Melody.
These buttons stand for Bass, Drums, Piano, Guitar,
Strings, Melody, and Soloist. The selected part (Bass) is
highlighted in color. Get back to the Melody track, by pressing the [M] button. Ctrl+Shift+F5 is
the hot key that allows you to switch tracks using keystrokes.
Try turning the Clean function on/off. “Clean” notation is an intelligent mode that eliminates grace
notes and unusual notation, producing a cleaner and much more readable notation.
This allows you to play in melodies using grace notes, and normal playing, without worrying that the notation won’t
display cleanly.
Let’s close the Notation window, by pressing the “note” button again. This returns us to the familiar
Band-in-a-Box screen.
58
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Play the Jukebox
Use the Jukebox for continuous playback of a list of Band-in-a-Box songs. Click the [JukeBox] button
to open the Juke Box Options dialog, a list of options that controls how the songs in the chosen
directory are played.
When you have chosen the options you want, click [PLAY JUKE BOX] to play all the songs in the selected
directory folder.
Use the Preview feature to automatically audition a complete directory of songs by playing a part of each song and
then moving on to the next one, or use the [<] and [>] cursor buttons to navigate manually through the list of juke
box songs.
Automatic Songs - “The Melodist”
Feel like composing a brand new song?
With Band-in-a-Box you can compose a new song, in the style of your choice complete with intro, chords, melody,
arrangement and improvisations, all created by the program! All you have to do is pick from one of the Melodists
and press [OK] - the program then automatically generates the intro, chords, melody, and arrangement in the chosen
style. It even auto-generates a title!
You can go from nothing to a completed song in less than 1 second! Once the song is generated, the chords and
melody are part of the regular Band-in-Box tracks, so may be edited, printed, and saved as with any other song!
You can also auto-regenerate any part of a song and modify it to suit you. The Melodist will also generate a melody
over an existing chord progression. A Melodist “Juke Box” mode creates and performs new compositions in
succession.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
59
Aside from the compositional values of the Melodist, the features can be used as a powerful practicing aid improving sight reading by reading the melodies generated in various keys, and ear training - improving your “ear”
by playing along with the chord progressions in the generated songs.
Launching the Melodist
To launch the Melodist, press the [Melodist] button on the main screen, or use the Shift+F5 hot keys.
Import a MIDI File
With the amazing Band-in-a-Box Chord Wizard, you can convert any MIDI file into a Band-in-a-Box song,
complete with Melody and Solo parts.
MIDI File Chord Interpretation Wizard
Many people who play music by ear think of songs in terms of “Chords and Melody.” However many MIDI files
lack chord symbols, so they become difficult to learn without the user having to figure out the chords in a time
consuming process.
Now you can open up any MIDI file in Band-in-a-Box, and Band-in-a-Box will automatically figure out the chords
of the song for you. It automatically analyzes the MIDI file, figures out where the Bass, Piano, Melody, and other
tracks are, and then figures out the chord changes for the song. The chords are written onto the Band-in-a-Box
chordsheet like any other song. This allows you to quickly learn how to play a song from a MIDI file - just read it
60
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
into Band-in-a-Box and you'll see the chord symbols, and then learn the melody! You can also read tracks into the
Melody and Soloist tracks.
To import the chords from a MIDI file, blank the Chordsheet, by choosing File | New. Then select the menu item
File | Import Chords from MIDI File or press the keystrokes (Ctrl+Option+I). This launches the Chord Wizard
dialog.
Select your MIDI file to import with the [Open (Change)…] button. The Chord Wizard will automatically detect the
settings for your song, choosing a Preset will help the Chord Wizard make the correct choices for the type of song
you are importing.
Make Your Own Songs
Now that you know how much fun it is to play music with Band-in-a-Box, you’ll be pleased to see how easy it is to
make songs of your own. This section shows you how to make a new song, with step-by-step instructions from start
to finish.
Start with a clean sheet. Use either the menu command File | New or Edit | Clear Lead sheet, or the keystrokes
Cmd+N to blank the Chordsheet.
Name the song.
Enter the title of the song by clicking in the title area.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
61
Select the Key
Click on the key select list and change the key of your song instantly. Click on “YES” to the
“OK to transpose Lead sheet?” prompt and Band-in-a-Box will automatically transpose the
entire song.
Quick Song Settings
These are enhancements for entering songs quickly. Typing special words, instead of chord names, will make the
following settings:
begin <Enter>
- sets the beginning of the chorus to the current bar
chorusend <Enter>
- sets the end of the chorus to the current bar
end <Enter>
- sets the end of the song to the current bar
tkc <Enter>
- sets key signature to C, tkbb would set it to Bb
trc <Enter>
- transposes song to key of C
t125 <Enter>
- sets tempo to 125
Entering Chords
Type in the chords
The chords we will enter are F for 1/2 a bar, Bb for 1/2 a bar, and C7 for a bar.
Mouse click on the first cell in the Chordsheet and type in the chord symbol. The chord name will appear in the
chord box. Press the return key to enter the chord on the Chordsheet and advance the chord cell ½ bar. To enter
two chords in a chord cell, type the chord names separated by a comma, e.g., f,bb. Continue until the song is
complete.
This song will have no intro, and the chorus will be 32 bars long. The chordsheet we want to end up with will look
something like this:
Copying and pasting a section of chords
Since many songs repeat the same sequence of chords throughout, a faster method to enter a song into Band-in-aBox is to COPY and PASTE the repeating chords.
Highlight a section of chords by dragging the mouse over them while holding the left mouse button. The area will
be blackened/highlighted.
Press Cmd+C, or select the Edit | Copy menu item. The highlighted area will be copied to the clipboard. It can
then be pasted back into the Chordsheet at any location, and reused as many times as you like.
Move the highlight cell to the bar that you want to paste the chords into, using the arrow keys or the mouse.
Paste the copied section with press Cmd+V command, or select the Edit | Paste menu item. The chords will then
appear at the new location. These features are also available from the Control+click or right-click contextual menu.
Chordsheet Contextual Menu
The Chordsheet has a contextual menu that opens with Control+click or a right-click on the highlighted bar in the
Chordsheet area. This menu is another convenient way to access the features for editing song arrangements.
62
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Chords can be copied, pasted, cut, or erased and new
chords can be entered from the Chord Builder.
The Chord Settings allow pushes, rests, and pedal bass to
be applied.
The Bar Settings let you refine your arrangement with
changes in tempo, meter, key signature, styles,
RealDrums, volume levels, patches, and harmonies.
Song Settings allow rests and pushes, and also control
tags, endings, and fadeouts.
Global system settings are found in the Preferences.
The highlighted bar can be set as the beginning or end of a
chorus, or as the end of the song.
Play the song from the current bar (highlighted) in any
chorus.
Choose a Style
The chords, tempo, number of repeats and other information that you enter in the Chordsheet tell Band-in-a-Box
what to play. The style you choose tells the program how to play it. When a style is loaded, the song will be played
play back in that style.
The Style Picker window allows easy selection of Styles by Category, Full Style Title, Memo, and examples of
songs that work in that style.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
63
You get to the StylePicker window by pressing the [Style] button or Ctrl+F9. This launches the
StylePicker window with lists of all of the styles you have installed in Band-in-a-Box.
The lists may be printed out. For example, you can select Jazz styles, and see all the Jazz styles in Band-in-a-Box
displayed. Then you can select a style such as GARNER.STY and see a full title, description of the style and
examples of songs appropriate to the style. You won’t have to go “hunting” for the style you want any more.
Choose the “Show Styles” filter” to display all styles, or only styles that match the prototype partially or fully.
Use the “Disk #” filter to view only the styles from one styles set disk.
The StylePicker has a filter to show/hide Real or MIDI styles. So
if you only want to see MIDI styles, or if you only want to see
styles that use some/all RealTracks, you can set this.
Category List: Use the Category list on the left to select a style category (Jazz / Pop etc.) or a style set. Click on
the list to choose.
Style List: Once chosen, you’ll see the list of styles available in that category or style set. You’ll see the name of
the style, and the file name for the style. RealStyles are styles made exclusively with RealTracks, while Styles with
RealTracks have both RealTracks and MIDI tracks. MultiStyles have additional substyle variations.
Favorites: The StylePicker has the ability to add/remove styles as favorites. A Favorite Style indication (F) shows
up for chosen styles and you can filter any list by only showing favorite styles. You can build up a list of favorite
styles, and only show them when needed.
The favorite styles are the ones that you’ve identified as favorites, either by pressing the [Add Favorite] button in
the Favorite Styles dialog, or the similar button in this StylePicker dialog.
You can make any style a favorite by clicking the [Add Favorite]
button. If you want to remove it, click the button again.
“Only Show favorites” will only show the favorite styles in any list that you have opened.
Memo and Examples: Click on a style to see a memo for the song, a list of songs that could be played using that
style, and the suggested tempo range.
Double click on the style name to exit the dialog, and load the style.
If you have added new styles to Band-in-a-Box then you can re-build this list.
This allows you to print the styles list. It copies the list to the clipboard. Then you open up your
favorite word processor (like Word for Mac, or BB Edit). Inside your word processor, select File
| Print and print the list.
The Search button helps you find data in any of the fields.
64
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Frame the song
Here we have selected bar one to be the first bar of the chorus and bar 32 to be the
last. The chorus will repeat three times before proceeding to the two bar ending.
Set the Tempo
Let’s set the tempo to 160 beats per minute. The tempo is displayed in the song title window with
a default setting of 120 beats per minute.
Click with the mouse to adjust the tempo in increments of 5 beats per minute. Clicking on the top of the numbers
increases the tempo setting, clicking on the bottom decreases it. The tempo can also be typed into the Main Settings
dialog, which opens from the menu Song | Title/Key/Tempo/Embel…, or with the keystrokes Command+K. You
can click 4 times on the metronome in this dialog to set your tempo.
Tap the Tempo
Not sure of the tempo for your song? Tap it in real time on either the [-] key or the [=] key on your computer
keyboard. Four taps on the minus key sets the tempo, four taps on the equal key sets the tempo and starts the song
playing.
Finishing the Song Arrangement
Use the powerful musical intelligence of features like the Harmonies and the Soloist to add the final touches to your
song. The Edit Bar Settings dialog (Alt+B or F5) lets you fine-tune your arrangement by changing styles,
RealDrums styles, patches, harmonies, tempo (absolute or relative), and meter anywhere in the song. Changes can
be applied to all choruses or just to a selected chorus.
Record a Melody
Band-in-a-Box has 2 built-in MIDI sequencer tracks, Melody and Soloist, so you can record and edit your own
melodies or solos. These tracks are recorded from a MIDI keyboard (or other MIDI controller) connected to Bandin-a-Box by your MIDI driver.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
65
Press the [Record] button to begin recording. This launches the Record Track dialog box. You can
punch in, overdub, and record directly to the ending or the tag. Use the filter to choose which MIDI
events are recorded.
Pressing the [Record] button will start Band-ina-Box recording what you play on the Thru
track. An audible count is played in prior to
recording.
Pressing the [Record] button will start Band-in-a-Box recording what you play on the Thru track. An audible
count-in is played prior to recording.
Once you have completed recording your melody Band-in-aBox will ask you if you would like to keep the take and if you
would like to copy the recorded chorus to the whole song.
Tip: Looking for inspiration? At the click of a button, the Band-in-a-Box Melodist will write completely new songs from scratch,
complete with Chords, Intro, Melody, Solo, Ending, and even an original Title. Or you can enter your own chord changes and let the
Melodist create a new melody over them. There are more than 100 Jazz, Pop, Rock, Latin, Country, and Classical melody styles.
66
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Adding Lyrics to your song
Use the menu command Edit | Enter Lyrics at Current Bar to open the Lyrics Entry window. The Escape key
closes this window.
Use the cursor arrows to move down and enter your lyrics a line at a time. Two lines of lyrics are displayed while
the song is playing, and the lyrics are highlighted as the highlight cell moves across the Chordsheet.
Add a Memo
A song memo of up to 2000 characters may be added with your own notes about the song and the Bandin-a-Box song summary. Clicking on the [M] button located to the right of the song title launches the
Song Memo dialog where you can type in a short memo about the song, style, etc.
A red border around the [M] button indicates that the song has a memo. The keystrokes Option+M will also launch
the Song Memo.
Automatic Memo-Generation
The Song Summary window automatically displays a full summary of the song (title/tempo/patches used in the
song), as well as other special features, such as substyle patch change, harmonies, and whether the RealTracks and
RealDrums are part of the style or specific to the song.
This saves much of the work previously required to manually type in this information to the memo.
Saving Your Work
Now that you have produced a great sounding song, it is time to save it as a Band-in-a-Box file, as a MIDI file, or as
an audio wave file. All tracks can be edited and saved.
To edit a MIDI track (bass, drums, piano, guitar, strings), or the MIDI part of a RealTracks that has a RealChart
(MIDI transcribed solo), simply open up the Notation window (or Piano Roll window), and click on the track and
edit it. Make sure to Freeze the track by pressing the Freeze button and choosing Freeze for that track. Now your
edited tracks will save with the song.
The [Save] button saves your song in Band-in-a-Box format. Band-in-a-Box accompaniments are
saved with the file extension *.sgu. If a melody has been recorded the file extension will be *.mgu.
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
67
[Save As] allows you to assign a name to the song and specify the location where it will be saved.
The [Save +] button lets you “Save all settings with Songs” or select the settings to save. It launches
the Save Patches and Harmonies W/ Song dialog where you can save custom patches for your song
as well as Volume, Pan, Reverb, Chorus, Bank, Harmony, Frozen tracks and RealDrums settings.
The [.MID] button will save your file in Standard MIDI File format.
Press the [Audio] button and Band-in-a-Box will render the song arrangement to an audio wave file.
This is done in the Render to Audio File(s) dialog.
Saving As Audio Files
The Render to Audio File(s) dialog box permits you to save your file as a wave file (*.wav), an AIFF file, or a high
quality compressed M4a file. The files will render in a few seconds with the built-in Apple DLS Music Device, or
through your own setup with Core MIDI.
There is an option to boost all files by a certain number of dB. “Boost All Render Files by” adds a dB amount to the
whole mix, so that the mix will be louder or softer. There is automatic peak limiting added, so that the music will
not distort if you set it too high.
Rendering also has a Normalize option to normalize individual tracks or the complete arrangement. Normalizing
boosts the volume to a maximum level without distortion. Most professional music tracks are normalized.
Congratulations!
Now you know how to produce a complete song arrangement in Band-in-a-Box with RealDrums and RealTracks, a
Melody, Solo, Harmonies, and Lyrics; either from scratch or from an imported MIDI file. You can print out clean
lead sheet notation, complete with chord symbols. And you can save your song in MIDI form or as lossless PCM
audio or compressed M4a audio for playback from your computer or over the Internet, or to send as an e-mail
attachment. You’re on your way to making lots of great music with Band-in-a-Box.
Have Fun!
68
Chapter 5: Guided Tour of Band-in-a-Box
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Yes, it’s as “easy as 1-2-3” to make great music on your computer using the intelligent automatic accompaniment
features of Band-in-a-Box, but there’s much more to this amazing program. Work your way through this chapter to
discover the advanced featues and techniques that will turn you into a “power user.”
RealTracks
What are RealTracks?
Just as RealDrums replace the MIDI drum track with live audio recordings of top session drummers,
RealTracks add “real” instruments recorded by top studio players and recording artists.
These tracks replace the MIDI track for that instrument, and can be controlled just like the MIDI instrument (volume
changes, muting, etc.). Best of all, they follow the chord progression that you have entered, so that you hear an
authentic audio accompaniment to your song. These are not “samples,” but are full recordings, lasting from 1 to 8
bars at a time, playing along in perfect sync with the other Band-in-a-Box tracks.
Band-in-a-Box Pro includes the Pro RealCombos, a selection of twelve RealTracks in three combos (Jazz Swing
140, Pop/Rock 120 & Country Ballad 85) together with RealDrums Set 1. Many more RealTracks are available,
either as separate add-ons, or bundled into the various Band-in-a-Box PAKs for better value. There are over 400
RealTracks in all, with many more to come.
RealTracks Dialogs
The RealTracks toolbar button opens a menu with selection for the RealTracks Picker dialog and the
RealTracks Preferences. It also offers suggestions if there RealTracks available that are better suited
to the tempo of the song than the RealTracks that are being used.
You could also open the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog (RealTracks Picker) directly with Shift+click on this
button. Ctrl+click on the button opens the RealTracks Settings dialog (Preferences).
RealTracks Picker
The Assign RealTracks to Track dialog (RealTracks Picker) is where RealTracks are selected, auditioned, and
assigned to a track in the Band-in-a-Box arrangement.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
69
Global settings for RealTracks are made in the RealTracks Settings dialog, which opens
with the menu command Windows | RealTracks Settings or with the [Settings] button in the
Assign RealTracks to Tracks dialog (RealTracks Picker).
In the RealTracks Settings dialog, you can Enable/Disable the RealTracks feature.
RealCharts (notation from RealTracks)
Most RealTracks display notation, i.e. RealCharts, showing the notes that are being played. Some guitar and bass
RealTracks also show tablature and an accurate on-screen fretboard display to show what is being played.
To see which instruments have RealCharts, visit the Assign RealTracks to Tracks dialog and sort column 11,
“Chart.” Instruments with an “N” or “Gt” in this column have RealCharts.
- Instruments with “Gt” in the Chart column have RealCharts with accurate guitar tab and on-screen guitar fretboard
display.
- If the instrument is Acoustic Piano and there is an “N” in the Chart column, the instrument has a Jazz piano
RealChart.
- The various other instruments with an “N” (Pedal Steel, Slide Guitar, Resophonic, Trumpet, Alto Sax, Tenor Sax)
have RealCharts in standard notation.
At the top of the screen, if a track has RealTracks, but is NOT a RealCharts track, then the track
name is green.
Real Instrument charts: If a track has a RealChart, the track name is green and underlined with a
short line.
RealGuitar charts: If a track has RealChart, and is a guitar track with accurate tab and on-screen
guitar fretboard display, then it is green and underlined with a long line.
The RealCharts can be saved to MIDI files or with Band-in-a-Box songs (MGU).
RealCharts are optional and are selected in the RealTracks
Settings dialog.
; “Show notation for RealCharts in styles” will show RealCharts that have been generated from styles with
RealTracks.
; “Show Notation for Soloists” will show RealCharts that have been generated from the Select Soloist dialog.
; “Save RealChart in MIDI file” will save the RealChart to a MIDI track so you can analyze it in other programs.
; “Save RealCharts in BB Songs (MGU)” will save the RealChart MIDI information to the MGU file.
70
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
RealTracks Folder
The RealTracks styles are stored in Applications/Band-in-a-Box/RealTracks by default.
You can choose an alternate folder location in the RealTracks Settings dialog by checking “Use
a custom folder location for the RealTracks” and then clicking on the folder button and picking
an alternate folder. Then, click on the [Update] button to confirm the new location.
You don’t need to visit this folder when using RealTracks; it is used internally by Band-in-a-Box, so you shouldn’t
add or remove files from this RealTracks folder unless you “know what you’re doing.”
Applying RealTracks Settings
To make these settings open the RealTracks Settings dialog with either the [Settings] button in the Assign
RealTracks to Tracks dialog or with Ctrl+click on the RealTracks toolbar button.
This dialog also opens with the Windows | RealTracks Settings menu command.
You can apply an overall Volume Adjust to the RealTracks. If they
are too loud overall, try a Global Volume Adjust of about -10 dB.
“Allow soloing to crescendo” can be applied to some
RealTracks to have the intensity of the solo building
up, with the flashiest part of the solos playing as the solo builds.
This launches the Assign RealTracks to Tracks dialog (RealTracks Picker) that
allows you to select RealTracks.
This “speedup” feature works automatically for faster generation of
RealTracks using CPU resources during playback. If you have a multi-core machine, you may not notice this at all,
since it will use different cores than the main Band-in-a-Box thread. If your machine is older, low on memory, slow
hard drive etc., you can disable this “speedup” feature so that your machine is doing less CPU work during
playback.
When set, the program will find the best RealTracks to
use at the current tempo. For example, it might substitute an Acoustic Bass at a higher tempo if that is closer to the
tempo of all songs.
If set, a yellow message appears whenever
better RealTracks are available at the current tempo. To choose these RealTracks press the RealTracks toolbar
button and choose “Select better RealTracks for this tempo” in the dropdown menu. Use this option if you don’t
want Band-in-a-Box to automatically substitute your RealTracks, but you would like to know if there are other
choices available to you that might be more suitable for the song.
This allows an additional two bars at the end of the song
for the ending on RealTracks to fade (decay) naturally. If your RealTracks selection does not support this feature,
you can check www.pgmusic.com/support to see if we have uploaded a free update.
This adds audio reverb to the RealTracks and RealDrums. Enter the % amount and click the update button. This
uses some CPU cycles, so disable on slower machines.
When set, songs will support shots, holds, and pushes for
RealTracks. Not all styles have these available, so check the RealTracks Library Holds folder and the “H” column
in the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
71
Many Jazz comping styles now play triads (instead of
7ths) when simple triads are entered, instead of “jazzing them up” to 7ths chords (e.g. Guitar: Freddie, Wes Piano:
some Jazz, all Stride, Rehearsal). If you prefer to have triads automatically “jazzed up” when comping using Jazz
RealTracks, then you can set this s option to force 7ths for triads.
“Custom RealTracks folder” allows you to put your RealTracks in a custom folder other than /Applications/Band-ina-Box/RealTracks. Use the [Folder] button to locate a custom folder, and use the [Update] button to assign the
folder. This option is discussed in the previous topic, RealTracks Folder.
The [Archive] button will erase the .AIFF files in the RealTracks folder when there is a
smaller .M4A file available.
[Defaults] sets RealTracks Settings back to default settings.
Save the new settings you have made in this dialog by pressing the [Update] button. Most changes will take effect
the next time you press [Play].
Press [OK] to make your selection and exit the RealTracks Settings dialog.
Press [Cancel] to exit the RealTracks Settings dialog without making any changes.
Using RealTracks
There are three ways that you can use RealTracks with Band-in-a-Box.
1. RealTracks in songs.
Use the [RealTrks] toolbar button to select the RealTracks Picker, which launches the Assign
RealTracks to Track dialog. This dialog displays the current RealTracks that are assigned to each
track. This dialog is also available with a right mouse click on any Band-in-a-Box part name. Then
select Choose RealTracks from the context menu that opens.
2. RealStyles.
These are Band-in-a-Box styles (.Style) that have at least one RealTrack. For example the style called
“=GEORGEP.sty” is a RealStyle because it uses RealPedalSteel for the Strings part, as well as other instruments
(MIDI bass, MIDI piano, MIDI guitar, RealDrums).
3. RealSoloists.
These are Soloists that are generated on the Soloist track, by pressing the Soloist button on the main screen.
RealSoloists using RealTracks begin at #361 in the list of Soloists. There is a [RealTracks] button in the Select
Soloist dialogue that jumps directly to the list of RealTracks soloists.
Using RealTracks in Songs - Assign RealTracks to Track Dialog
The Assign RealTracks to Track dialog assigns a RealTracks instrument to any of the Band-in-a-Box instrumental
tracks. It also shows any RealTracks that are assigned to Band-in-a-Box tracks.
This dialog is launched by either right-clicking (or Ctrl+click or
double click) on an instrument name at the top of the Band-in-aBox main screen and clicking on Choose RealTracks in the menu.
- or -
72
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Pressing the [RealTrks] toolbar button and selecting RealTracks Picker Dialog.
The dialog allows you to assign a specific RealTracks instruments to a track in a song. It also displays any
RealTracks that are currently assigned to each track.
This will assign a RealTracks to the current song only,
overriding any RealTracks stored in the style.
The [None] button sets the current track to no RealTracks assigned for the song.
This sets all RealTracks for the song to “None.” It will also optionally disable RealTracks present
in the style for this song.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
73
Select “Disable RealTracks for this
track (Force this track to MIDI)” if you want to have no RealTracks instrument for this track, even if the style
specifies a RealTrack.
“Artist Bio” - The RealTracks have been recorded by top studio musicians. The artist names and bios are displayed
for the RealTracks. Double click here to view the full memo.
“Memo” field - This describes the currently selected RealTracks style, and includes some useful tips, such as a
suggested tempo range and Band-in-a-Box styles to use it with.
“User comments” - You can enter your own comments about any style in this field. The comments are saved in
RTUserMemos.txt
Use the song and style demos to audition RealTracks.
The [Song Demo (MGU)] button will display a list of songs in the
Applications/Band-in-a-Box/RealTracks – Demos folder that use the selected
RealTrack instrument. Click on the song name and then press the [Play] button to
hear it.
The [Style Demo (.Style)] button shows a list of styles that use the currently highlighted RealTracks instrument.
Clicking on a style name will load the style into the current Band-in-a-Box song. Press [Play] to hear your current
song played with the RealTracks style that you want to audition.
[Defaults] sets the dialog to default values.
[Settings] launches the RealTracks Settings dialog.
[Audition] and [+] buttons play a short M4A file demo of the currently selected
RealTracks, without affecting the currently loaded song in Band-in-a-Box. The [Audition] button plays a solo file,
and the [+] button plays a file in context with a band.
Picking RealTracks
To use the dialog, first select the track that you want to assign. Then, select the RealTracks that you want in the list
below it.
You can sort the list by clicking on any column heading. As well as Name, GM (General MIDI instrument), Type
(Rhythm or Soloist), Feel (Even or Swing), Tempo, Genre, and Number there are more columns with additional
information about each RealTrack instrument.
- The “N/A” column shows “N/A” for RealTracks that you either have not installed or haven’t yet purchased, if
“Show RealTracks that are N/A” is checked below.
- “Set” is the number of the RealTracks set that includes the instrument.
- The “St” (stereo) column shows whether the instrument playback is stereo or mono.
- Instruments with an “N” or “Gt” in the “Nt” (notation) column will display the RealTrack in notation.
- The “Artist” column has the name of the musician playing on the RealTrack instrument. See the “Artist Bio” box
for information about the player.
- The letter “t” in the “T” column indicates RealTracks that are tempo swappable and can be substituted with other
RealTracks that are made at different tempos.
- If the “H” column is blank it means that Holds, Shots, and Pushes are available for the listed RealTracks. The
letter “n” in this column means that they are available but not installed. A dash – means that no Holds, Shots, and
Pushes are available for the style.
Since RealTracks are add-on purchases for Band-in-a-Box, your
version may not contain all RealTracks. Selecting the “Show RealTracks that are N/A” checkbox will show you all
available RealTracks.
74
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Some RealTracks have variations available, such as the Acoustic Jazz
Bass, which has variations that play in “2” only, in “4” only, or in “2”and “4” (for “a” and “b” substyles). Normally
you will want to “Show RealTracks Variations.”
Use this to show/hide RealTracks that are out of compatible tempo
range.
This will display RealTracks installation errors when you open the dialog.
Press the [Rebuild] button for more information.
This rebuilds the list of RealTracks. It also reports any installation errors.
You can play RealTracks at half time or double time. This allows you,
for example, in a ballad at a tempo of 70 to add a RealTracks solo with
a tempo of 140 and play it in double time, which will match the ballad tempo of 70.
A filter is available. Type a filter text, (e.g., bass) and press
[Update] and you will then see the list filtered to show only
RealTracks that have the word bass somewhere in the title,
memo, genre, etc.
Multiple search terms work with the RealTracks picker. If you separate terms with a space, each term is searched
for separately. So a search for "“Country Guitar Ev 120",”, will find any Country Guitar styles with an Even feel
that would work with a tempo of close to 120. Adding a search term that has a number will filter for RealTracks
that match the tempo or within a compatible range.
Pressing [Show All] will cancel the filter, and show all RealTracks again.
[Generate Track] will generate a RealTracks instrument on the currently selected
track.
This button will close the dialog, and assign the RealTracks instrument to the current track.
Then, when play is pressed, the RealTrack will generate.
Click on [Cancel] to exit the dialog without assigning a RealTracks instrument to the current
track.
Using RealTracks in Styles
The StyleMaker has settings to assign RealTracks to styles in the Misc. Style Settings dialog. This allows you to
create or edit styles to assign specific RealDrums or RealTracks to the style.
To access this dialog, enter the StyleMaker (User | Make A New Style), and then press the [PATCH]
button to launch the Misc. Style Settings dialog.
RealTracks can be assigned to any Band-in-a-Box instrument part in an existing style by using the “Assign Soloist
(MIDI) or RealTracks (audio) to style” feature.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
75
To assign RealTracks to a style select the “Instrument” part that you want to replace with a RealTrack.
Then select the RealTracks instrument that you want for this part in the style.
Note: This list also includes soloists, the RealTracks listing begins at #361.
Styles can have multiple RealTracks. For example, you could have RealPedalSteel and RealAcousticGuitar - and
also RealDrums.
Assigning RealDrums to the Style
RealDrums are assigned to the style separately from RealTracks.
To use RealDrums in as style that was originally made with MIDI drums, go to the “RealDrums Settings” section of
the Misc. Style Settings dialog and enable (check) the “Style uses RealDrums (audio drums)” setting.
To choose a RealDrums style, click on the [RD] button. This will open the RealDrums Picker where you can
choose from all of the RealDrums that you have installed in your Drums folder.
Volume and Timing Offsets
The volume and the timing of the RealTracks parts can be adjusted to match the rest of the style.
MultiStyle(s)
Enter the name of a style: zzjazz, or multiple styles separated by semicolons: zzjazz;zzbossa and these will appear
as MultiStyles, substyles c/d/e/f etc.
You can click on the [Style] button to choose the styles for your MultiStyle from the StylePicker window.
Styles with RealTracks
There are many existing Band-in-a-Box styles that have been made with RealTracks. The style names begin with an
equals sign.
76
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
RealStyles are styles that use only RealTracks and no MIDI instruments. These style names begin with an
underscore.
RealStyles and Styles with RealTracks have their own categories in the StyleMaker.
Finding all styles that have RealTracks.
Open the StylePicker and locate the categories called “RealStyles” and “Styles with RealTracks.”
Click on a category to list all of the styles that are present that include RealTracks.
Using RealTracks in Solos.
Press the Soloist button (Shift+F4) and launch the Select Soloist dialog. Get to Soloists in the range from
#361and up.
You can do that by:
Typing 361 and pressing [Go to].
1.
2.
3.
Choosing Favorites to return to a recently chosen Soloist.
Click on the [RealTrack] button to jump directly to the start of the RealTracks
soloists listings.
As with other Soloists, press the [All Solo] button to make sure that the Soloist will be
generated for all choruses, or [Melody and Solo] if you just want the Soloist for a certain chorus.
Saving RealTracks Soloists
Soloist generated RealTracks are saved with the song, so you will hear the RealTracks play the same solo when you
reload the song.
When you generate a solo using RealTracks, Band-in-a-Box will remember this, and when you go to save the song,
Band-in-a-Box will ask you if you want to save that solo (and thereby freeze the Soloist track). If you say yes, then
the solo will play instantly the same way when the song is reloaded. Of course, you can freeze the soloist track
yourself at any time.
Saving Your RealTracks
As with Band-in-a-Box MIDI parts and RealDrums, the RealTracks can be saved by rendering the
complete performance to an AIFF file or the individual RealTracks to separate AIFF files.
The RealTracks selection that you assign to a song will be saved with the song, but the audio track that was
generated is not automatically saved with the Band-in-a-Box MGU file. This is because the Band-in-a-Box MGU
file only contains chords/melody/lyrics (and an optional audio track AIFF file).
If you have generated a RealTracks part that you want to keep you can use the Freeze feature to save it.
Frozen tracks will reload with the song and play exactly as saved.
Are other RealTracks available?
There are one hundred and one sets with over 500 RealTracks instruments with many more to come.
See http://www.pgmusic.com/products_realtracks.htm for the latest releases.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
77
RealDrums
The RealDrums feature replaces MIDI drums with audio drums recorded live by top studio drummers.
Why do RealDrums sound better than MIDI Drums?
RealDrums are recordings of top studio drummers playing multi-bar patterns, whereas MIDI drums are patterns
based on single drum hits programmed, typically on a quantized grid, as people assume drummers are typically
playing.
With RealDrums, we record top studio drummers at multiple tempos, so the playing you hear at various tempos is
also musically different, not just “sped up.” Drummers play different types of fills etc. at slower/faster tempos, and
these are captured with RealDrums.
Technical note: If interested, you can see which tempos have been recorded by looking in the Band-in-a-Box/Drums folder for the
particular style you are interested in.
How Do RealDrums Work?
There are several ways to hear RealDrums with new or existing Band-in-a-Box songs. RealDrums can be added to a
single song, or substituted for MIDI drums in existing styles.
We provide many styles that already have RealDrums. These styles can be identified by the style name beginning
with a minus sign. For example “-ZZJAZZ.STY” is a version of the ZZJAZZ style that uses RealDrums.
Let’s Explore the Real Drums
Let’s load in some RealDrums tunes!
Open the Applications/Band-in-a-Box/Drums - Demos folder and you’ll see folders of demo tunes. These will
demonstrate the RealDrums.
Let’s load in “JazzBrushes_145_Demo.MGU” from the /Applications/Band-in-a-Box/Drums – Demos folder. Press
[Play]. If you have the RealDrums style installed for “JazzBrushes” (i.e., you have a folder called “Band-in-aBox/Drums/JazzBrushes”), then you should now be hearing RealDrums. You can tell right away, because the
count-in sound is different, it is not the usual MIDI count-in, but is a side-stick or snare live drum sound.
As the RealDrums are playing:
- Change the tempo of the music as it is playing. Use the standard tempo controls, the square bracket keys [ and
], to change the tempo and the RealDrums will change immediately to the new tempo. (The [ and ] keys change
tempo by 5 bpm.)
- Press STOP, and then change the tempo to a far slower tempo (like 60 bpm). Now press PLAY. Notice that the
RealDrums are not just playing slower, they are playing differently, with appropriate patterns and fills for a
slower tempo! This is because we have recorded the drummers playing at different tempos, and include a wide
variety of tempos inside the RealDrums folder.
-
Open up the StylePicker, and notice the category called “Styles with
RealDrums.” This lists many RealDrums styles that we’ve made. We always name the RealDrums style
beginning with a minus sign, so that “-ZZJAZZ.STY” would be the ZZJAZZ style, but using RealDrums
instead.
-
In the RealDrums Picker, click on the [Settings] Button to open up the Real Drums
Settings dialog. Try turning off the RealDrums by de- selecting “Enable RealDrums.”
Using RealDrums
The RealDrums toolbar button opens a menu to choose the RealDrums Picker Dialog, Shift+click, or
the RealDrums Preferences, Ctrl+click.
78
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
RealDrums Picker
Use the RealDrums Picker to choose RealDrums for the current song only.
The RealDrums Picker opens from either the [RealDrms] toolbar button menu or with the Windows |
RealDrums Picker menu command.
It can also be opened from the RealDrums Settings dialog with the selection “For this song only, use
this RealDrum style” and a click on the [RD] button.
A filter is available. Type a filter text, (e.g. bossa) and press [Update],
and you will then see the list filtered to show only RealDrums that have
the word bossa somewhere in the title, memo, genre etc.
Multiple search terms work with RealDrums Picker. If you separate terms with a space, each term is searched for
separately. So a search for "“Bossa Rock Ev 120",” will find any Bossa Rock styles with an Even feel that would
work with a tempo of close to 120. Adding a search term that has a number will filter for RealTracks that match the
tempo or within a compatible range.
Pressing [Update] applies the current filter.
Pressing [Show All] will cancel the filter, and show all RealDrums again.
There are additional settings to define your selection in the RealDrums Picker.
“Show if Tempo is out of Range” will show styles that wouldn’t work well at the current song tempo. The
acceptable range is shown in the list of styles Lo/Hi (9th and 10th) columns.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
79
“Show if Feel does not match” will show a song where the drums are in Even feel and the style is Swing (or vice
versa).
“Show RealDrums that are not favorites.” You can assign a style as one of your favorites by clicking in the first
column. Then you can sort by favorites or use this option to see only favorites.
“Show RealDrums that are N/A.” These are styles not found in the Drums folder, likely because they are add-on
styles not purchased yet. Press the [Rebuild] button and check the RealDrums Settings to confirm that you have the
correct drums folder selected.
“For this song only, force MIDI drums.” Set this if you want MIDI drums and want to override a RealDrums that
is set in the style.
“Memo” is a memo description of the style.
These are stored in the Band-in-aBox/Data/RDPGMemos.txt file.
You can also add your own memos in the User
Comments box below.
This shows the current RealDrums
for the song.
RealDrums are recorded by top studio
drummers. See the “Bio” for a capsule
description of the musician’s career and
credits.
This sets the drums to no RealDrums override for the song, and optionally also forces MIDI drums
(i.e., no RealDrums for the style either).
The RealDrums list can be sorted by clicking on any of the column headings.
Click on this button to enter an asterisk beside the current selection in the list, indicating that this is a
favorite style.
Click on the name of the RealDrums style name that you want to select for the song. Names ending in a caret ^
have variations available.
-
^ Clicking in the caret column will show the variations for the selected RealDrums style (if available).
Genre is the type of music that the RealDrums style comes from, such as Jazz, Rock, or Country.
Genre (2) suggests additional types of music that the RealDrums style might work for.
/4 indicates the time signature, which is 4/4 by default. If the column is empty the time signature is 4/4, if there
is a 3 in this column the time signature is 3/4.
Ev indicates the feel of the RealDrums style, either Even or Swing.
The listing in the 8 column indicates whether the meter is based on eighth notes (8) or sixteenth notes (16).
Lo is the slowest tempo for which the RealDrums style is suited.
Hi is the fastest tempo recommended for the style.
X indicates a style with a tempo that is out of range for the song.
N/A are styles not found in the drums folder.
Artist lists the names of the drummers who recorded each RealDrums style. Select a name to read their Bio.
80
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
- Set is the number of the RealDrums set that includes the style.
You can type in your own comments about any style in
the “User comments” field and they are saved.
RealDrums styles ending in a caret (^) have variations available. They
are listed here. Where there are two instruments shown, such as
Brushes/Sticks, the first one plays in the “a” substyle and the second in
the “b” substyle.
[PlayNow] loads the selected RealDrums and starts playback.
The [Stop] button stops the song playback. Click on [PlayNow] to resume.
The [Audition] button doesn’t load the style but instead uses Media Player to play a demo .AIFF file for the
style.
[Settings] opens the RealDrums Settings dialog.
[Rebuild] builds the list of RealDrums present as folders in the Drums folder. If you add new drum styles, press
this button to update the list. RealDrums made by you (or others) that are added by you to the RealDrums folder
also appear in the RealDrums Picker dialog.
[Defaults] returns the dialog to default settings, which will show all available styles.
Press [OK] to make your selection and return to the song.
Press [Cancel] to return to the song without making a selection.
RealDrums style change at any bar (F5)
The Edit bar settings dialog opens with the menu command Edit | Bar Settings, with the F5 function key, or the
keystrokes Alt+B.
Tip: If the F5 key (or F8 key) does not perform the expected function in Band-in-a-Box, you will need to go to the Apple System
Preferences and uncheck the system setting in the Keyboard Shortcuts list.
In this dialog you can change the style of RealDrums at the current bar (location of the highlight cell). The change
can affect all choruses, or just a selected chorus.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
81
The [R.Drums] button opens the RealDrums Picker to select a new RealDrums style from
the list.
Click on [Clear RealDrums change] to remove the change.
RealDrums Settings
The RealDrums Settings apply to all songs. (Use the RealDrums Picker to assign a particular RealDrums style for
just the one song you are working on.)
The RealDrums Settings dialog opens from the RealDrums Preferences item in the [RealDrms]
toolbar button menu.
You can also get to the RealDrums Settings dialog with the [Settings] button in the
RealDrums Picker or with the Windows | RealDrums Settings menu command.
Use the RealDrums Settings to substitute RealDrums for MIDI drums in existing Band-in-a-Box styles.
With “Enable RealDrums” checked RealDrums may be used rather than MIDI. This
setting can be changed while the song is playing so that you can compare MIDI drums
and RealDrums.
This will substitute RealDrums for MIDI styles in all songs where a suitable RealDrums style is available. You can
change the setting from 1 to 5.
82
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
If set to 1, almost all MIDI drums will be substituted by RealDrums. If set to 5, only RealDrum styles that match
the style perfectly will be substituted.
For RealDrums substitutions, choose different ^variations with each PLAY
This feature selects variations of RealDrums instruments with each PLAY.
Most RealDrums styles contain many instrument variations (brushes vs. sticks, hi-hat vs. ride cymbal, percussion
only, etc.). Now, by selecting “…choose different ^variations with each PLAY,” you can hear a different variation
each time play is pressed, so the song sounds fresh each time. One time you’ll hear it with brushes, the next time
with sticks and ride cymbals, etc.
Favor Brushes/Sticks
When selecting RealDrums styles to use for a style, Band-in-a-Box will use your preferences for brushes and sticks.
For example, if you choose “Favor Brushes” Band-in-a-Box will always choose from among variations that include
brushes (when available).
Favor Artists
We have “artist” support. This allows you to choose among different drummers playing the same style. For
example, we have multiple artists playing the “JazzBrushes” style. You can set Band-in-a-Box to choose a different
artist with each play, or always choose a specific artist.
If RealDrums style not found…, use other RealDrums style
Use “If RealDrums style not found, use other RealDrums style” to replace RealDrums styles that you don’t have
(i.e., haven’t purchased yet) with ones that you do have. This feature also has a range of settings from 1 to 5. If set
to 1, almost all missing styles will be substituted. If set to 5, only RealDrum styles that match the style perfectly
will be substituted.
Technical note: The a_pgmusic.ds text file controls this feature.
RealDrums For Individual Songs
Individual songs can have RealDrums added to them.
Click on the [RD] button to select a specific RealDrums style to use in a particular song. This will launch
the RealDrums Picker with a list of all available RealDrums styles.
F or this song, choose different ^variations with each play
When this is set, if you save a specific style with a song, you’ll hear a new variation of that style each time you press
PLAY, with different drum instruments.
Developer Mode
Only set this when you are a developer making a RealDrums style and want to see additional debug information
such as the /Applications/Band-in-a-Box /drumaudioresults.txt file and messages about errors in the _style.txt file.
Hi-Res Quality at half-speed
When selected, RealDrums will use a higher quality (more CPU intensive) method to play the drums when playing
at ½ or ¼ speed (from the Play menu).
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
83
Global Volume adjust
If you are finding that the RealDrums track is too loud or quiet in relations to the MIDI parts, you can adjust the
volume here. This affects all RealDrums styles.
Slide Track
You should normally leave this at 0, but if you are having sync problems between the MIDI tracks and RealDrums
you can set this to a positive or negative value. Values are in milliseconds (ms).
Custom Drum Folder, instead of /Applications/Band-in-a-Box /drums
You can choose any folder for your RealDrums. This allows you, for example, to conserve space on your hard drive
by storing the RealDrums on an external drive.
Since you can type in your own folder name directly, you should update the setting when you
are finished typing the name.
If you want to store your Drums folder somewhere other than /Applications/Band-in-aBox/Drums, then specify that location by choosing its folder here.
Other RealDrums Controls
This button clears the currently selected RealDrums for the song.
This allows you to audition the song with and without RealDrums without leaving this dialog.
Stop song playback.
Return the settings in this dialog to their defaults.
This updates the settings in the dialog and rebuilds the list of drum styles.
The [Archive] button will erase the AIFF files in the Drums folder when there is a smaller
M4A available.
For a single chosen folder, this reverses the Install function and erases the AIFF file when
there is already an M4A file.
Press [OK] to make your selection and exit the RealDrums Settings dialog.
Press [Cancel] to exit the RealDrums Settings dialog without making any changes.
84
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Song Settings
Song settings include the title, key signature, and tempo for a song and the Band-in-a-Box style for its arrangement.
Main Settings
The Main Settings dialog shows all the settings for the song. Go to Song | Title/Key/Tempo/Embel… or use the
keystrokes Command+K to open the dialog.
Title, Key Tempo
The Title: field will show the current title from the Title window. For a new song it will be “Untitled.” Type in the
title for your song here.
Settings for Key and Tempo can be typed directly into the dialog.
If you aren’t sure of the exact number value for the tempo of your song, you can click four times in tempo on the
metronome and Band-in-a-Box will set it automatically.
The Title, Key, and Tempo settings can also be made in the Title window on the main screen.
Transpose
If you change the key you can transpose all of the MIDI parts to the new key by checking the Transpose box. This
is especially useful when loading in new songs and transposing them to other keys.
If you’ve entered a progression that you intend for a particular key, and then choose the key afterward in order to
show the correct key signature, you would leave Transpose unchecked. Then the key signature will change to the
new key you type in, but the chords you entered will stay the same.
Embellish Chords
The Embellish Chords setting enables live embellishment of the chords.
Additional Song Settings
The [More …] button opens the Additional Song Settings dialog box. These are the
additional song settings for options like rests, pushes, chord embellishment, tags,
endings and more that turn a standard Band-in-a-Box song into an arrangement. They
are saved with the song.
This dialog box also opens with the [S] button on the main screen, or by choosing Additional Song
Settings… from the Song menu.
Vary Style in Middle Choruses
Default =
If checked, the song will play in substyle B throughout the Middle Choruses. The Middle Choruses include all
choruses except the first and last. If not checked, the middle choruses will play “a” and “b” substyles as set in the
Chordsheet with part markers.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
85
For example, in Jazz Swing, since the “b” substyle is Swing, all of the middle choruses will have swing bass. (The
“a” substyle is playing half notes on the bass.)
Allow Pushes in Middle Choruses
Default =
This is used if you have put pushes into a song, but don't want the pushes to play in the middle choruses. The
middle choruses are usually used for soloing, so you may not want the pushes to play.
Rests
Allow Rests in First Chorus
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the first chorus.
Allow Rests in Middle Choruses
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the middle choruses. The middle
choruses are usually used for soloing, so you may not want the rests to play.
Allow Rests in Last Chorus
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the last chorus.
86
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Allow Pedal Bass in Middle Choruses
Default =
This determines whether Pedal Bass effect will be allowed in middle choruses.
Allow Embellishment of Chords
Default =
The Jazz styles include embellishment of chords. This means that if you type a C7 chord the piano player may play
a C13 or a C7b9. This makes the arrangement sound more authentic.
Tip: If you are hearing flat 9 and flat 13 embellishments on a C7 chord that is clashing with the melody, you should rename the
chord C9 or C13, which will ensure natural 9 and 13 embellishments. To disable the embellishment for a certain song, uncheck this
option. There are very few situations that you wouldn't want it on, especially if you name some chords as C9 instead of C7 in
situations where the melody clashes with the embellishment, as discussed above. You would need to uncheck it for any song that
you don't want it on.
Tags
Tag Settings
A tag (or coda) is a group of bars that are played in the last chorus of a song. If you check the “Tag Exists?” field,
then the tag will play during the last chorus of the song. The tag begins after the bar you specify as “Tag Jump After
Bar #.” The song then jumps to the “Tag Begin at Bar #” and plays until “Tag Ends After Bar #.” At the end of the
tag, the song then plays a 2 bar ending as usual.
Generate 2-Bar Ending for This Song
Default =
You can disable the ending for a certain song. You can disable the endings for all songs by clearing the checkmark
for the “Allow Any Endings” setting in the Preferences dialog.
Use 4-Bar Ending for RealTracks
Default =
Adds two bars on the end of the song for the ending note on RealTracks to fade (decay).
Start the ending 2 bars early
Default =
The usual Band-in-a-Box ending is 2 bars appended to the end of the song. This option gives you an alternative to
end the song on the last bar of the song. Band-in-a-Box will still play an ending on the chord that you specify, and
the ending will occur as a 2 bar phrase beginning 2 bars before the end of the form. This results in more natural
endings for many songs.
For example, the song Old Folks At Home is a 32-bar chorus song from bar 1 to bar 32. It ends with the last melody
note on bar 31 with the word “home,” but Band-in-a-Box normally plays a 2 bar ending, starting at the end of bar 32
and going for 2 bars more. For a song like this, it is more natural to end the song at the end of bar 32.
To set this in Band-in-a-Box set “Start the ending 2 bars early” to true.
Note: “Auto Endings”
If you‘ve made a style, and haven’t included an ending, a 2-bar ending can be generated automatically, based on the style.
Fadeout ending # bars
You can quickly choose a fadeout ending. Just press the Fade button and Band-in-a-Box will fade out the last “X”
bars of the song (you can specify how many bars). Or customize the fadeout with precise values for each bar.
Solos should have a “bluesy” feel.
Check this setting for solos with more syncopation, flatted thirds, and sevenths.
Allow RealTracks substitution based on tempo
Default =
When set, the program will find the best RealTracks to use at the current tempo.
Allow RealTracks Shots, Holds, and Pushes
Default =
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
87
When set, this song will support Shots, Holds, and Pushes for those RealTracks that have them (as shown in the “H”
column of the RealTracks Picker).
Key Changes (Transposition)
The key signature of the song is displayed in the Title window.
You can quickly type in a key in either the Chordsheet or Notation window. Type tkc and press Enter to set the key
signature to C. Typing tkbb would set it to Bb. To transpose from another key to Bb you would type trbb.
Another way to change the key is to click on the key signature. A popup opens with a list of keys
to choose from. Band-in-a-Box then asks if it is “OK to transpose Lead sheet?” Answer [Yes] and
the entire song will be transposed to a new key. Answer [No] and the key signature will change
but the song will not be transposed. Select [Cancel] to exit without changing the key signature.
Setting Tempo
The tempo of the song is displayed on the main screen in the Title window.
An easy way to set the tempo is to type it in the Chordsheet or Notation window. Type t125 and press Enter to set
the tempo to 125, type t80 to set to 80, etc.
Tempo can be set on the computer keyboard with 4 taps of either the minus (-) key or the equals (=) key. When the
tempo is tapped on the [=] key, song playback will start automatically at the tapped tempo.
To change the tempo of a song while the song is playing you may use the [ and ] keys to change the tempo by 5
bpm at a time. Or you can move the mouse pointer over the tempo setting and click the mouse as follows:
The tempo display is broken up into 4 quadrants. Mouse clicking in these four areas will
change the tempo by +1, -1, +5, or -5 before or during play.
You can change the tempo at any bar in the song with the Edit Bar Settings dialog box. Press F5 or the keystroke
combination Option+B or go to Bar Settings in the Edit menu to open the dialog. The tempo change you enter takes
effect at the beginning of the bar and remains until a new tempo change at another bar is inserted.
Song Intros, Choruses and Endings
A typical song has the following elements:
- Introduction (Intro). If present is typically 4 bars long.
- Chorus(es). Typically 3 or 4 choruses in a 3-minute song.
- Ending. Typically a 2 bar ending following all of the choruses.
Note: We use the term “chorus” as commonly used in Jazz music. A chorus therefore means once through the entire form of the
song. A typical length of a chorus is 32 bars. A song may have the form AABA where the A sections are verses and the B section
is the bridge. This entire form AABA is called one chorus.
Adding An Intro.
You select the beginning and end bars of the chorus. If you select a bar greater than 1 for the first bar of the chorus,
then Band-in-a-Box knows that you want the previous bars for an intro.
Example: 4 bar intro to a song.
Type in the 4 bars of intro chords, starting at bar 1 of the Chordsheet. Then at bar 5 you will begin typing in the
chords of the chorus. Set the beginning of the chorus to bar 5, by selecting the Chorus begins at option on the Song
menu and then clicking on the measure of the first bar of the chorus.
88
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Auto-Generate Intro Bars.
Band-in-a-Box will automatically generate an introduction for any song from the [Intro] toolbar button or
the Edit | Intro Bars Auto-Generate menu option (Ctrl+Shift+B). This will create a chord progression
that gets inserted as an intro to the song, based on the optional settings you choose.
Chord Types can be Jazz or Pop.
Intro Length can be 2, 4 or 8 bars to suit the tempo of the song.
Starting Chord (after intro) is lets the intro lead in to the song correctly.
Pedal Bass has a list of pedal bass options, based on the key entered in the box.
Press the [(Re)-Generate Intro Chords] button to auto-generate chords for an intro.
Press the [Remove Intro] button to remove the intro from the song.
The Melodist feature will also generate an introduction for the songs it creates.
Selecting Bars To Begin And End The Chorus.
Bar number for Chorus to begin.
Click on the chorus begin number in the Title window, or select the Chorus begins at option on the Song menu, or
press +b. The message “Click on a Bar #” will start to blink in the toolbar. Mouse click on the bar number to
begin the chorus. The bar number that you select will then be displayed.
Bar number for Chorus to end.
Click on the chorus end number in the Title window, or select the Chorus ends at option on the Song menu, or press
+e. The message “Click on a Bar #” will start to blink in the toolbar. Mouse click on the bar number to end the
chorus. The bar number that you select will then be displayed.
Number of choruses to play.
Click on the number where the number of choruses are displayed on the Title/Key/Tempo/Chorus Window and
select the number of choruses from the Pop-Up Menu or select Total Choruses = from the Song menu or press +l.
The number of choruses will then be displayed.
The Chordsheet
The chordsheet is a spreadsheet where the numbered cells represent bars of music. The chord changes for the song
are shown in the corresponding bars.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
89
Band-in-a-Box chordsheet area.
As well as entering the chords for your song, the Chordsheet is where you put in style variations, fills, and breaks.
The basic procedures for entering information in the Chordsheet follow, but be sure to see the right-click contextual
menu for the Chordsheet for alternate methods and additional features.
Quick Song Settings
Typing special words, instead of chord names, in the Chordsheet will make the following settings:
begin <Enter>
- sets the beginning of the chorus to the current bar
chorusend <Enter>
- sets the end of the chorus to the current bar
end <Enter>
- sets the end of the song to the current bar
tkc <Enter>
- sets key signature to C, tkbb would set it to Bb
trc <Enter>
- transposes song to key of C
t125 <Enter>
- sets tempo to 125
Typing Chords
The basic way of entering a song in Band-in-a-Box is by typing the chords for the song into the Chordsheet.
The location of the black highlight cell determines where chords will be entered. Use
either the mouse or the cursor arrow keys on the computer keyboard to move the
chord highlight cell around the Chordsheet. Click on any bar to position the highlight cell, then type in the chords
for that bar.
The highlight cell covers two beats, or half a bar in 4/4 time. Two chord names can be typed into the highlight cell
(separated by a comma e.g. C, C#dim) so up to four chords per bar may be entered.
To enter a chord, type its name using standard chord symbols (like C, or Fm7, or Bb7, or Bb13#9/E) and press the
return key. The chord name(s) you have typed will be entered in the Chordsheet at the current location of the
highlight cell. Each time the return key is pressed the highlight cell advances 2 beats, or ½ a measure.
Note: To view a list of Band-in-a-Box chord names, please refer to the online Help.
To start typing in chords:
- Go to the top (bar 1) of the Chordsheet by clicking on measure 1.
-
Blank the Chordsheet by selecting the “New” option from the File menu, or with the keystrokes +n.
The highlight cell will be at the start of bar 1, reposition it if desired.
When you have the highlight cell positioned where you want to enter a chord type the name of the chord you
would like. For example, type c6 to get the C6 chord.
You should never have to use the shift key, as Band-in-a-Box will sort this out for you. Here are some other tips for
easy chord entry:
- Use b for a flat, e.g. Bb7. It is not necessary to type upper or lower case; the program will sort this out for you.
- Use # or 3 for a sharp, e.g. F#7. (# is the uppercase symbol of 3, so you can actually type F37 to get F#7.
Band-in-a-Box will sort out the case, saving you the effort of using <SHIFT>3 to type the # symbol).
- Use / for slash chords with alternate Roots such as C7/E (C7 with E bass).
- Use a comma (,) to enter 2 chords in a cell. In the example below, we would type Ab9,G9 to get the 2 chords in
the cell (on beat 3 and 4 of bar 2).
90
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
The sequence of keystrokes to enter all these chords above would be
c6>am7>dm7>ab9,g9>c6/e>>a739. The > indicates cursor key to the right.
(We are able to type A7#9 as a739 because Band-in-a-Box knows to use the uppercase of the 3, which is #.)
Tip: The fastest way to type in chords is to use your left hand to type in the chords. Your right hand stays on the cursor keys (or
mouse) to advance the highlight cell to the next bar/beat after you've typed in the chords.
Shortcut Chords.
If you enter a lot of songs, you'll appreciate these shortcut keys:
- J = Maj7
- H=m7b5 (H stands for Half diminished)
- D=dim
- S=Sus
Example: To type CMaj7, just type CJ (it will be entered as CMaj7).
Add your own chord shortcuts.
Have you found a chord that Band-in-a-Box doesn't recognize? If so, add it to your chord shortcuts file, and Bandin-a-Box will allow you to type in that chord in the future. You can also define chord “shortcuts,” one-letter
abbreviations for longer chord names (“J” for “Maj7” etc.).
To add your own chords and shortcuts, make a text file called shortcut.txt in your Band-in-a-Box folder. Note that
this file doesn't ship with Band-in-a-Box; if it did it would overwrite your file! Shortcuts supplied by PG Music are
in a file named pgshortc.txt, which should be used only by PG Music.
If you find a chord that Band-in-a-Box won't accept like Csus2, when it expects C2 instead, you can enter this as a
single line in shortcut.txt, “sus2@2” (without the quotes). Band-in-a-Box will then enter the chord C2 if you type in
Csus2, in other words you can type in Csus2 and the program will accept it. You can also use it for shortcuts, just as
j@maj7 lets you type Cj for CMaj7. See the file pgshortc.txt for examples of shortcuts.
MIDI Chord Recognition
Another way of entering chords is through MIDI chord recognition. Play any chord on your external MIDI
keyboard or MIDI guitar controller and Band-in-a-Box will recognize it instantly and insert it onto the Chordsheet.
This allows you to enter an entire song without having to type any of the chords. It’s also a good way to find the
right name for a chord.
To use this feature, select the menu command M | Insert current MIDI chord, or press the Ctrl+Enter keys. The
last chord you played on your MIDI keyboard controller will be automatically inserted into your song (chordsheet or
notation view) at the current cursor location. Then, Band-in-a-Box is ready for the next chord. You can insert up to
two chords per bar in this fashion.
Erase Chords
To erase chords, place the highlight cell over top of the chords you would like to erase. Press the [spacebar] once.
Then move your cursor to the right or left, or mouse click on another measure and the chord will be erased.
Insert or Delete Bars
Inserting or deleting measures in the Chordsheet saves a lot of copying or re-typing of chords when changes are
made to an arrangement. The commands to insert or delete bars from the Chordsheet are:
-
To insert bars choose Edit | Insert Measure(s) or
-
To delete bars choose Edit | Delete Measure(s) or
+i and you can insert a given # of bars.
+d and you can delete a given # of bars.
Breaks: Rests, Shots, and Held Chords
Breaks are points in a song when one or more of the instruments rests, plays a shot, or holds a chord.
Rests
You can have any, some, or all instruments rest at any bar. For example, you could rest all instruments except the
bass for the first 4 bars, then add in the piano for 4 bars, and then add in the entire band for the rest of the song. You
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
91
may optionally disable the rests in the middle or final choruses (where people are likely taking solos, and rests are
not appropriate).
A chord is specified as a REST by adding 1 period after the chord.
indicates a C chord that is a REST.
Shots
You can make certain instruments play a “shot” where the chord is played and then a rest follows. For example, the
song “Rock Around The Clock” has a shot on beat 1 followed by a rest for 2 bars.
A chord is specified as a SHOT by adding 2 periods after the chord.
indicates a C chord that is a SHOT.
Held Chords
You can specify that certain instruments hold a chord sustained for a certain number of bars. For example, you can
have the bass and piano hold a chord sustained while the drums continue to play a pattern
A chord is HELD by adding 3 periods after the chord.
indicates a C chord that is a HELD.
In these examples, bar 1 has a normal chord and bar 2 has a chord with a break on it (a rest, shot, or held chord).
2 bars of C chord (no break on bar 2).
This is the usual situation without any break. Note that the piano
plays rhythmically on bar 2.
Rest on bar 2.
This rests the instruments until the next chord on the Chordsheet.
The rest is typed in as a C chord followed by one period.
A shot is put on bar 6.
The shot plays a staccato chord on bar 6, and then rests until
the next chord on the Chordsheet. The shot is typed as a C
chord followed by two periods.
92
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
This illustrates a held chord on bar 10.
The chord on bar 10 is held (sustained) until the next chord on the
Chordsheet. The held chord is typed in as a C followed by three
periods.
“Breaks” for only some instruments.
You can specify that some instruments not be affected by the break. The coded names for the instruments are:
- B for Bass
- D for Drums
- P for Piano
- G for Guitar
- S for Strings
C.bd To exempt instruments, add their letters following the break. Typing
c.bd will put a rest on all instruments EXCEPT the bass and drums.
C...p
This will put a held chord on all instruments except the piano.
Pushes
Pushes in Styles.
“Pushes” (also called anticipations) are chords that are played before the beat. For example, in Jazz Swing, the
piano player often “pushes” a chord change by playing the chord an eighth note before the beat. Styles can push any
instrument so that the instrument plays before the chord begins. This is very common in Jazz and other Pop music,
and gives the music a more natural sound.
You need not be concerned with pushes that are in the styles as they happen automatically. You need only to be
aware that the styles can push the instruments. This makes styles sound much better, and more syncopated.
Pushes in Songs.
Chords can be pushed by an 8th or 16th note. For example, you can specify a chord to occur a 16th note before the
beat and all instruments, including drums, will play this.
You can also specify that a chord change should happen before the beat. To do this, you can either use keystrokes,
or the chord options dialog box. To use keystrokes:
- Type the caret symbol (^) before the chord. (The caret symbol is located above the 6 on the keyboard).
- Type a single caret to get a chord an eighth note before the beat.
e.g.
-
^C7
Type a double caret to get a chord a sixteenth note before the beat.
e.g.
^^C7
In Jazz styles (and other triplet feels), the chord will be pushed by a triplet, regardless if there is a single or double
caret (^^).
Shots, Holds and Pushes in RealTracks
Simply type in the chords as you normally would, adding periods (…) for shots and holds, and the RealTracks will
play them. Note that for this, you need the LibraryM/Holds folder in your RealTracks folder.
Not all RealTracks styles have shots, holds, and pushes available, so check the “H” column in the RealTracks Picker
to see if the style has them.
- If the column is blank they are available and installed.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
93
- If the column shows the letter “n” the Holds files are available but not installed. Check the support pages of the
PG Music web site, www.pgmusic.com, for RealTracks updates.
- If the column shows a dash “–” no holds are available for the style.
Assuming that you have the Holds files for the RealTracks that you are generating, then you just use Band-in-a-Box
as you would normally, and type chords with shots (e.g. C..), holds (C…) or pushes (^C or ^^C for 8th or 16th note
push), or combinations of push and hold (^C…).
Chord Settings Dialog Box
Chord settings control the “breaks"” in a song when one or more of the instruments rests, plays a shot, or holds a
chord. These breaks are all referred to as Rest Types in Band-in-a-Box, and they can be entered along with the
chord name or with keystrokes. Chords can also be “pushed,” which makes them play early, i.e., ahead of the beat.
There is an alternative to the various keystrokes to put in rest types and pushes for chords. You can use the Chord
Settings dialog box instead.
Click with your mouse to place the highlight cell on the chord you want to edit. Then, you can get to the dialog box
by selecting Chord Settings from the Chordsheet right-click contextual menu (shown) or from the Edit menu.
The Chord Settings dialog also opens with the key combination Option+Z.
This dialog allows you to select the various breaks (Rests, Shots, and Held Chords) and pushes by clicking on the
relevant Chord Settings.
94
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Beat and Chord
First you need to pick the beat in the bar where the setting will be applied. You can also type in new chords on the
different beats.
Pushes
"“Pushes"” (sometimes called anticipations) are chords that are played before the beat. For example, in Jazz Swing
the piano player often pushes a chord change by playing the chord an eighth note before the beat.
Depending on the feel for the style in use, chords can be entered on either 16th or 8th note resolution. You can
specify a chord to occur a 16th note before the beat for example, and all instruments will play this, including drums.
Rest Types
The Rest Types are No Rest, Rest Only, Shot, and Hold Chord
Rest Only
Rests can specify any, some, or all instruments to rest at any bar. For example, you could rest all instruments except
the bass for the first 4 bars, and then add in the piano for 4 bars, and then add in the entire band for the rest of the
song. You may optionally disable the rests in the middle or final choruses (where people are likely taking solos, and
rests are not appropriate).
Shot
You can specify certain instruments play a "“shot,",” where the chord is played and then a rest follows. For example
the song "“Rock Around The Clock"” has a shot on beat 1 followed by a rest for seven beats.
Hold Chord
You can specify that certain instruments hold a chord sustained for a certain number of bars. For example, you can
have the bass and piano hold a chord sustained while the drums continue to play a pattern.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
95
Pedal Bass
You can enter pedal bass with any
chord. For example, if you are in the key of F and would like to pedal on a C note for 2 bars (on an Fm7 chord),
then type in the settings as above. This will play the rhythm specified – in this case the pattern will play on beat 2
and 4.
Other options are <No Pedal Bass>, Beat 2 and 4 Octaves, Beat 1 and 3 (Slow Tempos), Whole Note, and Eighth
Notes.
Clear All
The [Clear All] button erases all rests, shots, pushes, and pedal bass from a song.
Copying and Pasting a Section of Chords
Copying a section of chords is done in a manner similar to copying text in a word processor. Highlight the area you
would like to affect and select the desired action(s) from the EDIT menu. (See below for additional details.)
Copying chords to the clipboard.
- Select the region to copy.
- Place the mouse cursor at the bar to begin the selection.
- Then, holding down the mouse button, drag the mouse over the region. As you do this, you’ll see that the
region will be highlighted (white on black).
- When you have selected (highlighted) the proper region of chords to copy, you can copy the selected region to
the clipboard with the keystrokes +c, or by selecting Copy from the Edit menu.
Pasting chords to the Chordsheet.
When you have copied some chords to the clipboard you can then paste them into the Chordsheet by:
- Moving the highlight cell to the destination bar where you want to begin the paste of chords. This can be done
by clicking that bar with the mouse, or by moving the highlight cell with the cursor arrows on the computer
keyboard.
- Press +v or select Paste from the Edit menu.
Tip: Remember that the copied section remains in the clipboard and can be used repeatedly. Example: If you're inputting a song
with verse, verse, bridge, verse, you can just copy the first verse to the Clipboard, and then paste in the other verses. The clipboard
remains even if you load in a new song, so you can copy and paste between songs.
Copy Chords and/or Melody
Copy and paste the chords, melody, and solo for a range of bars in the Copy Chords and/or Melody dialog.
Press the [Copy] button to launch this dialog box, or select Edit | Copy From.. To, or press
Option+C.
The settings allow you to specify the
location to copy from, the number of
bars to copy, the location to copy to,
and the option to copy any or all of
the chords, melody, and/or soloist.
96
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Copy Rests
The Copy Rests dialog is opened with the Edit | Copy Rests menu command.
With this feature you can copy the attributes of a chord over a range of other chords. Rests also include shots and
held chords. The settings allow you
to specify the bar and beat to copy
from, the number of bars to copy, and
the location to copy to.
Erase Chords and/or Melody
To erase chords with additional control for erasing the melody and/or soloist choose Edit | Erase From.. To.. or
press Option+K to launch the Erase Chords and / or melody dialog box:
As you can see, you can erase a number of bars of chords and/or melody and/or soloist. If you're erasing the melody
and/or soloist, you need to specify which chorus you're erasing.
Support for Non-Standard Chord display types.
In addition to the Standard Notation window, you can also enter or display chords in Roman Numeral notation,
Nashville notation, Solfeggio notation, or Fixed Do notation.
For example, the chord Gm7 in the key of F would be displayed as IIm7 (in Roman Numeral Notation), 2m7 (in
Nashville Notation), and Rem7 in Solfeggio. In Italy and other parts of Europe, chords like C7 are always referred to
by the Solfeggio name (“Do 7” for C7) regardless of the key signature.
These systems are very useful for learning or analyzing tunes, because they are independent of the key signature.
You can take an existing song and print it out in Roman Numeral Notation, so you can study the chord progression.
You can also just type a chord in any of these systems, like “4” which will enter the 4 chord in the current key, and
switch between systems without having to retype the chords.
This setting is made by selecting from the “Chord Display Type” list in the Preferences dialog. To open
the Preferences, select the [Prefs] button or press Option+P or Command+comma.
Click on the “Chord Display Type” box and choose from the
list of five options;
1. Normal.
2. Roman Numeral.
3. Nashville Notation.
4. Solfeggio Notation.
5. Fixed Do.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
97
When a new notation mode is selected a message will report the change on the main screen. Click anywhere in the
message box to close it.
The Roman numeral and other non-standard displays use superscript for the chord display when in the Notation
window (or print out), so they look best in the Notation window.
maj7
Tip: Print out a song in Nashville Notation or Roman Numeral notation. Then learn the song this way (i.e. 1
7b9
6 ). You'll then discover that it is much easier to play the song in any key.
4maj7 3
m7b5
Part Markers
Part Markers are placed on the Chordsheet to indicate a new part of the song. They are used to change substyles or
insert drum fills.
These are part markers. They typically occur every 8 bars or so, but may be placed at the beginning
of any bar.
Placing Part Markers.
- Move the highlight cell to the bar that you want the part marker at. Then press the letter p on the computer
keyboard. Repeatedly pressing the letter p will toggle between the “a” and “b” part markers or no part marker.
- Or you can position the mouse arrow directly over the bar line (or existing part marker). Repeatedly click the
mouse button to toggle between “a,” “b,” and no part marker.
Changing Substyles.
The part markers also represent the two available substyles (variations) for each style, the “a”
substyle and the “b” substyle.
The song continues to play in one substyle until it encounters a new part marker. There will always be a part marker
at bar 1 so that Band-in-a-Box knows what substyle to begin with.
Substyle “a” is usually used for the Verses of the song.
Substyle “b” is usually used for the Bridge of the song, and for soloing in the Middle Choruses. All of the middle
choruses of the song will automatically play in the “b” substyle. This is great for Jazz songs, allowing you to play
swing throughout the middle (soloing) choruses and revert to the “a” substyle for the last chorus.
Note: If you want to keep the same substyle in the middle choruses, you would need to uncheck the “Vary Style in Middle
Choruses” option in the Additional Song Settings option on the Song menu.
Adding More Substyles
…
You can add more substyles to an
individual song with a right-click on any
bar number. This opens the Substyle
Change Menu where you can define up
to 24 substyles, from “a” to “x.”
98
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
MultiStyles
Band-in-a-Box MultiStyles have four substyles, “a” through “d.”
There is a MultiStyles category in the StylePicker that opens a list of available MultiStyles.
Standard Pop song form with 4 substyle MultiStyle
As a general rule for styles with 4 substyles:
- “a” substyle is for the verse.
- “b” substyle is for the chorus.
- “c” substyle is for the intro (or first verse).
- “d” substyle is for the break (or interlude).
Placing Drum Fills.
A one bar drum fill will play in the bar preceding (leading into) a part marker, just as a live drummer will play a fill
to accent the transition between sections of a song. If you want a drum fill to play in bar 7 of a song, insert a part
marker at bar 8. You can either retain the current substyle or change the substyle (“a” or “b”) when you place the
part marker.
Edit Bar Settings
Bar settings let you change meter, tempo, styles, key, volume levels, patches, and harmonies at any bar. They are a
powerful tool for adding variety and dynamics to create a highly professional finished arrangement in Band-in-aBox.
After you have selected a bar, press the F5 function key or the keystrokes Option+B, or select Bar Settings from the
Edit menu, to open the Edit bar settings dialog. Settings such as number of beats per bar, tempo changes, style
changes, patch changes, and harmony changes can be made in this dialog.
Tip: If the F5 key (or F8 key) does not perform the expected function in Band-in-a-Box you will need to go to the Apple System
Preferences and uncheck the system setting in the Keyboard Shortcuts list.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
99
When making any changes to a measure using the Edit bar settings dialog box, Band-in-a-Box will place a colored
indicator box around the measure number of the edited measure.
Settings apply to Chorus # is a setting that lets you apply the changes at the specified bar in all choruses or just in
the chorus you choose.
# beats this bar sets the number of beats in a bar.
The initial time signature of the song is determined by the style (e.g. Jazz =4/4, Waltz =3/4). In certain songs you
will want to insert time signature changes at a certain bar. For example you might want a single bar of 2/4, or 8 bars
of 3/4 time etc.
This option allows a change of time signature during a song. The change takes place at the beginning of the bar and
continues until a new time signature change is specified. You can select # beats per bar from 1 to 4 beats per bar. A
setting of 0 beats/bar is used for no change of time signature.
Examples:
- A song in 4/4 time with a single bar of 6/4 time. Since the maximum # beats per bar is = 4 we will split the 6/4
bars into 2 bars, a 4/4 bar and a 2/4 bar. Insert a # beats per bar = 2 at the beginning of the 2/4 bar and then restore
the time signature to 4/4 by assigning # beats per bar = 4 for the next bar.
A song in 5/4 time throughout: To do this we will alternately create a 3/4 bar + 2/4 bars. On odd numbered bars
insert a # beats per bar = 3, and on even bars insert # of beats per bar = 2. This needs to be done for every bar.
Style Changes at any Bar
You can specify a new style at any bar of the song, so that you can use many styles within the same song. To
change styles at any bar:
-
Move the cursor highlight bar to the bar for the style change.
Press the F5 key to open the Edit bar settings dialog (or choose the Edit | Bar Settings menu command, or use
the keystrokes Option+B).
Use the [Style…] button to select a style using the StylePicker dialog.
Use the [*.sty] button to select a style from a folder on your hard drive. You should select a style
that is present in the Styles folder in Band-in-a-Box (or the same folder where the song resides).
The name of the new style you choose will be displayed.
To remove the style change at this bar, press the [Clear Style Change]
button.
There is an option to send the embedded patches in the style with
the style change. Disable this checkbox if you want to keep the patches that you have already selected.
Note: If you want to mix styles with 3/4 and 4/4 time signatures you should make the main style used in the song a 4/4 style.
You could then change back to 3/4 at bar 1 if you want.
When you select a style change, you'll notice that there is a red frame drawn around the bar line. This indicates that
there is a style change (or other change at that bar) found in the Edit bar settings dialog.
RealDrums Changes at any Bar
RealDrums can be changed at any bar, either for the whole song or just for the selected chorus. To select the new
RealDrums style, press the [R.Drums] button. This will open the RealDrums Picker where
you can choose from a full list of RealDrums or filter the list to narrow your selection.
You’ll see the new style name displayed onscreen.
To remove the change click on [Clear RealDrums change].
Tempo Change At This Bar
Most songs will have a single tempo throughout, but if you want to change the tempo at a certain bar of the song,
then use this dialog box to type in the new tempo in beats per minute. Or type in a relative tempo change in a range
100
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
of –90 to +100. A setting of –50 halves the tempo, a setting of 100 doubles it.
Tempo can also be set by clicking on the metronome button. Clicking on this button
4 times will set the tempo to your tapped-in value. The tempo change takes effect at
the beginning of the bar and remains until a new tempo change at another bar is
inserted.
Volume Changes
Volume levels can be changed at any bar, either for All parts or for each part individually.
Changes can be entered manually, or selected from presets.
The presets include settings to Mute a part, to reset the volume Back to Normal,
and to automatically fade levels.
Patch Changes at any Bar.
This setting allows you to insert a patch change at the beginning of any bar. Type the General MIDI number of the
patch change in the appropriate box (i.e. Bass, Soloist, etc.) that you want to affect.
Note: To save a song with patch changes at the beginning of the song you should use the Edit | Save Song with Patches… dialog
instead of this one.
Harmony Changes at this Bar
You can insert harmony changes into the song at any bar and beat. For example, start the song with “no harmony”
then have “SuperSax” come in on the bridge, then “Shearing” on the next chorus, etc. This is also effective when
used with the Soloist on the Thru part. With this setting, you can have multiple types of horn section solos (i.e.
Brass, Sax, etc.) or harmonized distortion guitar effects for guitar solos.
Clear Changes
The [Clear Bar] button clears all changes from the current bar, as determined by the
location of the highlight cell on the Chordsheet.
Press the [Clear all Bars] button to remove all changes in all bars in the song.
Chord Preview/Builder
You can instantly hear how any chord sounds by selecting it in the Chordsheet and pressing Shift+Return, or use
the “Chord Builder” feature to audition different chords until you find the one that sounds best to you. In other
words, you can enter chords “by ear” without having to know the actual chord names or any music theory. This
feature also illustrates the differences between various chord types.
Previewing Chords
This feature allows you to hear chords as you to type them in. When you are entering chords onto the Chordsheet
(or notation window), after you type a chord name, press Shift+Return. This enters the chord onto the Chordsheet
and then plays the chord for you, using the patches on the Piano part and Bass part. You can also listen to a chord
that has already been entered, by just pressing Shift+Return after moving to that bar with the chord. If there is no
chord entered at that bar, you will hear the last chord that was entered.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
101
You can also preview chords from the Chord Settings dialog. Press Option+Z to launch the dialog, and then press
the [Preview] button to hear the current chord in the Chord Options dialog.
Chord Builder
This feature allows you to hear and build chords up by clicking on the root, extension (and alternate root if
applicable). You can launch the chord builder by choosing the User | Chord Builder menu option or with the
keystrokes Ctrl+Shift+H.
You'll then see the following Chord Builder dialog:
You can click on the root of the chord (in the “Root” group), the extension (Maj7 etc.), and also an alternate “slashnote” root. For example, to make the chord F9/A, you would click on the “F” root, the “9” extension, and the Slash
Root of /A. As you click on them, you'll hear the bass note played on the Bass part, and the extension played on the
Piano track.
If you are happy with the sound of the chord, you can press the [Enter Chord] button to enter the chord at the bar
and beat specified. If you would like the chord to be inserted automatically when you click on the note/extension
names, select the “Enter chord when clicked” option. Change the Bar/Beat settings to enter at a different bar.
The Chord Builder can be left open as you work entering chords into Band-in-a-Box. Remember that you can also
play chords in from the MIDI keyboard by pressing Ctrl+Enter after you've played a chord on the keyboard.
Chordsheet Contextual Menu
The Chordsheet contextual menu opens with a right click or Control+click on the Chordsheet area.
102
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
In addition to quick access to editing features it also
includes shortcuts to major features for editing
arrangements and making program settings.
Chords can be copied, pasted, cut, or erased and
new chords can be entered from the Chord Builder.
The Chord Settings allow pushes, rests, and pedal
bass to be applied.
The Bar Settings let you refine your arrangement
with changes in tempo, meter, key signature, styles,
RealDrums, volume levels, patches, and harmonies.
Song Settings allow rests and pushes, and also
control tags, endings, and fadeouts.
Global system settings are accessed in the
Preferences.
You can select bars for the beginning and end of the
chorus, and for the song ending.
Start playback from the bar that is selected in any
chorus.
MIDI file “Chord Wizard”
This allows you to read in the chords from any MIDI file and write them onto the Band-in-a-Box chordsheet.
- First, blank the song by choosing File | New.
- Choose File | Import Chords from MIDI File (or press Ctrl+Option+I).
- You'll see this Chord Wizard dialog:
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
103
Press the [Open (Change)…] button, and select the MIDI file to import.
Choose a preset, and the Chord Wizard will interpret the chords in that
style.
Press the [INTERPRET CHORDS NOW] button to see the chords written
into the Band-in-a-Box chordsheet.
Chord Wizard results – interpreting from a Standard MIDI File.
The dialog has options to read channels into the Melody and/or Soloist tracks.
Read in Chords from a PG Music or Band-in-a-Box MIDI file.
Many of PG Music's programs have MIDI files with the chords in them. You can open these files in Band-in-a-Box,
and the chords will be imported onto the Chordsheet. To import the chords from a PG Music MIDI file (i.e. a MIDI
file made by Band-in-a-Box, PowerTracks Pro or some other PG Music programs), choose the menu item File |
Import Chords from MIDI File and select “OK to use PG Music chord names from MIDI file.” The chords will then
appear on the lead sheet starting at bar 1, overwriting any chords that were there previously.
“Jazz Up” the Chords; “Jazz Down” the Chords.
When switching genres (from Pop to Jazz, or Jazz to Pop), it’s often necessary to change the chords from
“Pop/Rock” chords (C) to Jazz type chords (Like CMaj7). Now you can quickly do this, by new menu options
called “Jazz Up,” “Jazz Down.” Choose the menu item User | “Jazz Up” … or User | “Jazz Down” … to do this:
- “Jazz Up” - This function simply converts triads to 7th chords, producing a lead sheet more suitable for Jazz. If
you have a song with triad chords like C or Dm, you can choose to “Jazz Up” the chords. When you do this,
you get an option of whether you'd like to see Maj7, Maj6 or Dominant 7th for the major triads.
- “Jazz Down” - This function converts 7th chords to triads, for a lead sheet more suited to Pop music.
Applying Styles
There are many styles available for use with the Band-in-a-Box program. For the purposes of this program, styles
refer to styles of music, i.e. Jazz Swing, Tango, Blues, Pop Ballad, etc. Either before or after you have entered the
chords to a song, you will have to pick one of these styles. Once a style is loaded, the song will be played back in
that style. Current Style Window
104
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
The name of the current style appears under the name of the song in the Title window. It is also displayed under
User | Current Style and information on the current style can be viewed by selecting Style Information… from the
User menu.
The favorite styles button [F] activates a window that keeps a list of the 150 styles you have
used most recently. The [F] button launches the Favorites / Recently Played dialog. (User
| Load Favorite Styles... also opens this window.)
The “Favorites” and “Recently Played” Radio buttons toggle between a list of your recently played styles and your
Favorite songs styles. This lets you quickly load in styles that have been used your last few sessions with Band-ina-Box.
The favorites list will start off as an empty one, but you can add songs/styles as your
favorites by clicking the [Add Favorite] button. (This button is also found in the StylePicker.)
Check the “Play When Chosen” checkbox to have Band-in-a-Box play your song
immediately upon selecting a style.
When “OK to add recent files” is checked, Band-in-a-Box automatically
adds styles to the list.
Use the [Search] button to save time scrolling up and down the list.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
105
When you have made your selection, press [OK] to load the chosen style.
Click on [Cancel] to return to the main screen without changing the style.
Types of Styles
Band-in-a-Box originally used MIDI styles, with well over one thousand available in a wide variety of musical
genres. This version also includes RealStyles with audio tracks generated from live recordings of top studio
musicians.
Built-In MIDI Styles
For a quick generic choice that will give you a good general idea of how your arrangement sounds, you can use the
original Styles menu to pick a “built-in” style.
The first 24 styles that we made were built into the program, and are still referred to as “Built-in Styles.” These
styles are no longer built into the program, making them editable like all other Band-in-a-Box styles.
The built-in styles may be selected from the Styles pull down menu. They are a convenient way to quickly apply a
basic style to a song.
User MIDI Styles
The other styles that we make are called user styles because they are editable.
The user styles may be selected,
- by clicking on the [Style] button, or
- from the Sty pull down menu, or
- by selecting Load Style from Disk… from the User menu, or
- by pressing +u.
Holding down control or option while clicking on the style load button will restrict the files to (A-K) or (L-Z).
These instructions are given in a message if an overflow of too many files has occurred. This works wherever you
load in styles with a File | Open type of dialog.
RealStyles (Audio)
RealStyles are styles that use RealTracks and RealDrums with audio tracks generated from live recordings by top
studio musicians. There is also a category for Styles w/ RealTracks, which use a mix of audio and MIDI tracks.
Styles with RealDrums use MIDI instruments with audio RealDrums.
Styles can also be selected by mouse clicking directly on the name of the style in the Title window. The Select Style
window (StylePicker) will appear.
The StylePicker
The Select Style window, also known as the StylePicker, is opened by pressing the [Style] button.
It lists all of the styles that are present in the
Band-in-a-Box folder. The StylePicker window opens up at the current style.
106
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
The StylePicker allows easy selection of styles by category or from a complete list of all styles. For example, you
can select Jazz styles and see a list of all of your Jazz styles. Then you can select any style to see its full title,
description, and examples of songs appropriate to the style.
The current style of the song is listed at the top of the window; in this case it is the Jazz Swing style
(ZZJAZZ.Style). This is referred to as the Prototype Style.
The prototype style can be changed to the current selection that is highlighted in the list by pressing the [*Change
Prototype Style] button.
There are filters to display only styles of a certain “Feel” or “Tempo” or only the styles of a certain Styles Set
number, as well as displaying the name of the Styles Set. To select this, open the StylePicker, and choose the
option you want with the “Show Styles:” setting.
When you pick Disk #, you can then see only that Styles Set listed, regardless of the category you are in.
RealStyles and Styles with RealTracks
RealTracks, live audio recordings by top studio players and recording artists, replace MIDI tracks and can be
controlled just like MIDI instruments (volume changes, muting, etc.). Best of all, they follow the chord progression
that you have entered, generating an authentic audio accompaniment to your song. They are not “samples,” but are
full recordings, lasting from 1 to 8 bars at a time, playing along in perfect sync with the other Band-in-a-Box tracks.
RealTracks can be built in to styles to replace some or all of the MIDI parts.
RealStyles are Band-in-a-Box styles that use RealTracks only. There is a separate category in the StylePicker for
RealStyles.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
107
It also lists Styles with RealTracks, a blend of MIDI tracks and
RealTracks, with subsets for different musical genres.
The style names for RealStyles are prefaced by an underscore, _.
Style names for Styles with RealTracks are prefaced by an equals sign, =.
Styles with RealDrums
The StylePicker has another category called Styles with RealDrums.
This lists many RealDrums styles that we’ve made. We always name the RealDrums style beginning with a minus
sign, so that “-ZZJAZZ.STY” would be the ZZJAZZ style, but using RealDrums instead of MIDI drums.
MultiStyles
Original Band-in-a-Box styles had two substyle variations, “a” and “b.” Band-in-a-Box MultiStyles have
four substyles, “a” through “d.” There is a MultiStyles category in the StylePicker that opens a list of your
available MultiStyles. The Memo describes each substyle variation.
Standard Pop song form with 4 substyle MultiStyle
As a general rule for styles with 4 substyles:
- “a” substyle is for the verse.
- “b” substyle is for the chorus.
- “c” substyle is for the intro (or first verse).
- “d” substyle is for the break (or interlude).
Choosing Styles
For each style, you see the following information:
-
108
The asterisk (*) or (^) caret indicates if the style is a perfect or good match to the prototype style.
ZZJAZZ is the name of the style file.
“sw” indicates that the style is in a Swing feel vs. “EV” for Even feel.
The “8” indicates that the style is an 8th note feel (vs. 16th note feel).
160 is the tempo for this style.
Jazz Swing Style is the full name of the style.
SD #0 indicates that the style is found on Styles Disk #0, one of the original 24 Band-in-a-Box styles.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Styles that are similar to the prototype are indicated with an asterisk (*). These are styles that have the same feel
(triplets/eighths/sixteenths) and a similar tempo range. Styles with similar feel but a different tempo range are
marked by a caret (^) symbol. So you can quickly see styles that are similar to Jazz Swing (in this example). The
styles J_BASIE and J_DIXIE could be substituted with a perfect match so are marked with an asterisk (*). Styles
like J_DJANGO are marked with a caret (^) because they sound best in a much faster tempo than the prototype Jazz
Swing style.
Use the filters to display all styles, or only ones that you choose.
Click on the OK button to make your selection.
Auditioning Styles
You can press the [Preview] button. The [Preview] button generates and plays an
arrangement with the new style; use the [Stop] button to end the preview.
Change the tempo by typing in a new tempo in the t= field at the top.
Click to update the tempo.
The [Song Demo] button plays the style demo song directly from the StylePicker window.
You can [Reduce] or [Expand] the duration of the chords, useful when changing the feel
of songs.
If the “Prompt With Preview” item is set, the program will ask you if you
want to change the feel of the song's melody, or auto-reduce/expand the
chord durations when the styles change.
When a new style is previewed, patches appropriate to the new style get
loaded in if you have selected “Auto Change Melody/Soloist Patch.”
So when you load in a “Chopin Piano Style” the Melody patch of your song will change to Piano. This allows the
song to blend in with the new style.
When this option is set you can double click on a style name in the list to
hear a preview of your song in the new style.
Other Options
Check this checkbox to play the selected song as soon as you press [OK].
Select this option and when you choose a style with the
song playing, it will switch to the new style and continue playing!
When this option is checked, the prototype style will be
the style that is currently assigned to the song.
List Management
This adds the currently selected style to the list of Favorite styles. Favorites have a letter
“F” beside their name in the left
column of the Styles list, they also appear in the Favorite Styles dialog.
If this option is selected, only styles that are favorites will appear in the Styles list.
If you have added new styles to Band-in-a-Box (or edited the BBW.LST file) the
StylePicker’s [Re-Build] button will update the styles list.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
109
This will copy the Styles List to the clipboard. It can then be printed as a text file from any
word processor.
This sets the StylePicker to show all styles. It is an easy way to restore the full list after a
filter has been applied
The [Search] button lets you find data in any of the fields.
Click on the [OK] button to make your selection.
Support for Third Party Styles
Third party styles with LS3 files are supported in the StylePicker. LS3 files have the information for Third Party
styles. If you have third party styles and an LS3 file from the third party, add these files to the
Data folder. Then press the Rebuild button inside the StylePicker, to see your styles listed.
About LS3 Files
LS3 files add information to the StylePicker dialog about your styles. The LS3 files are for third party added styles
and style data descriptions.
An LS3 file cannot exceed 65,000 bytes (65K). If you need more, use 2 LS3 files. The style data and descriptions
show up in the style picker dialog.
- Lines beginning with @ are for style descriptions (memos etc.).
- Lines beginning with the 3 chars ;^@ are for the style data.
More information on the format of the style data line is found at pgmusic.com/styledata.htm.
Here's a summary of the style data line (on the next 4 lines):
; stylename,soloist# to use (1-255),soloist type to use (see list on web),double time OK (false/true),
; time sign. (3 or 4),straight or swing (sw/ev),16ths or 8ths (8/16),tempolow(30-500),
; tempo high range (30-500), tempo mid range (30-500), style disk # (0-30000) PG uses 1-255),
; melody patch to use (1-128 or higher-see list on web),soloist patch to use (1-128 or higher-see list).
Choose a “Built-In” style or click on the [User Song+Style] button to choose from the file dialog.
Style Aliases
Let's say you have a new style for Jazz called “Dizzy.” You can create an alias so that when Band-in-a-Box looks
for a Jazz Swing style, it will load in “Dizzy” instead, so you don't have to change all your songs that were made
with the old style. And when you find a new favorite style, just change the alias.
Aliases are accessed by the MIDI | Style Aliases… menu item.
110
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
To make an alias, click on the [Choose] button under the “Original Style” heading to select the original style in the
Styles folder. Then click on the [Choose] button under “Substitution” to select the style you would like to substitute
in its place.
The [Clear] button will clear the styles chosen for the style alias that is currently selected in the “List of Style
Aliases.”
You can temporarily disable the Style Aliases feature by unchecking the “Allow Any Style Aliases” checkbox.
You can also have confirmation of substitutions by checking the “Confirm Substitutions” checkbox.
When you are using an alias, you will notice that there will be a small arrowhead in the Title window on the main
screen indicating that you have an alias loaded. Aliases are stored in files called *.ALI.
Alias for ZZJAZZ.Style indicated by the > symbol.
Playing, Pausing, and Stopping Songs
Playing Songs
There are several ways to play a song in Band-in-a-Box, either starting from the beginning or from a
specified place in the song.
To generate a new Band-in-a-Box arrangement and play the song from the start you can either,
- Press the [Play] button, or
- Press the keystrokes
+a, or
- Press the F4 function key, or
- Select the menu command Song | Play.
To play a song in Band-in-a-Box from a particular measure,
Press the [From] button and select the bar from which to play, or
With the song stopped, type the letter x on the computer keyboard to restart from the current location of the
highlight cell, or
- Select Play From Bar # from the Song menu, or
- Press Ctrl+F.
Double clicking on the spreadsheet or notation will start playback from that point, without re-generating the song
(unless needed due to a change in the song).
-
-
Replay plays a song without constructing it first. To replay a song in Band-in-a-Box,
Press the [Replay] button, or
Select Replay Already Constructed Song from the File menu, or
Press the keystrokes +r, or
Press the x key.
Pausing Songs
-
There are several ways to pause a Band-in-a-Box song.
Press the [Pause] button.
Select Hold (Pause) from the Song menu.
Press the delete key.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
111
Stopping Songs
-
To stop a Band-in-a-Box song;
Press the [Stop] button, or
Select the Stop option from the Song menu, or
Press the esc key.
Changing Volume, Panning, Reverb, Chorus, Bank
To change the volume, panning, reverb, chorus, or bank of a part:
1. Select the part by clicking on the desired part to change.
2.
Then click in the box for the desired setting to affect.
3.
Clicking on the number in the box will change the value by 1. To increase the setting, click on the upper
half of the number. Click on the lower half of the number to decrease the setting by 1.
4. Clicking on the gray vertical bars to the right of the box will increase or decrease the setting by 5, except
for Bank settings. Bank numbers start at 0 and then go up by multiples of 8 (8, 16, 24, 32, etc.) until they
reach 127.
5. The range of settings is from 0 to 127 except for Pan, which goes from –63 (hard left) to 64 (hard right)
with 0 in the center of the stereo field.
Another option is to Control+click on the name of the setting to open a dialog box where you can directly type in a
value.
Clicking on the piano keyboard sets the Volume of the current instrument, and the range is the same range as the
piano (0 to 127), i.e., a click on the bottom C sets a value of 0 and the top B is value 127.
The default setting is Volume, but for other settings like REV, CHR, PAN, or BANK click on the
label first and then set your levels by clicking keys on the piano keyboard. For PAN, the lowest key
(C) sets a value of -63 and the top key (B) is 64.
Tone Control
The RealTracks bass/treble tone control adjusts the bass/treble EQ for any RealTrack.
Choose an instrument (bass/drums/piano/guitar/strings/melody) and then use the “TONE” control to
adjust the tone from -18 (maximum bass) to +18 (maximum treble). Default is 0. The settings are saved
with the song.
Audio Reverb
There is a Reverb control for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums, so you can easily add reverb (0 to
127) for any RealTrack. Reverb type is also settable, and saved with the song.
112
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
At the top of the screen, there is an “A.REV” (Audio Reverb) control. Click on an instrument radio
button, and then set the Audio Reverb for it. The Audio Reverb varies from 0 to 127.
Note that this only applies to RealTracks, since MIDI tracks have MIDI Reverb, which is set via a
“REV” control.
You can adjust the value by clicking a key on the on-screen piano keyboard. Or right-click (or control-click) the
control to enter a value. There is also a feature that automatically adds reverb to RealTracks, according to
instrument type. (No Reverb is added to Bass for example, but most instruments get reverb.)
This feature defaults to on, but you can turn it off in RealTracks Settings or Reverb Settings dialog.
If you just want more or less added, you can
adjust the “Strength %.” For example, the
default adds a reverb of 40 to most tracks, but if you set the strength to 75%, then 30 will get added.
You can also set the type of reverb. The default is a “room” type of reverb.
To do this, press the Audio Reverb button, and adjust the various parameters.
You can then save your reverb types as presets, and the current settings will also be saved with the song. The
presets all gets saved to a PGReverbSettings.bin file in Band-in-a-Box/Preferences folder.
You can enable/disable Reverb. If you disable it, this will save some CPU cycles, so this might be advisable on an
older/slower machine, if you hear that the audio is clicking or not keeping up.
Freeze Tracks
Freezing (locking) MIDI or RealTracks/RealDrums
Any track (MIDI or RealTrack) can be frozen. When frozen, it doesn’t get changed or re-generated. This saves
time when replaying previous songs, and allows you to freeze an arrangement that you like.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
113
If you freeze the whole song, you don’t have to wait
at all for the song to regenerate. Next time you play,
it is ready to go.
You can make tracks Frozen by pressing the Freeze
button (snowflake) on the toolbar, and then choosing
which tracks that you want to freeze or unfreeze.
There are a number of reasons that you would freeze
a track.
Reasons to Freeze a RealTracks track (audio):
- Frozen tracks will play back instantly, not requiring time to generate.
- They play back the same way each time, so if you like a solo, you can “freeze it.”
- If you send a song to a friend as “frozen,” they will hear the same performance.
- For the Soloist track, if you generate a solo, it can now be saved (by freezing the track).
Reasons to Freeze a MIDI track:
- You can edit the MIDI data, to customize the performance to match a certain song, and this will be saved. Use
the Notation window or Piano Roll to edit the track.
More reasons to freeze any track:
- Frozen tracks play back instantly, without requiring time to regenerate.
- They play back the same way each time.
- You can change the chord progression of the song, and have one part playing a different chord progression than
the rest of the band. For example, type a “blowing” chord progression, generate a solo, freeze the solo track, then
type a normal chord progression and generate the rest of the instruments (bass, guitar etc.) that will play the
normal changes.
- Have different instruments play different styles. For example, the Bass could be generated using Reggae, then
Frozen, and then the rest of the instruments generated using a Techno style.
Un-Freezing a Track(s)
This is also done by the Freeze button. Choose a
frozen track to un-freeze it, or choose “Un-Freeze all
tracks.”
Forcing Generation of a Song that is Frozen
Band-in-a-Box won’t touch tracks that are frozen. But if you want to change that, without having to Un-Freeze the
tracks, you can do this easily.
Hold down the SHIFT key as you press the [Play] button (the fly-by hint will remind you of that),
or go to the Song menu and choose Generate (even if tracks are frozen).
114
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
When you do this, the song will regenerate, the tracks will get rewritten, and the song will stay frozen. So if you’re
freezing songs to get the instant playback with RealTracks, but get tired of the “same-old” frozen arrangement, just
press SHIFT-PLAY, generate a new arrangement, and press SAVE. Then the new “fresh-frozen” arrangement will
play instantly, even with many RealTracks.
Tip: Obviously you wouldn’t use this feature to force regeneration of a frozen song if you have made custom edits to the song that
you don’t want to lose, unless you’ve saved the song and have a backup copy.
Saving Songs
Saving a Song
Once you have made a song, or have made changes to a song, you can easily save the song if you
- Click on one of the Save buttons, or
- Press the F2 function key, or
- Choose Save or Save song As… from the File menu, or
- Press +s.
Then type the filename for the song. Don't add the extension; Band-in-a-Box adds it for you. The extension .SGU
indicates a Band-in-a-Box song; the extension .MGU indicates a Band-in-a-Box song with a melody.
Saving song with Patches…
You can save your song with patches and other settings. This is done by selecting the [Save +] button or
the Save song with Patches… option from the File menu. If you would like to save certain patches with a
song type in the number of the instrument patch that you would like. Leave the other instruments at “0”
for no patch change.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
115
Fill Patches
To fill the patch boxes with your current patch settings, press the [Fill Patches] button. This saves you having to
type in the patches to save with songs.
controller settings, harmonies, Soloist, mixer settings, and RealDrums style in a particular song.
You can also save the instruments as “On” or “Off” for each song. For example, you could have a song with no
piano part. Usually, these settings are set to “On,” as you would normally like all members of your “band” to
participate.
To change a patch click on the down arrow beside the patch name and make a selection from the General MIDI
patch list.
Forgot the number of the patch you wanted? No problem. Just click on the [View Patches] button and up pops
your numbered patch list.
Tip: Remember that - as with all other Band-in-a-Box patch functions - you use the General MIDI #'s for the instrument, regardless
of the synth you are using.
Fill Patches
To fill the patch boxes with your current patch settings, press the [Fill Patches] button. This saves you having to
select the patches to save with songs.
Zeros
Click on this button to clear all patch changes, then no patch changes will occur.
Frozen
This will set the track into a frozen state where it gets saved with the specific arrangement and won’t get overwritten
by Band-in-a-Box. You can still edit the frozen track.
Use the [All] button to set all tracks to Frozen.
The [None] button set all tracks to not-frozen (normal).
Save Settings for…
Other parameters that can be saved (volume, reverb, etc.) are shown on the right side of the window.
You can save all settings, including patches, by selecting “Save all settings with Songs.” Uncheck this box to
customize the settings that are saved with the song.
116
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Storing Volume, Reverb, Panning, Chorus, and/or Bank Settings
You can optionally save these MIDI controller settings with your songs. You can make, for example, a song with
the piano a little quieter than usual, add reverb to the melody patch, or pan the bass to one side, etc. Simply choose
the parameters you want to save with a song and press the [Save Song] button when you are ready.
You can also choose to Save current Melody and Soloist patches with every song.
Save Current Melody Harmony with song and Save Current Thru Harmony with song will save the current
selections and reload them the next time you open the song.
Save Soloist w/song will save the Soloist track with the song.
Save/Load Thru settings with songs saves the Thru patch, volume, reverb, etc. Normally you wouldn’t save these
settings with songs.
For this song only, use this RealDrum style lets you assign a specific RealDrums style to your song. Press the
[RD] button to choose the RealDrums style.
For this song only, force MIDI drums will always use MIDI drums, not RealDrums, with the song.
When you have made all your settings, click on [Save Song] and they will be saved
with the song.
Saving a MIDI file
Your song can be saved as a Standard MIDI file with the [.MID] button in the toolbar, or with the menu command
File | Save Standard MIDI File…, or with the keystrokes Option+S. Save the file to disk or to the clipboard.
Choose which tracks get written to the MIDI File.
By muting tracks with Option+Click on the track name at the top of the screen, you can decide which tracks get
written to the MIDI file. Any track that is muted is excluded from the MIDI file.
See the Preferences dialog for MIDI file options. For example, if you don't want to create a MIDI file containing
the first 2 bars of the 1—2—1-2-3-4 count-in you can select this option, and the MIDI file will begin directly at bar
1 without the count-in. If there is a Melody pickup, then the 2 bar lead-in will remain in the file.
Preferences – User Settings
Use the Preferences to set the user options for the program.
The settings are all saved in the /Band-in-a-Box/Preferences folder in a file named Band-in-a-Box Preferences_X86.
If this file is removed the program will require the same setup as when it was first installed. This can be a way of
removing unwanted settings for a “fresh start.”
Select the [Prefs] button or press Option+P or Command+comma to go to the Preferences dialogs.
There are buttons for Preferences, Preferences 2, Soloist Prefs, Reverb, and DAW Plugin settings.
Preferences Dialog (Preferences 1)
Boost Vel. of Pushes by
The pushes in Band-in-a-Box are the chords that get played before the beat. Typically, pushes are played a little
louder than other patterns. You can leave this setting at 0, or set it to between 0 and 10.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
117
Show Chords with push/rest chars
The push character is the caret symbol (^). So a C chord with a push is displayed as ^C. The rest character is a
period (.), so C. shows a C chord with a rest.
If you prefer not to see these characters displayed, then set this to false. These characters won't show up on the
printout regardless of this setting.
Show Rests in color
If checked, pushes are displayed in GREEN, and rests are displayed in RED. This only applies to the Chordsheet
(not the notation).
Allow any Rests
You can disable the rests feature. You might want to do this if you've got a song with a lot of rests in it, and are then
having difficulty recording a melody because you don't hear the drums providing the beat (due to the drums resting).
If so, you can temporarily disable the rests so that you can record and listen to the drums.
Allow any Pushes
If for some reason you don't want a style or a song to have pushes, you can uncheck this box.
Allow Style Pushes
If for some reason you don't want a style to have pushes, you can uncheck this box.
Chord Display Type
This box allows for non-standard display of chords on the Chordsheet area. The options here allow for Normal
(standard notation), Roman Numeral notation, Nashville notation, Solfeggio notation and Fixed Do notation.
When a new notation mode is selected a message will report the change on the main screen. Click anywhere in the
message box to close it.
118
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Allow Lead In Bars
People who use Band-in-a-Box for soloing practice will likely turn the lead-in off to allow endless looping
uninterrupted by the lead-in count.
Play Lead In even if Intro present.
If a song has an intro, it’s usually not necessary to play the 2 bar lead-in count. There's a new option to always omit
the lead-in if an intro is present. If you would like the lead-in bars to be played even if an intro is present in the
song, set this feature to “On.”
Lead-in Type
You can specify to have Band-in-a-Box play 2 bars of a drum pattern instead of the count-in. You may prefer
hearing the drum beat to a simple count-in, since it provides more information about the upcoming groove.
To set this, choose Prefs | CountIn, and set Lead-in Type to one of “b” substyle fills/ “a” substyle fills/ or fill-pattern
or pattern-pattern combinations.
Audible Lead In / Volume
Use these settings for the audible drum count-in. You can select any drum instrument for the count-in. You can
choose different count-in rhythms (e.g. Tap on 2 and 4 instead of 1-2-3-4).
Instrument
Choose your pick of drum instruments for the lead-in count.
Pattern
Choose the pattern for your lead-in count from the dropdown list.
Smart Lead-ins
Smart lead-ins can also be set here; they avoid playing the count-in drum sound during a Melody pickup.
Lead-in Drum count if drums muted
This is great for drummers who play along with Band-in-a-Box and mute the drum track. Previously, when the
drum track was muted or disabled in a song, the count-in drum click wouldn't play. Use this option to play the drum
count-in in all circumstances.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
119
Metronome During Recording
Select this to hear the metronome while recording.
Allow Any Endings
Song endings can be turned off for all songs, or on a song-by-song basis.
To turn song endings off for all songs uncheck the “Allow Any Endings” option.
To turn the song ending off for a single song select the Additional Song Settings option from the Song menu and
uncheck “Generate 2 Bar Ending for This Song.”
SpaceBar Key
These different functions can be assigned to the spacebar. The default is to play from the current position, which
will also stop play when the spacebar is pressed during playback.
OK to Load Harmony w/songs
If checked, the harmony settings for each song will be loaded and saved with each song. If set to NO, the harmony
setting won't be saved or loaded with the songs. If you are using a certain harmony, you should set this setting to
NO, otherwise you'll have to keep re-selecting the harmony when you load in new songs.
Change Harmony with new chords
Example: If a harmony is played on bar 1 on a C chord, and then the note is held as the chord changes to a Fm7
chord, (if this setting checked) the harmony notes will change so that they will be still be playing chord tones. If
they don't the harmony sounds dissonant. Leave this setting checked, unless you have a specific reason to disable it.
The harmony is changed by moving the voices to the nearest chord tone.
Harmony Volume Adjust
Raise or lower the overall volume of the Harmony with a range of –128 to 128.
OK to Load Style with songs
Leave this unchecked to audition the same style with several different songs.
Use MSB for Bank (Roland)
Band-in-a-Box sends General MIDI bank changes in two ways. Most synths (e.g. Roland, Korg, Kawai) use the
Controller 0 for the bank. This is the MSB (Most Significant Byte) method. Check this option if you are using one
of these synths. Some synths use Controller 32 for the bank (e.g. Peavey). This is the LSB (Least Significant Byte)
method. If you have one of these synths, then uncheck the “Use MSB for Bank (Roland).”
Tip: If your synth requires both MSB and LSB bank changes, use the '+' button (patches on higher banks).
Pause Play until MIDI note/event (or QWERTY key) received
Allows playback to be started from another keyboard or the computer keyboard. The Band-in-a-Box arrangement
will be generated, and then the program will pause until the MIDI or keystroke signal is received.
Close window when not in BB
Closes the Band-in-a-Box window when the Finder or another program is chosen.
Include Patch Changes in MIDI files
This will include the patch (instrument changes).
Include 2 bar lead-in in MIDI file
If you don't want to create a MIDI file containing the first two bars of the 1—2—1-2-3-4 count-in you can select this
option, and the MIDI file will begin directly at bar 1 without the count-in. If there is a Melody pickup, then the two
bar lead-in will remain in the file.
Include Controllers (Reverb/Chorus/pan)
This will include the reverb, chorus, and panning settings.
120
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Include Forced Channel Meta Event
This will include the forced channel META event. It is recognized by PowerTracks Pro Audio and other PG Music
programs only.
Write Chords, Part Markers Meta event
Writes the chords and part markers to the MIDI file.
Include Guitar Position Controller
This will insert a controller 84 which PG Music uses to indicate the fret position. Since some synths also use this
for “Portamento Control,” you should use this setting with caution.
Write Soloist Part on channel 5
Normally the program writes the Soloist part on channel 8. Since that could also mean the left hand of a piano track
using the convention of channel 8/9 for piano, this option allows you to write it on channel 5 instead.
Write Harmony to MIDI file
If checked, the harmony will be written to the MIDI file. If not, just the melody will be written to the MIDI file.
MIDI file Harmony separate tracks
If checked, the harmony will be written to the MIDI file on separate tracks for each voice. You could use this to
print out individual parts to your printer for example.
Write Guitar part on 6 channels
If set to YES, the styles that are Intelligent Guitar Styles will result in a MIDI file that has the Guitar part written on
six channels (11-16). Then, when you read it in PowerTracks, or another sequencer that uses the convention of 1116 for guitar strings, the guitar part will display correctly.
If song has RealDrums, also generate MIDI drums is an option when saving a Band-in-a-Box arrangement to a
MIDI (*.MID) file. It can be unchecked if your song uses RealDrums and you don’t want MIDI drums included in
the MIDI file.
If song has RealDrums, generate xxxx_RealDrums.AIFF audio saves the RealDrums (which are audio) as a
separate AIFF file. This allows you to easily import the entire Band-in-a-Box song into another program for editing.
Number of Levels of Undo
Set the number of levels of undo from 5 to 999. Undo takes up memory, so don’t use huge values unless you have a
lot of memory or make a lot of mistakes.
More Preferences – Preferences 2
More preferences are accessed with the [Preferences 2] button in the Preferences dialog.
Click on [Preferences 1] or [Soloist Prefs] to jump to the dialogs for those settings.
OK to save/load rev/vol/chorus w/songs
Offers global control over additional song settings (i.e. reverb, chorus, etc) that can be saved and/or loaded with
each song.
Send GM mode at startup
For sound modules that are GM compatible, this command will ensure that the module is ready to accept GMspecific MIDI data such as Bank, Controller, and Patch information.
Send GS Mode On at startup
For sound modules that are GS compatible, this command will ensure that the module is ready to accept GS-specific
MIDI data such as Bank, Controller, and Patch information.
Send XG Mode On at startup
For sound modules that are XG compatible, this command will ensure that the module is ready to accept XGspecific MIDI data such as Bank, Controller, and Patch information.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
121
Turn External Keyboard’s Local On at end of session
Normally while using Band-in-a-Box the “local-off” setting for your MIDI keyboard is best, since the THRU part
will be coming from Band-in-a-Box and you don't want to hear your MIDI keyboard doubling the notes that are
being played. However, when you exit Band-in-a-Box, you might want the “local on” setting for your synthesizer
turned back on. This option defaults to true.
OK to beep with messages
Now that computers have better speaker systems, a simple “beep” when an incorrect key is pressed can seem loud
enough to “wake your neighbors.” Setting the “silent beep” option allows Band-in-a-Box to visually flash the
window title bar to get your attention, instead of generating an audible “beep.”
OK to prompt to reduce/expand
If a style is changed with a different feel (16th notes instead of 8th notes), Band-in-a-Box will automatically offer to
expand or reduce the duration of the chords, and change the tempo to accommodate the new style. This also works
as the song is playing.
Lowest Bass Note (E2 = default)
Styles will normally play bass notes (down to the low E) if the pattern won't go below a low E. This happens with
all styles automatically, but there is also an option to set the lowest bass note real low so you can get a low C if you
want to!
My soundcard or MIDI doesn't have brushes – remap them
Most GM modules have brushes available on patch 41 on the drums. On some, you need to load a GS sound font
for this to occur. On the Yamaha XG, you likely need to send a “GS mode on” message from the GM menu in
Band-in-a-Box. But if your module just doesn't have brushes available, then you can set this option, and the style
will remap the notes to different drum instruments that don't have brushes.
For Roman Numerals in minor keys, use relative major
Option for minor keys base roman numerals on the relative major.
For example in key of Am, Am is either the Im chord or the VIm chord.
122
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Save Button on main screen works as Save As
The [Save] button will launch the file dialog where the location and name of the file being saved can be changed.
Name MIDI files with .MID extension
This will append the file extension .MID to MIDI files saved in Band-in-a-Box, rather than prefacing them with
SMF (Standard MIDI File).
Allow larger fonts on Chordsheet
Display larger fonts, particularly with higher screen resolution.
Color for Chordsheet Area
Make your choice from a list of colors for the Chordsheet area. The keystrokes Ctrl+Shift+C will toggle through
the colors from the main screen without opening the Preferences 2 dialog.
Help Tags
Help tags are short messages that appear if you leave the mouse pointer hovering over an interface element for a few
seconds. When the pointer leaves the object, the tag vanishes. If the mouse pointer is not moved, the operating
system hides the help tag after about 10 seconds.
Use these settings to enable help tags, and to set the delay time in mS before a tag opens.
Normalize MIDI velocities to…
If performing live, or at a jam session, it helps to have the volume of all of the songs be similar. With the
“Normalize MIDI velocities” feature, you can level the volumes to a setting you enter. For example, you can set all
volumes to be 70 and the program will make each song play within those levels.
Normalization for the Melody and Soloist tracks is optional, if you want their MIDI velocities left “as-is” you can
uncheck the Also normalize Melody, Soloist box.
Insert Breaks (silence) in arrangement, also called Chord Breaks, is a great feature for practicing tempo control.
Select the # of bars, and Band-in-a-Box will play for, say 4 bars (selectable), and then will rest all instruments for
the next 4 bars. Once set, this feature works automatically with all songs until you turn it off.
During the silence, you keep playing (comping, drums, melody, etc.), trying to stay in tempo. Drummers can mute
the drum part.
When the band comes back in after the 4 bars, you’ll get instant feedback on how well you have maintained the
tempo, if the band comes in time with you or not.
Once set, this feature works automatically with all songs until you turn it off.
Allow Lyrics display during playback
When lyrics are present (Edit | Enter Lyrics at Current Bar) this setting will open the lyrics window and show two
lines of scrolling lyrics as the song plays.
Soloist Prefs…
The More Soloist Settings dialog can be opened with either the [Soloist Prefs] button in the Preferences dialogs,
or the [More] button in the Select Soloist dialog.
Use MIDI Volume for Soloist Wizard
Set to “true” if you want MIDI velocity information sent to the Soloing Wizard. If you have a velocity sensitive
MIDI device attached to your computer and you want to control the dynamics of the Soloist, you should enable this
feature.
Trigger Playback Early
Set to “true” to enable song playback to start before the Soloist has actually completed composing a solo. Setting
this setting to “false” (disabled) will instruct Band-in-a-Box to completely compose a solo before song playback
begins.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
123
Soloist –Prefer Long phrases
Set the checkbox to “true” (enabled) if you would like the Soloist to use the longest musical phrases it knows.
(Note: this option may also increase Soloist creation times. Disable this feature if you are using a slower or lowmemory equipped computer.)
Velocity Adjust
The “Soloist Velocity Adjust” and “Melodist Velocity Adjust” boxes allow you to quickly boost or reduce the
volume of the Soloist or Melodist part relative to the other instrument parts.
For a realistic mix, they are set slightly louder than the other instrument parts in a song. The default is 5.
OK to treat the V Major triad as a V7
Since the V chord is usually played as a 7th, this allows better playing on V chords. You can disable it for Rock or
Blues songs that use the major triad.
Reverb
This button opens the Reverb Settings dialog with audio reverb settings for
RealTracks and RealDrums.
Select from presets, apply custom settings, and save your own presets in this dialog.
You can enable/disable the audio reverb. If you disable it, this will save some CPU cycles, so this
might be advisable on an older/slower machine if you hear that the audio is clicking or not keeping up.
Click on the green Select a Preset button to open the list of presets. This list will show only the “Band-in-aBox Default Reverb” until you save some presets of your own.
124
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
As you adjust the settings, they will be applied to the current song. The [Swap “Default”] button toggles between
your current settings and the default settings. This allows you to hear the effect of the changes you make to the
settings.
Use the row of “room” buttons to load typical settings for different types of spaces. These buttons are a convenient
way either to apply a particular effect or to load settings that you can then tweak to make your own preset.
Reverb Parameters
Pre-Delay is the time delay of first reflections.
Decay is the time it takes for reverb to decay. Reverb time is measured as RT60, the time it takes for reverb to
decay to a level -60 dB below the dry signal level.
LF Rolloff gradually reduces the bass frequencies. If you can’t add enough reverb because the sound gets too
muddy, try increasing the LF Rolloff slider. It is adjustable between 50 Hz and 500 Hz.
HF Rolloff is the rate at which the high frequencies die away as the reverb decays. Rooms with hard surfaces are
typically bright, but rooms with soft surfaces are usually darker. It is adjustable between 1 KHz (dark) to 11 KHz
(bright).
Density is the density of low-level echoes near the end of the reverb tail. High Density settings add sheen to the
sound.
Level adjusts the final level of the plug-in.
Typical Reverb Settings
- A large hall might have long Pre-Delay, long Decay, and moderate Density.
- A hard large space, such as a gymnasium, might have long Pre-Delay, high Density and high HF Rolloff.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
125
- A soft large space, such as a concert hall with carpet, padded seats, hangings, might have medium Density and
low HF Rolloff.
- A small hard space, such as a tile washroom, might have short Pre-Delay, medium-to-long Decay, high
Density, and high HF Rolloff.
- A small soft space, such as a large living room, might have short Pre-Delay, short Decay, medium-to-low
Density, and low HF Rolloff.
Saving Settings to Presets
You can save your reverb types as presets, and the current settings will be saved with the song in a
Preferences/PGReverbSettings.bin file.
To save the current settings to a preset, type in a name for your preset in the “Preset Name” field.
Then click on the red Save a Preset arrow and choose a location in the Preset list. You can write over an
existing name.
A prompt will ask you to confirm that you want to save the preset.
Select [Yes] to save the new preset to the chosen location.
Auto Reverb
Enable “Auto-Add Reverb to RealTracks” to automatically apply preset amounts of reverb to RealTracks according
to the instrument type. No reverb is added to the Bass part, for example, but most instruments get reverb.
If you just want more or less reverb added overall, you can adjust the “Strength %.” For example, the default Bandin-a-Box reverb setting is 40 for most tracks. If you set the strength to 75%, the Band-in-a-Box becomes 30.
You can save the current settings as the Default Reverb.
Click on [Restore Defaults] to go back to the original “factory” reverb settings for
Band-in-a-Box Default Reverb.
DAW Plug-In Mode
There is a “plug-in” mode for your favorite sequencer (GarageBand, ProTools, Logic, Nuendo, Reaper and more).
With the plug-in mode, Band-in-a-Box is open as a small window, and acts as a plug-in for your favorite DAW
126
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
sequencer, so you can drag and drop MIDI and audio (AIFF, M4A) tracks from Band-in-a-Box to your favorite
sequencer.
The DAW Plug-in mode is a mode within the regular Band-in-a-Box program. This mode allows you to transfer
tracks or parts of tracks, to other DAW sequencers or Finder.
You can enter and exit the DAW plug-in mode easily.
Press the [DAW Mode] button on the Toolbar, then choose the
menu item “Start DAW Plug-in mode” (or go to the Windows
menu and choose Plug-in Mode for Sequencer-DAW).
When you do this:
1. Window size of Band-in-a-Box changes to a small size (you can resize it to the size/position that you want, and it
will remember that).
2.
You can now easily drag tracks from Band-in-a-Box to your DAW in 2-steps. First, drag the track button to the
drop station (blue rectangle), and then when it turns green, drag that to your DAW’s track.
You can also drag files to other programs, besides DAW’s, if they accept a drop of audio files (AIFF, M4A) or
MIDI files. For example, Finder allows this. For this documentation, we will use Finder as an example.
Dragging Tracks from Band-in-a-Box to Finder (or a DAW).
1. Run Band-in-a-Box. Enable Plug-in mode as explained above.
2. Open (or make) a song in Band-in-a-Box.
3. COMBO (MASTER) TRACK.
If you want the entire performance dragged to Finder, drag the Combo button to the drop station.
Then when it turns green, drag to Finder.
It will be dragged as audio, unless you have set it to be dragged
as MIDI in Plugin Settings dialog.
Normally, a single file is dropped, with the entire arrangement, but
if you want all tracks transferred as separate files, you can enable this option in Plugin Settings dialog. (Note
that your DAW will need to support dropping of multiple files, and will typically put them on consecutive
tracks.)
4. SINGLE TRACKS.
If you want a single track transferred, drag that track button to the drop station. (For example, drag
the Bass button to transfer the bass track.) Then when the drop station turns green, drag that to Finder.
If the track is a RealTrack (green), then it will be transferred as Audio. If it is a MIDI track (black), then it will
be transferred as MIDI.
(Note:
set this in Plugin Settings dialog.)
5. SELECTED REGIONS.
If you want MIDI tracks transferred as audio, you can
If you would like to transfer only a portion of the performance,
you can do this by selecting the region in Band-in-a-Box and then dragging the track button
to the
drop station (don’t drag the selected region). You will then get just the selected region dragged to Finder.
Tip: If you hold the SHIFT key during the drag, then the file will be dropped as MIDI (if it is a MIDI track), regardless of the setting
in Plug-in options.
Tip: If you hold the CONTROL key during the drag, then the file will be dropped as AUDIO (if it is a MIDI track, it will be rendered
to audio using Apple Synth), regardless of the setting in Plug-in options.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
127
Plug-In Options
To get to the DAW Plug-in options, press the [DAW Mode]
button and choose the menu item “Options for DAW Plug-in” or
go to the Preferences dialog and click the [DAW Plugin] button.
You will then see the plug-in options.
Allow Drag and Drop (default=true) If disabled, the Drag and Drop feature will not work. There shouldn’t be a
reason to disable this.
Drag individual MIDI tracks as audio (default=false) When enabled, the chosen MIDI tracks get converted to
audio, using Apple Synth.
Drag Combo (Master) track as audio (default=true) When enabled, the entire arrangement gets converted to
audio, using Apple Synth. If not selected, the MIDI tracks in the arrangement get transferred as MIDI, in a single
file.
Drag Combo as separate tracks (default=false) If set to true, when dragging the Combo button, the drop will
result in multiple files, one for each track.
Drag Audio as m4a files If set to true, the audio gets dropped as m4a.
Show DragDrop Folder This will show Finder where the dropped files reside. When you drag a file to your
DAW, the file is created on disk and stored in the DragDrop folder inside the Band-in-a-Box folder.
Erase DragDrop Folder This will erase (trash) all of the dragged audio/MIDI files in the DragDrop folder. Note
that some DAW sequencers require these files to reside permanently (or until you use a “consolidate” command in
the DAW), so don’t erase these files unless you are sure that they are not needed.
Note the tips for forcing MIDI or forcing audio when dragging. Holding Shift forces MIDI, holding Control forces audio.
Other Editing Features
Shrink/Expand
The Shrink command will reduce durations of chords by ½ (e.g., 4beats>>2beats, 2beats>>1beat). Expand doubles
the durations of chords (e.g., 1beat>>2beats, 2beats>>4beats).
128
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Unfold (convert to 1 big chorus)
If you have a song with 3 choruses, and want to convert it to a single large chorus, this command “unfolds” the song
into just that; one BIG chorus. This is useful for customizing a song.
When selected, Band-in-a-Box will display all choruses and verses of a song without loops or repeats. This is a
useful command if you wish to make use of the Patch/Harmony change at any bar feature, or if you are going to
generate a MIDI file for use with a sequencer or sequencing program.
Slide Tracks
This dialog opens with the command Edit | Slide Tracks. It allows you to move any of the bass, drums, piano,
guitar, strings, melody or the soloist track ahead or behind by a certain amount.
Setting these numbers will slide the entire track ahead or behind by the # of ticks (120 ticks per beat). You could,
for example, slide the bass track so it plays a little ahead of the rest of the band. This has the effect of making the
bass player “drive the band” and is useful in Jazz styles to make the music sound more exciting.
Allow Any Slides
If you want the slides to occur, then check this box.
Humanize Slides
If this box is checked, the slides will be randomized to slide the track a different amount for each note. The amount
varies from 0 ticks to the slide setting for the instrument. A track that always plays notes early by a certain amount
tends to sound out of time, whereas randomizing the slide makes the track sounds more human.
If the song is currently playing, you can press the [Update] button to hear any changes you
have made.
This returns all fields to factory default settings. The default settings are as shown in the
illustration.
This enters a value of zero for all fields.
Song Memo…
A song memo of up to 2000 characters may be added with your own notes about the song and the Bandin-a-Box song summary. Clicking on the [M] button located to the right of the song title launches the
Song Memo dialog
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
129
where you can type in a short memo about the song, style, etc.
A red border around the [M] button indicates that the song has a memo. The keystrokes Option+M will also launch
the Song Memo.
Automatic Song Summary
The Song Summary panel automatically displays a full summary of the song (title/tempo/patches used in the song),
as well as other special features, such as substyle patch changes or harmonies and MIDI or Real instruments/drums
in use. This saves much of the work required to type this information into the memo manually.
Enter/Copy/Move Lyrics
These features enable the typing, editing, and exporting of song lyrics.
Edit Chord Shortcut.txt
This will edit the file SHORTCUT.TXT using Teach Text. This is the chord shortcuts file. Make sure to save the
file after editing. Changes won’t take effect until you choose Edit | Refresh Chord Shortcuts.
If you find a chord that Band-in-a-Box won't accept like Csus2, when it expects C2 instead, you can enter this on a
single line (without the quotes) “sus2@2.” Then Band-in-a-Box will enter the chord C2 if you type in Csus2. These
allow someone to type in Csus2 and the program will accept it. You can also use it for shortcuts, like if you entered
j@maj7, Band-in-a-Box would let you type Cj for CMaj7. See the file pgshortc.txt in the Band-in-a-Box folder for
examples of shortcuts.
Refresh Chord Shortcuts
After editing chord shortcuts in the SHORTCUT.TXT file you must use this command to save the changes.
MIDI Setup
Connecting to MIDI
Here is an illustration of the connections for a MIDI system using a MIDI Interface to connect to an external MIDI
synthesizer.
The Band-in-a-Box program running
on your computer sends a stream of
MIDI data via the MIDI Driver to
your MIDI interface.
- The MIDI interface transmits information between the computer and your synthesizer.
- The Synthesizer or Sound Module (e.g. Roland Sound Canvas) produces the musical instrument sounds.
Band-in-a-Box tells it what notes to play and how to play them.
- Stereo Speakers or Headphones are connected to your synthesizer so that you may hear the music.
130
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Your MIDI setup could also be configured to use the built-in sounds of QuickTime Musical Instruments, or a virtual
software synthesizer such as the Apple DLS.
There are also MIDI systems such as OMS and FreeMIDI that can be configured by the user. (FreeMIDI and OMS
are supported only in Band-In-A-Box OS9, booted from Mac Classic) If they are present on your system, they will
appear in the Band-in-a-Box MIDI Drivers dialog.
Selecting a MIDI Driver
Band-in-a-Box automatically detects the MIDI drivers installed in your system. The MIDI | **Select MIDI Driver
or Apple DLS Synth menu command opens the MIDI Drivers dialog, which lists the drivers that have been detected.
Selecting “Apple DLS Synth” plays your MIDI tracks through the high quality built-in Apple DLS Music Device, or
software synthesizer. No special configuration should be necessary.
“MacOS X CoreMIDI” lets you configure a custom setup with other software synths or external MIDI devices.
The CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth chapter gives detailed instructions for your MIDI setup.
Click on [MIDI Drivers Help] to go to the CoreMIDI and Apple
DLS Synth help tutorial.
MIDI Settings
The MIDI Settings dialog box opens with the MIDI | MIDI Settings menu command or the Command+M key
combination. It lets you make settings for each part (bass/drums/piano etc.) and also to set the Harmony channels.
The settings are:
- CHANNELS: Range 0 to 16. (If set to 0, part will be Off).
Some synths (e.g. MT32), give higher priority to lower channel #'s, so if you are “running out of notes” you should
assign important parts (e.g. Melody) a lower channel than other parts (e.g. Guitar).
- OCTAVE: This adjusts the octave of the part. Range is -2 to +2, usually set to 0. (Bass is usually set to -1 for
General MIDI instruments.)
- PATCH: Range 0 to 127. These are General MIDI patch numbers. You do not type in the patch numbers of your
synthesizer. (The patch map handles mapping of the General MIDI patch numbers to your non-GM synthesizer's
patch numbers.)
- VOLUME: Range 0 to 127. Typical volume setting is = 90.
- REVERB: Range 0 to 127. Typical setting = 40.
- CHORUS: Range of 0 to 127. Typical setting = 0.
- PAN: Panning refers to the left/right stereo placement. Range is –63 (hard left) to +64 (hard right). A setting of
0 is centered.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
131
Press the [Harmony] button to launch the Harmony Channels dialog box.
132
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Setting the Harmony Channels
Melody Harmony Channel A
Always uses the Melody channel.
Melody Harmony Channel B
Default =11
Melody Harmony Channel C
Default =12
Thru Harmony Channel A
Always uses the Thru channel.
Thru Harmony Channel B
Default =13
Thru Harmony Channel C
Default =14
Band-in-a-Box already uses 7 channels (Bass, Drums, Piano, Guitar, Strings, Melody and Thru channels). Adding
these 4 harmony channels produces potentially 11 channels of information. If you have a modern module that
receives on all channels, then you can use these defaults.
Older modules capable of playing only 8 parts at once (like an MT32 or a Korg M1) won't be able to take advantage
of the harmony using different instruments. In this case, you should set the harmony channels as follows:
Melody Harmony Channel A
Uses the Melody Channel, no need to set.
Melody Harmony Channel B
Need to Set equal to Melody Channel.
Melody Harmony Channel C
Need to Set equal to Melody Channel.
Thru Harmony Channel A
Uses the Thru Channel, no need to set.
Thru Harmony Channel B
Need to Set equal to Thru Channel.
Thru Harmony Channel C
Need to Set equal to Thru Channel.
If you do this, then you don't need to do any other modifications to your Band-in-a-Box setup, because it is not using
any new channels.
Piano Display:
Default =
Uncheck this box if you don’t want to see notes played on the onscreen piano keyboard.
Color Notes?
Default =
The notes that play on the onscreen piano are usually in different colors for each part. Bass – Aqua, Piano – Blue,
Guitar – Green letter G, Strings – Pink letter S, Melody – Red letter M, Solo – Red letter S. Uncheck this box to
show them all in black and white.
Allow Patch Changes:
Default =
Do not check this box if you want to disable All Patch changes. If you haven't made a patch map, you should
disable this.
Style GS Patch Changes:
Default =
Styles frequently come with patch changes. If you want to disable these, uncheck this box.
MIDI (sync):
Default =
To synchronize Band-in-a-Box with an external sequencer, check this box.
Overall Volume Changes:
Default =
To prevent any changes of volume inside Band-in-a-Box, uncheck this box.
Style Volume Changes:
Default =
Styles occasionally come with volume changes. To prevent these, uncheck this box.
Extra Note Offs:
Default =
Leave this box unchecked unless you are having trouble with stuck notes when you press [Stop]. If you check this
box, Band-in-a-Box will send a sweep of all notes off.
Concert Pitch Adjust:
Default = 0
This is useful for non-concert instruments such as Saxophone or Trumpet. The output is transposed so that you see
the music in one key, and it plays in another.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
133
Trumpet players and other Bb instruments should set Concert Pitch Adjust to -2 (i.e. minus 2). Alto Sax and other
Eb instruments should set Concert Pitch Adjust to +3.
Here's an example of an Alto player using Band-in-a-Box by setting the concert pitch adjust to +3.
If the song is in the concert key of C transpose the song to A using the key signature box on the main screen. The
song will display in the key of A, but with the Concert Pitch Adjust set to +3 it will play 3 semitones higher, in the
key of C. So the Alto player can read the music in the transposed key while hearing it in the concert key. The song
can also be printed out in the key of A.
The [View GS Map] button opens a list of General MIDI patch numbers for quick
reference.
Boost THRU velocity by
If the sound of your keyboard is too quiet when playing along with Band-in-a-Box, and increasing the THRU
Volume doesn't help enough, use this option to boost the THRU velocity and make your THRU playing louder.
(For example, non-velocity sensitive keyboards are usually set to output a quiet velocity of 64).
Output Chords to External Device
Some external music hardware devices require chords played in root position to drive them in real time.
An example of this is the Digitech Vocalist. It will let you sing into a microphone and harmonize your voice
according to the chords that are input to the device. Band-in-a-Box now has the capability of outputting a separate
channel with the chords in root position to support such external devices automatically. There are also settings such
as complexity of chords, output channel, velocity, and note range. Band-in-a-Box will also drive “Real Time
Arrangers” like the Roland RA series.
The best way to accomplish this is to access the MIDI | Output chords to external device… menu item. You will
then be given a window like the following:
134
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Click on the [Vocalist] button if you have such a device connected to your MIDI system. Band-in-a-Box will then
send it the appropriate chord information automatically as your song is playing (e.g., root position triads) and the
Vocalist will harmonize your voice according to the root position chords that Band-in-a-Box is sending to it.
For any other devices, you will need to know a little more information as to what your external device needs to
“see” for it to function correctly, such as channel, velocity, chord type, etc. Then type the appropriate values in the
spaces provided in the Output Chords To External Device window (shown above).
The JukeBox
Overview of the Jukebox
The Jukebox will Load and Play an entire folder of songs. Songs play continuously, one after the other. The
Jukebox will continue to play while you move to other programs, so you can use the Jukebox to provide background
music for your Macintosh!
To play the Jukebox, click on the toolbar button, press Command + J, or choose Juke Box
Play from the Song menu to open the Juke Box Options dialog. Then choose how you want
your songs to be selected and played.
Make your choices of options as described below, and then click on the [Play Juke Box] button to start the Jukebox
playing.
Press the and arrows onscreen, or the [ or ] keys to select the “Previous Juke Song” or the “Next Juke
Song” respectively, or choose these options from the Song menu.
Jukebox Options
Include Songs without Melodies: If checked, the program plays songs with and without melodies - that is songs
within the Songs folder. If not checked, the Jukebox will include only songs with the MG? extension.
Audible lead-in: While listening to the Jukebox, you might not want to hear the count-in click. If not checked, you
won't hear the count-in click.
Vary Melody Instrument: Hearing a song after a song is played with the same melody instrument would get a
little monotonous. If you check this option, the program will randomly change the melody instrument between your
favorites.
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
135
Use Tap in click to start: This option is used to control when the next song starts and allows you to control the
tempo of the song. See options below “Set Cue/Tap Options.”
Hide Song Name: This feature is used to play the “Guess the Song” game. When checked, the titles are hidden
until you click the title. When someone guesses the Song Title, you can click in the Title box to verify if he/she is
correct. You'll probably want to restrict the Jukebox to only songs with melodies unless you can guess songs
without melodies!
Random Play/Alphabetical: If set to “Random” the songs will be played in random order (without repeating
songs). If set to “Alphabetical” the songs will be played in alphabetical order from the Songs folder.
Change Harmony w/each song: If selected a harmony will be automatically selected for each song that plays in
the Jukebox. Use the “Harmony # range” settings to choose from a particular section of the Harmony list.
Generate Solos: Set this option to “On” to permit the Soloist to play a solo over all the songs selected for Jukebox
playback.
We have created a special Jukebox directory of songs that showcase the many Soloists available. Take a moment to
hear this showcase by following these steps:
1. Change to this directory by loading/opening a song from the Soloist DEMO folder, but instead of playing the
song you have loaded press the [Juke] button.
2. Ensure that the “Generate Solos” checkbox is set selected (checked). If you enable “Auto-Choose Soloists” the
program will select an appropriate Soloist for each Jukebox song. “Change Soloist w/each chorus” instructs the
program to choose different Soloists for each chorus of a song. For example, if Band-in-a-Box encounters a
three chorus Jazz tune during jukebox playback, the program might choose a Saxophone solo for the first
chorus, a Trumpet for the next, and a Guitar or Piano for the last chorus.
3. When you select [Play Juke Box] the Select Soloist dialog will pop up with a suggestion to use a Soloist for
the first song in the jukebox list. This is normal. Press [OK] to accept the Soloist suggestion. (The Jukebox
will not bother you with the Select Soloist dialog again; it will simply choose an appropriate Soloist for any
given song in the Jukebox song list.)
(Preview) Switch to next song after ____ Bars
Use this setting to preview the songs in a Jukebox list. Band-in-a-Box will play each song in the folder for the
number of bars you enter into the box. Use a setting of 99 bars to play one chorus of each song.
136
Chapter 6: Band-in-a-Box PowerGuide
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
Band-in-a-Box offers a variety of notation and printing features for viewing parts on-screen as they play, editing
MIDI tracks, and for printing parts as sheet music.
Notation
The grand staff notation scrolls by onscreen as the song plays. A time bar indicates the song position while notes
highlight in red as they play. The onscreen notation allows you to follow and read along as the song plays. It’s a
great way to practice your sight reading or sight singing.
Band-in-a-Box notation features engraver spacing for clean, uncluttered display without note overlap. It handles
Jazz eighth notes and triplet figures correctly. Automatic options like “auto durations,” “clean notation,” “mono
display,” “minimize rests,” and “engraver spacing” produce very musical and readable notation. The Notation
window is also a powerful editing tool.
In Editable Notation mode, notes can be entered in step time (clicking with the mouse on the staff, or on the
onscreen piano), or in real time from a MIDI keyboard. Drag and drop editing allows notes to be changed and
moved. There is also a Staff Roll mode, similar to a piano roll.
The Staff Roll mode supports moving and changing of MIDI notes, plus it allows the editing of note velocity and
duration. This is a very powerful feature for fine tuning the dynamics of a performance.
A number of Notation Options let you format your notation display and choose which elements of the notation to
display or hide.
Printing
Print out any combination of chords, notes, and lyrics (or blank paper)!
You choose what to print out (notes /chords / lyrics / bar numbers), and what clefs to include (treble / bass). You
can print out the first chorus, last chorus or the whole song. Margins are available, so you can make a left margin to
produce a printout to go into a 3-hole binder for example.
Band-in-a-Box prints a lead sheet style of notation, so it will attempt to auto-fit your song onto one page. Use this
feature to print a library of your favorite songs.
Notation
Opening and Closing the Notation Window
To get to the Notation inside Band-in-a-Box you need to open the Notation window. You can do this
by pressing the [Notation] button. You can also open the Notation window from the menu (File |
Notation Window) or by pressing +w.
You can also open the Notation window from the menu items File | Notation Window, Windows | Notation Window,
or by pressing Command+w.
The Notation window covers the previous window (the Chordsheet) and is fixed (not movable). It is sizable, when
the size of the Band-in-a-Box window changes the Notation window redraws in proportion to the new size.
Close the Notation window by pressing the [Notation] button again.
Notation Window Toolbar
The toolbar at the top of the Notation Window gives you access to most of the functions.
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
137
Options
The options button launches the Notation Windows Settings dialog, where notation display
options are set.
Notation Mode
This is an important button. It is the Notation Mode button. This toggles between the 3 modes of the
Notation window, Standard Notation mode, Editable Notation mode, and Staff Roll mode.
Print Options
Press this button to Print the Notation to any standard printer supported by the Macintosh. (If
you haven't set up your printer to
work with any other MAC programs, then you'll need to select a printer in the Chooser.) This launches a dialog box
that lets you set options for printing (described elsewhere).
Current Note
This box displays the name of the note that the mouse is currently over. This is the note that will be
inserted when you click to insert a note.
Note or Rest Checkbox
These determine whether a Note or a Rest will be inserted when a mouse is
clicked.
Mono Mode
When this checkbox is selected, the notation is entered as monophonic (one note only). This is
useful for melodies that only have one note playing at a time.
Mono mode is a faster way to enter notes, because the Notation Window will automatically delete a note that is
present at the same location that you are putting a new note on. So if you have mistakenly put a B note on as a C,
you just click on the B note, and if in mono mode the C will be deleted automatically.
“Clean” Notation
When music has been played in from a MIDI keyboard, there are frequently effects like grace
notes, glitches, and notes played off time.
The Clean Notation mode is an intelligent feature that “Cleans Up The Notation” for you. It does this by
eliminating the display of grace notes and glitches, and also simplifies the Notation display so it is more readable.
Clean Notation doesn't affect the actual content of the track, just how it is displayed. In general, this should be on,
since it improves the display. But if you want to see every grace note or glitch that was played, then turn it off.
Looping the Notation Screen
While a song is playing, click the “L. Scr” checkbox and the song will loop for the 4 bars
shown on the notation screen. For example, if you let the soloist create a great sounding Jazz
solo, you can then look at the notation and sight read along with the solo. When you reach a particularly interesting
or difficult part that you would like to practice, set the L. Scr to “On” and it will loop that 4 bar phrase.
Tip: Since you might be holding your guitar or sax as you try to play with this command, we've made some easy hot keys to
navigate around. The “NUMPAD 1” key turns the Looping on or off. The Cursor Up / Down keys jump to the previous / next
screen.
The Track Buttons
These stand for Bass, Drums, Piano, Guitar, Strings, Melody, and Solo. Normally you will be displaying the
Melody or Soloist track, but you can display or print any track from Band-in-a-Box.
Note: The instrument tracks are not created by Band-in-a-Box until you press [Play], so you may notice that the track is
blank (or shows a previous song) until the song has been played once!
138
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
Exploring the Standard Notation
Current Time position.
This vertical line, called the time bar, indicates the current time position. You can click anywhere on the Current
Time line to set a new position. This is useful to set a different location to type in chords, or to play from a different
location.
The clef is displayed, and the key signature of the song. If you want some extra space for the
notation, you can press the options button and set “Show Key Signature” to “No,” and this key
signature won't be displayed.
Setting the Key Signature.
The key signature of the song is set by the Key Signature area, which is outside the Notation window and is under
the Title of the song. You'll get a popup menu that allows you to choose a key, and optionally transpose the song.
Typing chords in Notation.
Chords can be typed in the Notation window and entered at the current position of the time bar. Chords that are
typed in the Notation window also show up on the Chordsheet.
As you can see, the Notation window contains the notes
and chords of the song. The bar numbers are also
present, with the chorus number in brackets ( ). If there
is a part marker present at the bar, the bar number will
be displayed in blue, and there will be a letter “a” or “b”
indicating the part marker.
Notation Window Contextual Menu
Chords can be edited, and major song editing features accessed, from the contextual menu that opens with
Control+click or a right click in the Notation window.
Chords can be copied, pasted, cut, or erased and new
chords can be entered from the Chord Builder.
The Chord Settings allow pushes, rests, and pedal
bass to be applied.
The Bar Settings let you refine your arrangement
with changes in tempo, meter, key signature, styles,
RealDrums, volume levels, patches, and harmonies.
Song Settings allow rests and pushes, and also
control tags, endings, and fadeouts.
Global system settings are accessed in the
Preferences.
You can also right-click on a bar in the Chordsheet
to set it as the beginning or end of the chorus or the
end of the song from the settings in the context
menu.
For example, these settings are available with a
right-click on bar 16.
This menu can be used to start playback from the
highlighted bar in any chorus of the song.
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
139
Notation Modes
There are 3 modes to the Notation window,
1.Standard Notation Mode
To display or print notation and enter chords.
2. Editable Notation Mode
To enter or edit notation and chords.
3. Staff Roll Mode
To enter/edit notation duration and velocity.
You can toggle between each of the modes by pressing the Notation Mode button on the Notation toolbar.
Shift+click on the [N] button will back up one notation mode.
Standard Notation Window
The Standard Notation window is for display, entry of melodies and chords (or any track). You see the melody/
chords on screen just as you would in a lead sheet. You can even display the Bass, Drums, Guitar, Piano, or Strings
tracks in notation. Handles Jazz eighth notes and triplet figures correctly. Automatic options like “auto durations,”
“clean notation,” “mono display,” “minimize rests,” and “engraver spacing” produce very musical and readable
notation. Notes can be entered in step time (clicking with the mouse on the staff, or on the onscreen piano), or in
real time from a MIDI keyboard.
Editable Notation Mode
This allows you to enter or edit notation. Usually, the Melody and Soloist tracks are the only ones you'll want to
edit.
Note: Although you could edit the other tracks (e.g., Bass track), your edits would be lost when the song is re-composed
when you press [Play] - unless you make a MIDI file to save it first.
You will notice the grid of vertical lines that indicates where the notes will be placed. This song is in Jazz Swing, so
Band-in-a-Box has automatically set the grid resolution to swing triplets, 3 grid lines per beat. This resolution can
be changed in the Notation Window Settings dialog, but Band-in-a-Box should set it to the correct value, based
upon the style that is currently in use. For example, when a style is a Bossa Nova the division will be sixteenth
notes, since Bossa Nova is an even rhythm, not a triplet feel rhythm.
To insert a new note.
Move the mouse to the location that you want. If you want Beat 1, move to the first dotted line in the bar. Click on
the staff over the note that you want.
The Current Note box in the toolbar will give you the name of the note that you're on. Click with the
mouse button to insert the note.
- To insert a SHARP hold down the SHIFT key as you click the note.
- To insert a FLAT hold down the CONTROL key as you click the note.
- To insert a NATURAL hold down the
key as you click the note.
How long does the note last that I insert?
Band-in-a-Box uses an intelligent auto-duration feature to determine how long the note should be. A note that is put
in will initially have a duration of 2 bars (2 whole notes). When the next note is put in (say 2 beats later), Band-in-aBox will shorten the duration of the previous note to just shorter than 2 beats. This means that you don't have to
worry about durations at all, and can just click on the notes that you want, at the locations that you want.
If you want a specific duration (i.e., over-ride the auto duration), you can do this by editing the note using by
clicking on the note while holding down the option key, and then you're in a dialog box that allows you to type the
exact duration that you want.
140
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
The purpose of auto-durations is to allow you to enter a lead sheet style melody by clicking only once per note,
dramatically speeding up the entry of notation.
Inserting Rests.
You can Insert a REST by clicking the Rest button, and then clicking at the location where you
would like the rest to be inserted.
This automatically chops off the duration of the previous note.
Note: Band-in-a-Box dislikes rests less than a quarter note, so if it is important to you to see rests less than a quarter note,
make sure to de-select the “Minimize Rests” check box in the Notation Window Settings dialog box.
Notes can be moved via drag and drop. To move a note, place the mouse cursor over an existing note and then click
and hold the mouse button down. While keeping the mouse button pressed, move the mouse cursor over to the
location you wish to drop the note and then let go of the mouse button. The note will be moved to the place you
dropped it.
Certain areas of the screen are not valid locations to drop a note. The mouse cursor will change to a busy cursor to
indicate an invalid location. If you try to drop a note in an invalid location, nothing will happen.
Moving a note in time.
If you want to change the start time of a note, drag the note with the left mouse button to the new location. This is a
simple way to move the note. Alternatively, you could edit the note numerically with an option click on the note.
Changing the pitch of a note.
Similarly, you can drag the note vertically to change the note value, and release it when you're on the note you want.
key to have the note inserted as a sharp, flat, or natural respectively.
Hold down the shift, control, or
Editing a note's values.
Click on a note while holding the option key. This brings up the Note Edit dialog box that lets you change any
values about the note in numerical data.
Staff Roll Notation Mode
Click on the Notation Mode button again to enter Staff Roll mode. It will look like this.
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
141
This mode is similar to the Editable Notation mode, except the beats begin right on the bar line. You can also see
the durations of the notes visually, represented by horizontal blue lines. Similarly, you can see the velocities of the
notes displayed as vertical blue lines.
Note: If you can't see these lines press the [Opt.] button to ensure that you have set the “Show Bar/Beat Lines,” “Show
Note Durations,” and “Show Velocity Lines” to “Yes.”
This mode works like the Editable Notation - you mouse click to insert a note, and can drag notes horizontally or
vertically, and edit notes by pressing the Mouse while holding the option key.
Option key mouse drag of velocity or duration.
There is an additional function available in this mode: Option+Mouse Drag. Hold down the option key, then place
the mouse cursor on the note head and drag it horizontally to the right to set the note's duration. Use the same
procedure to set velocity, but drag the mouse vertically from the note head.
Notation Options
Use the Notation Options to format your notation display and choose which elements of the
notation to display or hide. Press the [Opt.] button in the Notation window toolbar to open the
Notation Options dialog.
Resolution Setting
Band-in-a-Box automatically sets the resolution whenever a style is loaded. If a style has a triplet feel (such as Jazz
Swing or a Shuffle style), then Band-in-a-Box will set the resolution to “3 (swing).” This will ensure that Jazz
eighth notes (swing triplets) are handled correctly. When a “straight” style like Bossa Nova is loaded in, Band-in-aBox will change the resolution to sixteenths notes. This will provide even eight notes. You shouldn't have to
change this setting very often, as Band-in-a-Box sets it for you.
The “Resolution” setting determines how the program rounds the note times and durations when translating a track
into standard notation. For example, a resolution of 4 will cause the program to round each note and duration to the
nearest 16th note when displaying the music (in 4/4 time). A resolution of 3 will cause Band-in-a-Box to round each
note to the nearest 8th note triplet (in 4/4 time). A resolution of 2 will cause BB to round each note to the nearest
8th note (in 4/4 time).
Tip: If you're displaying Jazz Swing or Shuffle music that has a triplet feel to the eighth notes, make sure to set the
resolution to = 3(swing). This will display the 8th notes and other aspects of Jazz Swing music correctly.
Tick Offset
The “Tick Offset” on the notation options is one of the keys to great looking notation. It accounts for playing that is
before or behind the beat. The track is automatically scanned to determine the tick offset so that you don't have to
set this yourself. This results in better looking notation.
You may change this setting, but normally Band-in-a-Box will determine the best tick offset automatically.
Tip: The notation of Jazz Swing music will often be improved by a Tick Offset setting of about minus 5. This is because Jazz
music is typically played a little after the beat or, in Jazz terms, “laid-back.”
142
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
Transpose
The Transpose setting lets you adjust the Notation window to display notes either higher or lower than their actual
pitches. It includes presets for commonly transposed instruments. For example, if you select Guitar +12 and the
guitar music will be displayed an octave higher, which is the way guitar music is normally notated.
You have the option to enter your own setting in semitones.
Clefs Split at
The “Clefs Split” at setting determines the split point for placing notes on the Bass or Treble clef. The default
setting is C5, which is middle C. For example, you can use a higher split point, such as C6 if you want some notes
up to a G above middle C to be displayed on the bass clef with ledger lines instead of on the treble clef. If the split
point is above middle C, and a note in the music is high enough that any of the ledger lines above the bass clef
would overwrite the treble clef, the note will be placed on the treble clef.
Chord Vert. Pos
Default =5
Range 1 to 10
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
143
The chord vertical position affects the printout, not the display, it controls how high the chords will be printed above
the staff. If set to =5, the chords will be written 5 notes above the top of the Staff (i.e., 5 notes above the F - at high
D).
If your piece contains a lot of high notes, then set the chord position to a high setting. If you're using a big font (e.g.
32 point music font size), you should set the chord height to a low value (1 or 2) so it won't be too high and encroach
on the staff above.
Show Key Signature
If turned off, you won't have the key signature box displayed on the Notation screen, which will save some space on
the screen. Usually set it to true.
Show Bar/Beats/Lines, Show Note Durations, Show Velocity Lines
These options are for the Staff Roll mode, and determine which lines will show up. Normally you'll want all of
them displayed.
Use Chord Scale for Enharmonics
Band-in-a-Box will automatically use the chord tones (1, 3, 5 and 7) in choosing its enharmonics. If “Use Chord
Scale for Enharmonics” is checked, Band-in-a-Box will also use the enharmonics for the passing tones of the chord
scale.
For example, on an F#7 chord in the key of Eb, the Ab note is part of the F#7 scale (as a G#, the 2nd of the scale),
but is also part of the Eb key of the song. If you want to display based on the chord scale, setting “Use Chord Scale
for Enharmonics” will display the note as a G# instead of Ab.
Enharmonics for passing tones are based on the chord if we “Use Chord Scale for Enharmonics.”
Scroll Ahead by
The “Scroll Ahead by” option can be set to none, 1 bar, or 2 bars. This is useful if you are reading the music from
the Notation as it is scrolling. Since musicians read ahead of the music, it is helpful for the music to scroll ahead.
So when the playback is on bar 4, you'll also see bar 5 of the next screen displayed. This feature still shows you the
current bar when it is scrolling ahead, so it is useful even if you don't read ahead.
Minimize Rests
The “Minimize Rests” checkbox, when checked, will cause Band-in-a-Box to display the music with minimal rests.
Use this setting if notes are displayed as shorter than you intended. For example, if eighth notes are displayed as
sixteenth notes because you recorded them staccato.
Engraver Spacing
This is an intelligent option that spaces the Notation to avoid overlapping notation, and accounts for space required
by accidentals, rests etc. It should normally be set to “On.” The only reason to set it to “Off” would be to speed up
the Notation redraws, but then you will see a mathematical spacing, which results in overlapped notes in some
situations. It is only operative in (non-editable) Notation mode.
Inserted Note Defaults
- If the Snap to Grid Lines checkbox is checked, the inserted note will be lined up with the closest grid line
(quantized). So you don't have to click exactly on the beat to have the note inserted exactly on the beat.
- Duration % is the duration that will be assigned. For example, if a whole note is inserted with a duration of 80%,
the note would last 4*80% = 3.2 beats.
144
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
- The Channel # and Velocity settings determine the MIDI channel and velocity of inserted notes.
Play Inserted Notes
If the “Play Inserted Notes” checkbox is checked, notes that you insert will sound briefly as they are inserted. This
lets you hear that the note you inserted sounds correct.
Entering Chords Using the Notation Window
This is identical to the operation of the Chordsheet. You use the Current Time Indicator (time bar) to see where you
are in the bar. Then type in the chords as you do in Band-in-a-Box.
To type the Ab that you see here, type Ab. Then to move to the Gb7 that is on beat 3, press the RIGHT CURSOR
Key. To enter an Ab chord on beat 1 and a Db7 beat 2, type Ab,Db7 (i.e. 2 chords separated by a comma ).
Note: You can also use Option+Z or select Chord Settings option from the Edit menu to enter chords. This pops up a
dialog box that lets you type in the chords, and also sets options like pushes, rests, and shots.
Convert Harmony Part to Notation track.
Previously if you added a harmony the harmony parts wouldn't be seen on the notation, you would only see the lead
part. Now you can write the harmony part directly to the notation track, so you can see it and print it out, just like
any other part.
Note: These features are all described for the Melody track, but apply equally to the Soloist (or THRU) part.
To convert a melody (or Soloist) track to a Harmony, do the following:
1.
2.
3.
Select the Harmony that you want to use.
Choose the menu item Melody | Convert Harmony to Melody Track.
Your harmony will now be written to the track, and you'll get a confirmation dialog.
The harmony may be removed from the
track at any time, even after you've
saved and re-loaded the song. This is
done from the menu item MEL |
Remove Harmony (or guitar solo) from
Melody Track.
Printing
Band-in-a-Box prints Lead Sheet style notation with chords and melodies. It will also print instrument parts from
your Band-in-a-Box arrangements, a great way to get charts for individual practice, group rehearsal, or live
performance.
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
145
Printing is accessed with either the [Print] button in the Notation window, or the one
on the main screen toolbar.
Most songs will fit on one page, so your printout will look similar to a standard fake book.
You can easily make and print out a custom fake book of all of your tunes. Instantly transpose and print parts for
brass or reed instruments. Print options include title, bar numbers, composer, style, and copyright information.
The harmony may be removed from the track at any time, even after you've saved and re-loaded the song. This is
done from the menu item Melody | Remove Harmony (or guitar solo) from Melody Track.
146
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
Printing
Lead Sheet Style Printing
Your created songs can be printed out in the style of a lead sheet style. Most songs will fit on 1 page, so your
printout will look similar to a standard lead sheet. You can easily make and printout a custom fake book of all of
your tunes, and you can easily transpose parts to print out for trumpet /sax players etc. The printout includes title,
bar #s, composer, style, and copyright information. Prints using a scaleable True Type font and supports all MAC
compatible printers.
A lead sheet usually contains the chords, melody, and lyrics of a song, on a single page if possible. We have kept
the concept of Band-in-a-Box using 4 bars per line on the printout since Pop music is usually in 4 bar phrases. This
aligns these phrases on the beginning of a new line.
In addition to a lead sheet style printout, you can also print out any part of Band-in-a-Box, such as the Piano part, or
Guitar part, to practice your sight reading, or to learn the parts if you are learning to play that instrument.
Printing a song is done by pressing one of the [Print] buttons. This launches the Print
Options dialog box that lets you view the current settings, and then press the [OK – Print]
button.
Print out any combination of Chords, Notes, Lyrics, (or blank paper)!
You'll need to choose what to print out (notes, chords, lyrics, bar numbers) and what clefs to include (treble, bass).
You can print out the first chorus, last chorus, or the whole song. Margins are available, so you can make a left
margin to produce a printout to go into a 3-hole binder for example.
Auto-Fit onto 1 page
Band-in-a-Box will set the # staves per page for you. This will be set when you enter the Print Dialog box, or
change the range that you want to print (first /last chorus or whole song). This will be done to try to fit your printing
onto 1 page. If you're printing the whole song, it is unlikely that it will fit onto 1 page, so Band-in-a-Box will set to
the default 10 staves per page. You can over-ride this setting by typing in the # staves per page that you would like.
Note: Remember that the title on page 1 takes up 1 stave, so if you choose 10 staves, you will get the title + 9 staves on
page 1, and 10 staves on page 2.
Print Options Dialog Box
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
147
Include Chords. If selected, this will include the chords of the song on the lead sheet. Remember that you can set
the height of the chords relative to the staff in the Notation Window Settings dialog box.
Include Notes. If you want only a chord lead sheet with no notes, then turn this off. Otherwise, it should be true.
Bar #s below by. Sets the position of the bar numbers below the staff. The range from highest to lowest position is
1 to 7.
Lyrics. Lyrics can either be printed above the chords, below the staff, or not printed at all. Normally lyrics are
printed below the staff.
Include Lead In Bar. If your song has a lead-in (pickup) to bar 1, then make sure you've checked the lead-in.
Actually, Band-in-a-Box has set this for you by determining if there are any notes in the lead-in measure. You can
over-ride this automatic setting, if necessary.
Treble Clef. Normally you will want to include the treble clef. If you're printing out the Bass part, you probably
don't want the treble clef.
Bass Clef. For Melodies, you likely won't want the bass clef printed. For other parts (Piano, Bass) you will want
the bass clef printed.
Clef split at. This determines where the notation will split the treble and bass clefs. Middle C is C5.
Clef Sign Every Line. If checked, the treble and bass clef signs will be printed on every new line in the printout.
Print Range (First Chorus / Last Chorus / Whole Song). You can print the First Chorus, Last Chorus, or the
Whole Song. When you change this setting, Band-in-a-Box will reset to auto-fit the printout to one page if possible.
Normally, you'll want to print the first chorus of the song.
You'll want to print the last chorus in a song that has a tag ending, or a song that you want to see the 2 bar ending
printed.
The whole song could be printed if you've played differently for each chorus. Use the Edit | Unfold (Convert to 1
big chorus) option to make each chorus different.
Lyrics Below By. Positions the lyrics below the staff, with settings from 1 (highest) to 7 (lowest).
Key Signature Every Line. Default = NO
Most modern fake books don't include the key signature every line. If you would like this to happen, then select
this.
Staves per page. This determines how many staves will be shown per page. The title takes up 1 stave on page 1, so
that if you set the # staves to =10, you will get 9 staves + the title on page 1 and 10 staves on page 2, 3 etc.
Title / Style / Composer / Tempo / Copyright
The title is written in a big font that is underlined and centered.
LIKE THIS
There are [a] and [A] buttons at the right side of the Title field. These change the case of the title. ([A]= UPPER
CASE, [a] = Lower Case).
If the title is long (or you're using big margins), then the font size will be reduced, and the font won't be underlined
for the title. Titles are limited to 60 characters.
The name of the Style that is saved with the song is automatically entered.
Click on the [T] button to insert the current Band-in-a-Box tempo, or type a tempo into the Tempo field yourself.
The other fields are for Composer, Copyright information. You can get the © symbol by pressing the [©] button.
Left Margin / Right Margin. The left and right page margins are set in inches. For example, you could set the
margin to 1.25 inches.
Music Font Size
You can choose any size font you want for lead sheet printout. To change the font size for printout, insert the font
point size you would like in the “Music Font Size” box. The larger the number, the bigger the font. The default is
24.
Setup
This launches the setup dialog box for your printer.
148
Chapter 7: Notation and Printing
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
Band-in-a-Box puts a lot of musical talent in your hands, whether it’s the playing of top session musicians on
RealTracks and RealDrums or automatic features that encourage your own creativity.
There are features like the Melodist for generating all or part of an original song arrangement from scratch, you just
tell it what type of song you want. And if you like the song and want to keep it, it’s all yours.
The Soloist generates improvised solos in hundreds of styles in both MIDI and RealTracks formats. You might use
the Band-in-a-Box solos in your finished tracks, or to inspire your own improvisations, or even as exciting (and
often challenging) sight reading and practice exercises.
Likewise, the Guitarist is able to create polished guitar chord solos in the styles of all-time guitar greats, plus it will
show any instrument part on the guitar fretboard.
When professionals interpret and perform a song, we expect something more than the standard published
arrangement. That’s because they bring their particular talent and musicianship to the song. Band-in-a-Box does
likewise with the Embellisher, which adds professional style to a recorded track, and the Reharmonist, which
brings an advanced knowledge of chords and progressions to your arrangements.
Use the built-in musicianship of Band-in-a-Box to make all of your music better.
Automatic Songs - “The Melodist”
Feel like composing a brand new song? With Band-in-a-Box you can compose a new song in the style of your
choice - complete with intro, chords, melody, arrangement and improvisations, all created by the program! Just pick
a “Melodist” and press [OK] - the program then automatically generates the intro, chords, melody, and arrangement
in the chosen style. It even auto-generates a title for you, to complete your song!
Launching the Melodist
To launch the Melodist, press the [Melodist] button on the main screen, or use the Shift+F5
hot key top open the Generate Chords and/or Melody dialog. Let's explore the dialog screen.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
149
The left of the screen has the list of the Melodists.
In this example, the “Swing Tenor” is selected. This
Melodist will generate intro, chords, melody harmony,
style, and solos using the group of settings preset with this
Melodist. For example, “Swing Tenor” uses “Jazz Easy
Style” (J~EASY.STY) and a Tenor Sax patch, and the
Melody and Chord settings in the Melody Maker.
Scroll down the list, and pick a Melodist that you'd like to
use. Once you have chosen a Melodist, examine the group
of settings called “Chords and/or Melody.”
This section determines what aspects of the song are going to be generated.
- If you want to generate Chords, Melody, and an Intro, make sure that these items are selected.
150
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
-
If you'd like a Pedal Bass figure during the intro and at the end of sections, select the Insert Bass Pedals option.
Selecting Solo in Middle Ch. will generate an improvisation in the middle choruses of the song.
If you'd like Band-in-a-Box to generate a title for your song select the Auto-Titles option.
The Allow Style Changes checkbox, if set, allows a Melodist to load in the style associated with it. If you don't
want Melodists to change the current style that you have loaded, then deselect this option.
The Auto-Titles option will generate a new title for the song.
The Form selection box allows you to choose between a song generated with a specific form (AABA 32 bars)
or no form. The AABA defaults to 32-bar form, which is the most popular song form.
Note: Melodists may alternatively be set to 64 bars (e.g. Melodist # 18 ColeP 64 bar form). The song “form” refers to the pattern
that the verse and chorus repeat. An “AABA 32” form has 4 sections of 8 bars each - the “a” section is the verse and the “b” is the
chorus (or bridge) of the song. If you'd prefer for the song to have no form, you could set the song to “no form” This wouldn't be a
very musical setting, but might be useful for practicing or ear training.
-
The # choruses setting determines how many choruses of the song form (Melodies) are to be generated. For
example, if set to 5, the Melodist will generate 5 choruses, enough for an intro chorus, ending chorus, and 3
Middle Choruses. The # choruses setting defaults to the # choruses present in the current song.
Preset Buttons
There are convenient buttons that will set these settings to
popular presets. For example, pressing the “Chords &
Mel” button will set the checkboxes to Generate Chords
& Melody (but not Solos). The “All” button will generate
Chords, Melody and Solos. The Chords button sets the options to generate Chords only (no Melody), and the
Melody button will set the options to generate only a Melody (no chords) over an existing chord progression.
The [Defaults] button sets the Melodist settings back to Defaults.
The Tempo setting determines the Tempo of the song, and defaults to
the current tempo of the previous song.
If “Auto-Tempo” is checked, the tempo will be set by the tempo range stored with the Melodist. For example, if a
Melodist is called “Fast Waltz,” it would have a fast tempo range stored inside the Melodist and the song would be
generated at a fast tempo if the “auto-tempo” option is set.
In songs with an AABA form, it is common for the second “a” section to be transposed. For example, the first “a”
section might be in the key of Eb, and the second would be transposed up to the key of Gb. Melodists store these
settings, and some Melodists are set to transpose the A2 sections. If you don't want to allow Melodists to transpose
the form in this way, set the A2 transpose to none.
If set to “section plus” it will transpose the A2 section, and might transpose 2 bars early or 2 bars late. The song will
only be transposed if the particular Melodist is set to transpose the section.
The Song Key area determines the key for the song. If set to Any Key, the program will
randomly pick a key for the song, weighed more heavily toward the popular keys like C
and F.
The Minor Key % setting determines what % of songs would be generated in minor keys
(vs. major keys).
If set to 20, then 20% of the songs would be generated in minor keys. You can also set the Song Key Pop-up to a
specific key, or set it to use the current key of the previous song.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
151
The next section of the Melodist Screen allows you to select whether you want
to generate the “Whole Song” or just part of the song. If you select part of the
song, you can specify which bar and chorus to start at, and how many bars to
generate. An easy way to set the range of bars is to select the bars by dragging
the mouse over the chord area prior to launching the Melodist dialog. Then the
“Generate” form will be automatically set to “Part of Song” and the range of
bars will be set to the selected area.
If you were generating a song from scratch, you'd want to set “Generate Whole Song.” After you listen to the song,
you might want to improve on a certain section of the song (say bars 5 and 6 of the first A section). To do this, from
the Chordsheet window, select bars 5 and 6, and press the Melodist button again.
You'll notice that the “Generate Part of Song” radio button is set, with the range set to bar 5 and 6. Pressing OK at
this point will cause only bars 5 and 6 to be regenerated, preserving the rest of the song. This allows you to
repeatedly generate/re-generate parts of the melody and/or chords until you get the Melody/Chord progression that
you're looking for!
If the form of the song were AABA, you'd normally want the regenerated section to
be repeated throughout the form, for example, in all of the “a” sections.
The Replace Thru form will set the Melodist to copy the generated bars to the other “a” sections.
If you'd like to remove the current Intro, Melody or Soloist Track, press the [Kill Intro], [Kill Melody] or [Kill
Soloist] button.
You can press the Search button and then type in part of a Melodist name, memo, style name or
other text associated with a Melodist. This will then cause the Melodist selection to change to the
next item containing the text. Similarly, you can type in a number of a Melodist and press the
[Go To #] button.
The Memo area displays a Memo for the current
Melodist, as well as the name of the database (e.g. Melody1.ST2) that the Melodist is based on.
Melodists can store patch and harmony
settings, and these are displayed in the patch area of the Melodist selection screen. You can also set the instrument
to change each chorus (for example from vibes to guitar to piano). You can over-ride the settings of the current
Melodist and choose your own patch, harmony and change instrument settings in these controls.
152
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
The Melodist Jukebox will continuously generate new
songs, and play them in jukebox fashion. You can set
the range of Melodists to include in the jukebox
(using the From…To settings) or keep the Jukebox on
the same Melodist by de-selecting “Change
Melodists.” To Launch the Melodist Jukebox, press
[Juke Songs Now] (option+j).
Normally you'd want the Melodist to be written to the Melody track. If you'd prefer the Melody to be written to the
Soloist track (e.g. for a counter melody) then set the ‘Write to Track” setting to Soloist.
Normally you'd want the Melodist to be written to the Melody track. If you'd prefer the Melody
to be written to the Soloist track (e.g. for a counter melody) then set the ‘Write to Track” setting
to Soloist. The favorites button allows you to pick a Melodist that you've used recently.
Editing Melodists
If you'd like to create your own Melodists, or permanently change the settings of
existing Melodists, press the [Edit…] button to launch the Melodist Maker, which is
described in detail elsewhere.
Using the Melodist
Generating Complete Songs
Here are some ways that you can use the Melodist by generating complete songs.
- The most obvious use of the Melodist is that you can generate an entire song – complete with intro, chords,
melodies, full 5 part instrument arrangement, pedal bass figures, solo improvisations and even an automatic
title. You can customize the song to your liking, regenerate any of the elements (chords, melody etc.), or any
part of the song until you “get it right.” Either way, the end product is a complete song. What a great
compositional and educational tool!
- Sight Reading: You can put the Band-in-a-Box Melodist in Jukebox mode, so that it is continually generating
and playing new songs in succession. By displaying the Melody track in Notation, you can then sight-read
along with the Melody. Since the melodies are unique, this is the ideal type of sight-reading practice; playing
along to music that you haven't heard before.
- Ear Training: Play along with the Melodies and chords that the program is generating, without looking at the
music. Since Band-in-a-Box is always using intelligent chord progressions and melody phrasing that a
professional would actually use, you are learning to recognize chord progressions and melody phrases that you
will encounter in real playing situations.
- Guitarists can extend the 'Sight Reading' concept by just watching the on-screen guitar fretboard play the
melody notes. If a student were watching his teacher reading music, he would watch the guitar not the sheet
music. This is because guitar is a very visual instrument. Similarly, you may prefer to watch the on-screen
guitar instead of the notation.
Generate Less than a Complete Song
Here are ways that you can use the Melodist short of generating a full song:
- Auto-generate / regenerate / remove an intro for an existing song. You can learn from the intelligent chord
progressions that are generated to lead in to the first chord of the song.
- Auto generate pedal bass patterns over existing songs, to add tension/release effect to your Band-in-a-Box
arrangements.
- Generate chords only, and then compose your own melody by playing or singing along with the chord
progression. This can help composers to write new songs by starting them off with a chord progression that
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
153
they might not ordinarily use. And if you're stuck at a certain bar, see what BB will generate/regenerate as a
melody for that section.
- Generate chords only, and practice playing your musical instrument along with the chord progressions. Print
out the generated lead sheet of chords so that you can see the chords easily on the music stand. Working with
new chord progressions is useful to “get-out-of-a-rut” in your practicing by playing new chord progressions.
You can also improve your harmony ear training, by figuring out the chords as they are being played, without
looking at the chord symbol display.
- Generate Melodies only, over existing chord progressions.
Using Melodist Jukebox
Use the versatile Melodist Jukebox feature to:
- Generate Songs (Chords & Melodies) in succession.
- Generate Solos only over generated chord progressions.
- Generate Solos over the same chord progression (to practice blues soloing for example).
Automatic Intros
The Melodist will automatically generate an introduction for the songs it creates. It is also possible to generate an
introduction for any song from the Edit | Intro Bars Auto-Generate menu option (Ctrl+Shift+B).
This will create a chord progression that gets inserted as an intro to the song, based on the optional settings you
choose.
Chord Types can be Jazz or Pop.
Intro Length can be 2, 4 or 8 bars to suit the tempo of the song.
Starting Chord (after intro) is lets the intro lead in to the song correctly.
Pedal Bass has a list of pedal bass options, based in the key entered in the box.
Press the [(Re)-Generate Intro Chords] button to auto-generate chords for an intro.
Press the [Remove Intro] button to remove the intro from the song.
Automatic Song Title Generation
The Melodist will optionally give a title to the songs it writes. Song titles can also be generated on demand with the
User | Auto-Generate Song Title menu command (Ctrl+Shift+S). The song title will appear in the Title window.
Repeat the Auto-Generate Song Title command until the program comes up with a suitable title for your song.
Band-in-a-Box will keep generating new titles for as long as it takes to get the right one.
154
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
Automatic Solo Generation – “The Soloist”
Pick any song or chords in any style, and choose a “Soloist.” Band-in-a-Box then creates and plays a professional
quality solo in the style of your choice. In addition to great Band-in-a-Box accompaniment, you can hear
sensational solos as well - showing you exactly what notes are played. Choose from “soloists” in a style similar to
great Jazz musicians such as Django Reinhardt, John Coltrane, Country/Pop soloists and others, or create your own
soloists using the “Soloist Maker.”
Select a Soloist
To select a pre-made Soloist, click on the [Soloist] button on the toolbar, press Shift+F4, or choose Soloist
|Generate and Play a Solo. This will launch the Select Soloist dialog.
Now, select the type of Soloist (“Soloist Type” list box) and choose the appropriate style. This will bring up a list of
Soloists in that style. Then, simply choose which one you would like to hear and what instrument you would like
the Soloist to play.
When the “All” box is checked, all soloists will be displayed but those that do not conform to the
Soloist Type box will be in parentheses. If this box is not checked, only Soloists that conform to the
Soloist Type selection will be displayed.
The [Fav] button opens a Favorite Soloist
list of the fifty most recently used Soloists, with the most recent at the top.
The [RealTracks] button moves the Soloist list to #361, which is the start of the RealTracks Soloists. These are
Soloists that are audio, not MIDI. Soloists generated with RealTracks are saved with the song, so you will hear the
RealTracks play the same solo when you reload the song.
When you generate a solo using RealTracks, Band-in-a-Box will remember this, and when you go to save the song,
Band-in-a-Box will ask you if you want to save that solo (and thereby freeze the Soloist track). If you say yes, then
the solo will play instantly the same way when the song is reloaded. Of course, you can freeze the Soloist track
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
155
yourself at any time. Note that only one solo can be saved. You can’t generate a bunch of different segments of
solos; only the last one will be saved.
Use the [Search] button to search the Soloist titles and memos. Check the “All” button to search all Soloists,
otherwise only the type selected will be searched.
[Go to] will go to the specific Soloist number that you enter in the box.
The “Memo” has information about the selected Soloist and notes about using it.
There are additional settings that let you customize the solo.
When “Double Time” is checked, the Soloist will play twice as many notes in a given space of time. This is useful
for ballads or other tunes with slower tempos.
The solo instrument is set by default according to the selected Soloist, but you can override that instrument by
clicking on the list box and choosing from the General MIDI patch list.
The [Choose] button opens a list of instruments that typically play in the same register as the default instrument.
You can choose a new solo instrument from the list.
[Clear] will clear the default or chosen solo instrument, useful if you want to keep a previously used solo
instrument.
Some Soloists have a harmony assigned. You can use this setting to override the selection or to add a harmony of
your own choosing. Use [Clear] to remove the harmony.
If a selected Soloist autoloads a new style, that style will be displayed here. You can [Choose] to load a new style
with the selected Soloist, or you can [Clear] the selection so that no style is loaded.
“Change Instrument” determines if and how frequently the Soloist instrument will change. This could be each
chorus, every part marker, every substyle change, or every 4, 8, 16, or 32 bars.
Solo Modes
As well as the normal mode of soloing for a number of choruses while
the melody is silent, the Soloist has several other modes.
For example, Fills will “noodle” over the changes for a percentage of
time.
Other modes are Solo Around Melody, Trade 4s, Solo Wizard, and
Custom Solo for a Specific Range of Bars.
156
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
Around Melody option.
This option for the Soloist part creates a solo around the melody, that is, at times when the melody is silent. To solo
around the melody, do the following:
1. Open up a song that has a melody, preferably a sparse melody with some space in it that a Soloist might be able
to “jump in.”
2. Press the Soloist button. Select the Solo Mode “Around Melody.”
3. Set the Soloist to play in All Choruses, and uncheck the “Mute Melody in Middle” option.
4. Press [OK] and the solo will be generated, playing riffs at times when the melody isn't playing.
Tip: For added effect, add a guitar chord solo to the Soloist part using the Chord Solo button on the Guitar and choosing Solo
as the destination. Or simply choose a Guitar Harmony like 32 J Pass.
Trade Fours Soloing
Band-in-a-Box can generate the first four or the second four bars. “Trading fours” refers to a solo lasting four bars,
usually followed by a different melodic solo (or drum solo) for the next four bars. It’s fun to solo along with Bandin-a-Box in 4's mode, letting the computer solo for four bars, followed by your solo.
In the Select Soloist dialog, you can click on the button beside the “Trade 4's” radio control to select whether you
want the first four bars or the second four bars. If set to 1st, the soloist will take bars 1-4, 9-12, etc. And if set to 2nd,
it will solo on bars 5-8, 13-16, etc. The fours are based on the beginning of the chorus, not the first bar of the song.
You can generate four bars trading off with each other in two ways. The easiest way is to choose the Normal Solo
mode, and select the “Change Instrument Every 4 bars” option. This results in different instruments taking four bar
solos.
Another method is to choose the trade 4's option, generate 4's using the first setting, and then choose Soloist | Edit
Soloist Track | Swap Melody and Soloist Track, and then generate a solo again, using the second set of four bars.
This will result in 4's with one track on Melody and the other on the Soloist track.
Solo Wizard
Additionally, you will find another great feature in the Solo mode list, the “Solo Wizard.” With this mode selected,
the program will play correct notes in the style of the current Soloist as you play notes on the MIDI or QWERTY
keyboard,
Beyond impressing your friends with your newfound improvisational prowess, this feature has practical implications
as well. For example, you can concentrate on practicing your solo phrasing and playing in time without concerning
yourself with which notes to play. Band-in-a-Box will supply the correct notes.
Tip: The Soloist will use the velocities you play or pick its own, depending on the setting in the Soloist Prefs “Use MIDI
Volume for Soloist Wizard” checkbox.
Custom Solo Generation
You can redo any part of the solo that you don't like with
the ability to generate and regenerate parts of the solo.
There is a [Custom…] button on the Select Soloist dialog.
This launches a custom solo dialog to allow you to set a
range for the solo.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
157
Tip: You can have these values preset to the values you'd like by first selecting the range of bars that you'd like from the
Chordsheet screen, and then clicking on the Soloist button.
Usually soloists end a little after a bar end –i.e. they play a couple of extra notes. Setting the “OK to solo for an
extra beat” will allow this.
If you want to overdub a solo and have multiple solo tracks going at once, de-select “Overwrite existing solo in
range.”
Once you press the [Generate Solo Now] button, the portion of the solo that you have selected will be generated.
The song will then start playing two bars before the new part, so you can quickly hear the new solo.
Remember that the custom solo generation can be used with different soloists, so you can use a “Tenor Sax Jazz”
soloist for a few bars, and then insert a custom “Bluegrass Banjo” soloist for four bars and so on.
Soloing over Slash Chords
The Soloist analyzes slash chords (like C/Bb) to determine the best scale type to use (e.g. Bb Lydian). There's
nothing you need to do, this function happens automatically behind the scenes.
Editing Soloists
If you'd like to create your own Soloists, or permanently change the settings
of existing Soloists, you can press the [Edit] button to launch the Soloist
Maker, which is described in detail elsewhere.
Tutorial: Using the Soloist Feature
-
Generate a Soloist and practice the solo by looping it, slowing it down, or printing it out, until you can perform
a great solo on any chord changes!
- Generate a Soloist and attach a Harmony such as “Big Band Brass” to create phenomenally quick and
interesting Big Band Arrangements automatically. Generate a standard MIDI file or print them out for you and
your friends.
- Have the Soloist play a solo according to your accompaniment and arrangement.
- Trade 4's with the Soloist (you solo for 4 bars, BB solos for 4 bars, etc.).
- Concentrate separately on different aspects of your playing with assistance from the “Wizard.” From soloing
with proper phrasing and “feel” (and the best notes) to accompanying a soloist with confidence and authority.
- Use the Soloist track to record another part in addition to the Melody and other parts provided by Band-in-aBox.
- Generate a Soloist on chords/keys that you would like to practice. For example, if you want to work on your IIV7-I progressions, you can just type the chords you want, and generate a solo to play over those changes. As
the solo plays, you see the notation, you can sight read along. Pressing the “Loop Screen” checkbox on the
notation will loop the notation the screen so you can master each 4 bar phrase (II-V-I) and then move ahead to
the next one!
A Few Technical Notes on the Soloist.
- The Soloist has its own separate channel and settings. But when the Soloist uses a Harmony, it becomes linked to
the Thru Harmony channels and settings. Since we are already using 12 of the available 16 MIDI channels in
Band-in-a-Box, we didn't want to use up another 2 channels on dedicated Soloist Harmony channels. So if you
want to hear a Soloist with harmony, use the THRU Harmony settings. In other words, wherever a THRU
harmony is selected, the Soloist part will use the THRU Harmony settings.
- We have designed the Soloist not to repeat any solo ideas so that the solos are always fresh, with new ideas
forming and playing all the time. As a result, we have included a Refresh Soloist menu item under the Soloist
menu that, when selected, will allow the Soloist to “think about” all of its musical notions again. Choosing the
158
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
“Refresh Soloist” option (Shift+F7) is like telling the soloist “It's OK, you can play whatever you like, even if it's
something that you played 5 minutes ago.”
- The Soloist menu contains many options. It has all of the same editing options found in the Melody menu, so you
can treat the Soloist track as a 2nd melody track. Even if you don't plan to use the Automatic Soloist feature, you
can just use the Soloist track as a 2nd track for counter melodies, overdubs etc. The result; two melody tracks,
two solo tracks, or one melody and one solo track all at your disposal for any song, without having to resort to an
outboard sequencer.
Automatic Guitar Chord Solos – “The Guitarist”
With Band-in-a-Box, you can generate a guitar chord solo for any melody. Band-in-a-Box will intelligently arrange
the melody into a guitar chord solo by inserting real guitar voicings throughout the piece. You can select from
among many Guitarists to create your arrangement. And you can define your own Guitarists, choosing parameters
such as strum speed, types of voicings (Pop/Jazz), embellishments, and many more. You can easily make and
learn a professional quality guitar chord solo to your favorite song!
Generate a Guitar Chord Solo
Load in a song with a melody in it. We suggest the song GIT_TEST that should be in your Songs folder. If it isn't
there, choose the song “Old Folks at Home” or any other song with a melody.
Open the Guitar window (Ctrl+Shift+G). Launch the Chord Solo function with
the [Ch. Solo] button, or select Melody | Generate Guitar Chord Solo.
Select Guitarist Window.
Once you press the Chord Solo button, you'll see the Select Guitarist window.
Here are the steps needed to generate your Chord Solo:
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
159
1.
Select the Guitarist to Use. In the main list at the left of the Window, you see the list of Guitarists that is
already defined. For example, you can see that Guitarist #2 is called “Jazz Guitar, single position.” That will
create chord solos that stick to a single position on the guitar neck whenever possible.
2.
Select Melody or Soloist track. You'd normally want the Guitar Chord solo to be written to the Melody track,
but you can also select the Soloist track as the destination.
3.
Confirm the Guitar Patch Selection. The Guitarist that you pick (see item #1) will already have chosen the
guitar patch to use, but you can override it with this setting.
4.
Select the Range of the song to use. You can either generate a chord solo for the whole song, or just a region
of the song. In either case, remember that you need to have an existing melody to work with. You can use the
Melodist to generate a melody if you don't have one.
5.
Select the Main Guitar Position to use. Band-in-a-Box has a setting called “Auto Set” that will set the main
guitar position for the solo for you, based on the key signature. For example, in the key of C, Band-in-a-Box
will choose the 5th position as the best position for the chord solo to be played. You can override this. For
example, if you wanted the solo to be in the 12th position you could de-select the “Auto-Set” and then set the
guitar position to 12th position.
6.
Change Guitar channel. In case you already have a guitar track that has guitar channels (for example if it was
already played on a guitar controller as a single string guitar part), then you might want to tell Band-in-a-Box
not to change the guitar positions of the notes that it finds. Normally you'd want to set “OK to change existing
guitar channels” to true.
160
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
7.
Press [OK] to generate the Guitar Chord Solo.
You'll now see a message box confirming that a chord solo has been added.
Playing the Guitar Chord Solo
The playback will begin automatically, and you'll see the guitar voicings on the guitar neck. For example, at Bar 8,
the chord is a C#dim and Band-in-a-Box has voiced a Bb melody note with a 4-note guitar voicing of Bb, E, C#, and
G.
This particular solo will be played in a single position, because those are the parameters of this particular guitarist.
Other Guitarists will play in a range of positions (e.g. Guitarist #1), or in open position (e.g. Guitarist # 8).
As you listen to the solo, you'll notice the following:
1. Some of the notes are left as melody, and some are assigned to chords.
2. Wide varieties of guitar chords are used, including some advanced chords. All of them are popular chords
played by real guitarists – there are no theoretical chords.
3. The chords are strummed, to simulate a real guitar player.
4. The Track Type for the Melody has been set to Guitar, and the MIDI file will be saved with the Guitar Channels
(11-16) preserved which preserves the fret positions.
Note: All of these items can be customized in the Guitarist Maker, which is launched by the [Edit...] button in the Select
Guitarist dialog.
Redo Part of the Solo
Let's redo part of the solo at a higher fret position. This particular song GIT_TEST.MGU has 6 choruses, and the
last 3 choruses have a much higher range of soloing. Let's redo that part of the solo, using a higher fret position.
We'll press the [Ch. Solo] button again, de-select the auto-set position button, and choose the 12 position. Since we
only want to regenerate this for the choruses 4 to 6, we set the range to “Part of Song” and the range to start at
chorus 4, bar 1, and range of 96 bars. This will rewrite the solo, by first removing the existing guitar chord solo (if
any) and then generating a new one.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
161
Technical Note: Since some of the guitarists can be assigned to strum the chords in a delayed fashion, if you repeatedly regenerate the solo, the melody will become more and more delayed. The solution(s) would be to choose Edit | Undo Solo prior
to re-generating the solo, or picking a Guitarist that doesn't delay the strum. The Strum delay status is indicated on the “Info”
panel of the Select Guitarist screen.
Saving the Guitar Chord Solo
Once you have generated a Guitar chord solo it becomes part of the notation track. You can edit it like any other
part by deleting/inserting notes, etc.
The solo will be saved with the song (MGU) and exported to a MIDI file, with the string positions intact (because
we use channels 11 to 16 for the Guitar part). You can remove the solo at any time, even after the solo has been
saved/reloaded, by choosing Melody | Remove Harmony (or guitar solo) from Melody Track.
Guitar Settings
The Guitar Settings dialog allows you the ability to adjust various parameters on the on-screen guitar fretboard so
that music can be displayed effectively (and easily) on this window, regardless of the original instrument intended
for the track data. It also offers the ability to enter notation using the on-screen guitar, and to play back track data in
specific fretboard positions for educational and sight-reading purposes.
Note Display Options
If MIDI Thru is selected (default = On), the Guitar will display the music played on a MIDI keyboard. If Current
Track is selected (default = On), the current track will be displayed
162
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
The guitar will display information on channels 11 to 16 on strings 1 to 6 if Multi-Channel Mode is set to = On
(default). Channel 11 is referred to as the “base channel” (default = 11). You can edit notes on the Notation to set
the channels of the notes. Guitar controllers will also record information in this manner, so you can record on a
MIDI guitar and see the display on the Guitar Fretboard. The base channel is normally 11, but you can set it to any
channel (e.g. if set for channel 5, this would mean that channels 5 to 10 would be the guitar channels).
The Fretboard Color can be brown or black (default=brown).
If you elect to not display note names, you can select “Use Inlays” and a guitar inlays will be displayed along the
neck.
If Send Notes to (Editable) Notation Window is set, when you click on the Guitar notes (and the Notation window
is open in Editable Notation mode or Staff Roll mode) the note will get inserted at the current time line on the
Notation window.
If you would like to have Melody and Soloist parts written specifically for guitar, set this to “Yes.” Then the notes
that are played on the six different strings will be assigned to six separate MIDI channels.
You can set the Fretboard Octave. For example, if the music is very low, and you need to boost the octave to
display it on the guitar, set the guitar octave to 1 or 2.
There is an AutoSet Octave setting (discussed elsewhere). If selected, the Guitar Octave is set automatically.
Use Index Finger Position: If set, the scale will use the “index finger” to play notes that are one fret outside of the
normal position, instead of the little finger.
Show out-of-range notes: If set, any note will be displayed on the guitar, regardless if it is the range of the guitar or
not.
Show muted note of guitar style comping: For the three-note Jazz voicings, there is a high note that is applicable
to the chord but is either not played or muted. You can choose to display this note on the guitar fretboard.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
163
The note names will get displayed in up to two positions, depending on the settings for Show Notes at Aeolian
Position and Show Guitar at Phrygian Position. (Default = true)
You can choose which notes will be displayed on the fretboard, either None, Root Only, Chord Tones, or Scale
Tones.
Positions can be auto-set to None, Aeolian, or Phrygian.
The Auto-Switch Position setting allows the program to automatically switch the display of the guitar when a new
track is loaded in. This auto-chooses the best position to display the track.
The Guitar can be sized using the Guitar Width and Guitar Height setting or the preset buttons that set the size.
[Set to Defaults] button sets the Guitar window to factory defaults.
The [Update] button will apply any change you have made to the fretboard size.
Editing Guitarists
Guitarists can be customized using the Guitarist Maker, which is
described in a separate topic and is launched by the [Edit...] button in
the Select Guitarist dialog ([Ch. Solo] button).
Melody Embellisher
When musicians see a lead sheet that has a melody written out, they would almost never play it exactly as written.
They would change the timing to add syncopation, change durations to achieve staccato or legato playing, add grace
notes, slurs, extra notes, vibrato, and other effects. Now you can have Band-in-a-Box do these automatically using
the Melody Embellisher. If you enable the Embellisher, any melody will be embellished as it is played, so that you
hear a livelier and more realistic melody - and it's different every time.
The Melody Embellisher feature is turned on and off by the Embellisher checkbox on the main
screen.
The Melody Embellisher settings are accessed during playback with the embellisher (grace note) button on
the main screen, or from the Melody | Embellish Melody during playback menu item.
The Melody Embellisher only functions during playback. If enabled, the melody that plays will be embellished.
You’ll see the embellished melody on the notation as the melody plays, so you can see the embellished notes. When
[Stop] is pressed, the notation reverts to the original unembellished melody.
The embellishment changes timing of notes, durations, velocities, legato, as well as adding grace notes, additional
notes, and turns. Here is a before-and-after example that shows a typical embellishment of a melody.
164
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
Original (unembellished) Melody…
Embellished Melody…
As you can see in the notation examples, the embellished melody adds anticipation in bar 9, and in bar 10 adds extra
notes and timing changes to spice up the melody.
Using the Embellisher
If you disable the Embellisher, by de-selecting the Embellisher checkbox, the melody (or solo)
will play as normal with no changes.
There is a Melody Embellisher dialog. It is launched from the Melody | Embellish Melody Dialog
menu item (control+option+l) or the Embellisher (grace note) button on the main screen. This
allows you to customize the settings of the Embellisher, choose Embellisher type from presets, and
make a particular embellishment permanent.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
165
“Live Auto-embellish during every playback” is
the same setting that is on the main page checkbox. If enabled, embellishment will occur during every playback. If
disabled, embellishment will not occur unless you choose the [(Re-) Embellish NOW - Permanent] button in the
dialog.
Embellisher Presets
The presets allow you to choose a combination of common settings for the Embellisher quickly.
The Embellisher Memo describes the current embellishment, with statistics counting the number of embellished
notes.
If the song is playing and the Embellisher is enabled, you can update the embellishment by pressing this button.
This is useful if you've changed settings, and want to hear what the new embellishment sounds like.
[Defaults] reverts to factory settings. [More] opens a dialog with additional settings to fine-tune the Embellisher,
and [Stats] displays the same thing that appears in the Memo field, but will display it even when there is no current
embellishment.
If the song is not currently playing, you can still create an embellishment and have it apply permanently by pressing
the [(Re-) Embellish NOW – Permanent] button.
Normally the embellishment occurs live when the song is playing, and doesn't affect the Melody track permanently.
But if you like the embellishment, and want to apply it permanently to the melody, you can choose the [Make
Current Embellishment Permanent] option.
The original Melody track is not permanently affected unless you have press the [(Re-) Embellish NOW –
Permanent] button. If you have done this, and want to restore the original melody, you can press the [Restore
Original Melody] button.
The Embellisher is usually referred to as the Melody Embellisher, because you'll usually want to have it affecting
the Melody track. But if you'd prefer it to affect the Soloist track, you can choose the Soloist track as the
Embellisher track.
166
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
Embellisher Settings
The settings contain a number of parameters that affect the embellishment. They can be turned on and off, and can
be set with certain percentage strength. The settings are:
Humanize: The velocities, durations (legato), and timing of the notes are humanized. The original velocities etc. of
the notes are ignored. This is useful when the melody has been entered in a stiff manner.
Adjust Octave: The octave of the Melody is changed to the best octave for the current Melody instrument. For
example, if the instrument were a Piccolo the octave would be raised to the best range for a piccolo. There is an
additional setting for the octave in the “More” settings dialog.
Anticipations: An anticipated note is played early, or “ahead of the beat,” as in this example.
Unembellished notes
Embellishment with anticipations on beat 1 and 3
Less Anticipations: This is the opposite of anticipation. This finds notes that are anticipated, and “embellishes”
them by playing them later (on the beat).
Grace Notes: The grace notes are brief notes played just before, and a semi-tone below the original note. The grace
notes intentionally don't show on the notation, so that it will remain easily readable. They can be heard.
Doubled Notes: Melody notes are doubled with the same pitch.
“C” quarter note is
Embellished …
Unembellished …
doubled to 2 eighth
notes.
Extra Notes: Extra notes are added between melody notes.
In this before-andUnembellished …
With Extra Notes added …
after example, an Eb
and E note are added
between the D and F.
Note “Turns”: With a note turn, a single note is replaced by a group of notes that includes the original note and the
semitone or scale tones above and below.
In this before-andUnembellished …
Embellished with turn …
after example, the C
note is replaced by a
“turn” of 3 notes
with a note a scale
tone above the C.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
167
Vibrato: Vibrato can be added according to the additional vibrato settings available in the “More” dialog. The
vibrato can't be seen on the notation window, but you can examine the events in the Event List.
If set, the Melody will be delayed a little, providing a “laid-back” feeling.
There are additional settings in the Embellisher Additional Settings dialog box.
This allows you to set advanced settings for the Embellisher. These include,
- Vibrato Depth: This is the amplitude of the vibrato, ranging from 0 - 127.
- Vibrato Speed: This is the speed of the vibrato (slow-fast) range 0 - 127.
- Only use Vibrato if Note is this many ticks: e.g., If set to 120 ticks (one quarter note), then only notes of at
least that duration will get vibrato.
168
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
-
Start the Vibrato after this many ticks: For notes that will get vibrato, the vibrato will start after this many
ticks.
Adjust Octave Method: If the octave is to be adjusted, it will either only adjust it if the notes are outside the
playable range, or always adjust it to the best octave, according to the setting you make here.
Dynamic Range: Refers to the range of velocities used for the humanization. Useful range 30 to 50.
Legato Settings: Refers to the amount of legato for the notes. Useful range 55 to 75.
The Reharmonist
Generate Chords for a Melody
Generate chords for a melody, or an improved chord progression for a melody, with the “Reharmonist” feature.
This feature generates a chord progression in the chosen genre, based only on the melody.
The idea of the Reharmonist is to generate a completely new chord progression for a melody, in a genre that you
choose (Jazz, Country, etc.). This ignores any existing chords in the song.
Chords for a Whole Song
This example uses the melody of Bach’s Brandenburg Concerto #1 in F, 1st movement, but you could use the
melody of any song you choose.
Press the [Re-Harm] button to open the Select Re-Harmonist dialog and choose “Whole Song.”
You could also use Windows | Auto-Generate Chord Reharmonization.
Deselect “Show-All” and then select the “Bossa Nova (Latin)” genre.
Note that the program has analyzed the melody, and decided that the key should be F (this is independent of any key
that was already set in the song).
Now press “OK – Reharmonize.” You will then have an entire chord
progression written for the song, in a Bossa Nova style.
The Chord Progression generated is different every time, so the one that you get will be different from this one.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
169
Play the file that you have generated. Notice the “Bossa” style of chord progression, with 2-5
progressions, and other typical Bossa chords.
Revisit the Reharmonize dialog, and try generating a new chord progression, in a new Genre.
For example, “EZ listening (Pop)” will
generate a Pop style chord progression, very different from the Jazz chords in the Bossa version.
Reharmonize Part of a Song
Now let’s use the Reharmonist in an “interactive mode” where it gives us choices of various chord progressions at
each bar. Let’s see if we can interactively improve on the chord progression, according to our own tastes.
The first 2 bars generated originally are:
Make sure that the currently highlighted cell is bar 1.
Now press the Re-Harm button, but this time choose
“Part of Song” and under “Set Range” enter Bar 1,
Chorus 1, and the # bars as 2.
Here are two of the possible variations the Re-Harmonist has suggested for the first two bars.
See a List of Possible Reharmonizations
This could also be done with the menu command Windows | Chord Reharmonist Dialog (choose your own).
In the Reharmonize melody – new chords for 2 bars of the melody dialog you can choose from a list of
reharmonizations for any 2 bar segment of the song.
Use the feature interactively by displaying a menu of possible chord progressions for a portion of the melody, and
audition them to choose the best one using the “Bar Reharmonist.” This allows you to hear some new chord
progressions for existing melodies, or brand new progressions for tunes without chords.
170
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
The reharmonization starts at the Bar # indicated. Use the [-2] and [+2] buttons to navigate to the segment to be
recompiled.
Choose a chord progression, and press [Do-Reharmonize NOW] and the program will insert that progression.
The progressions are sorted in alphabetical order, or from “best to worst” depending on this setting.
Chapter 8: Automatic Music Features
171
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
Overview
Band-in-a-Box has a built-in sequencer allowing you to record and edit up to two MIDI tracks. One track is the
Melody track, the other is the Soloist track, and they are identical in function. Most often melodies are recorded, but
the two sequencer tracks can be used for any type of MIDI recording – overdubs, extra parts, or 2-part melodies.
MIDI can be recorded into Band-in-a-Box in a number of ways:
- From a MIDI keyboard or MIDI controller connected to your computer.
- In the Notation window using your mouse.
- With the Wizard feature using your QWERTY keyboard.
Real Time Recording
If you want to record using your MIDI controller (keyboard, guitar, wind), click on the [Record]
button, or
- type the letter R or
- choose Record Melody from the Melody menu, or
- go to Edit Soloist Track | Record Soloist in the Soloist menu.
The Record Track or Record to Soloist Part dialog box will appear:
Choose where you want to start recording your track:
- from the start of the song,
- at a specified bar,
- at the tag,
- from the end of the track.
If you select “Overdub Underlying Notes,” you will hear the melody that you're overdubbing.
172
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
The [Filter] button in the Record dialog opens the Record Filter dialog. This lets you choose which MIDI
information you want to record and which you want to leave out. You can eliminate unnecessary MIDI information
or select new MIDI information, like controllers, to add to an existing track.
Click OK to return to the Record dialog, and press the [Record] button or the letter R again to begin recording.
Tip: If you're sure that the settings are correct, just press R twice, and you won't have to see the Record Track dialog.
When the recording is finished, you have several options.
[OK - Keep Take] will save the take that was just recorded.
Copy 1st Chorus to Whole Song
If you have recorded one chorus of the song, checking this at the end of the recording will copy the same recording
to all of the choruses.
Overdub Underlying Notes
You have the option to merge the recording with existing melody. If there is no underlying melody - this option will
be grayed out.
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
173
Retain Past Last Recorded
You have the option to keep or erase any melody after the last recorded note.
Step Edit Notes
You can step edit a recorded track, or create a new track in the Edit Note/Time Etc., dialog. Select Step edit
Notes… from the Melody menu.
This feature is very useful if you have recorded a good take with just a minor glitch. Rather than scrap the take, you
can use the step edit feature to fix the track and save it.
Note Number
The note is played out through the MIDI driver so you can hear it. The note is also drawn on the Keyboard at the
top of the screen so you can see it.
Input the MIDI Note Number. There are 128 MIDI notes. Every C note is a multiple of 12, which makes middle C
(called C5 for the 5th octave) note number 60. For example, C5 = 60, C#5 = 61, D5 = 62 etc.). In the example
above therefore the note = 64 would be 4 semitones above middle C, an E.
Velocity
Type in a velocity to control the volume that the note is played at. Change the velocity to zero to stop a note from
being played. Note that you can globally change the volume of a melody track, from the melody pull down menu
Time
Represents the total time in ticks for the current event from the beginning of the song. At 120 ppq resolution, a
quarter note equals 120 ticks and a bar of 4/4 time is 480 ticks. This number includes the lead-in bar of 480 ticks.
Bar #, Beat Number, Tick
The Bar, Beat, and Tick show the time that the note is played. Ticks are the smallest unit, equal to 1/120th of a
quarter note.
Duration
This is the length of time that the note is played. 120 ticks of duration = 1 beat (quarter note).
Previous/Next Event
Use these arrow controls to move through the MIDI track one note at a time.
Insert Before/After
This allows you to insert an event before or after the currently displayed event.
Note: You can get better results by using the Notation window to edit notes instead of this window. To do this, you open the
Notation window and mouse click on a note while holding down the option key in Staff Roll or Editable notation mode.
174
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
Entering Notes Manually in the Notation Window
You can enter melody notes directly to the track in the Notation window in either the Editable Notation Mode or the
Staff Roll Mode.
Enter the Editable Notation mode from the Standard Notation screen with a single mouse click on the
[N] button.
In the Editable Notation mode you can enter, move, and edit notes and rests using standard mouse techniques – point
and click, drag and drop, and Option+Click to open the Note Edit dialog box.
Recording with the Wizard Feature
This is a very helpful feature if you don’t have a MIDI keyboard but you want to record with a “live” feel. Use the
Wizard to record notes from the computer’s QWERTY keyboard for a track that’s more natural than step time.
Here’s how it works:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Enable the Wizard checkbox.
Press [r] key to record.
As the song plays, play the melody on any keys on the bottom two rows of the QWERTY keyboard, in the
rhythm of the melody. The “wizard” notes won't be the correct melody of course, but don't worry about that as
you record. When you're finished, look in the Notation window. You’ll see notes in the right places and with
the correct durations, but with the wrong pitches.
Drag the notes with the mouse and drop them on the correct place on the staff. You’ll hear the notes play as
you drop them, and the names will show in the note name box. For sharps, flats, and naturals, hold down the
shift key, control key, or key respectively. You'll end up with a melody that sounds like it was recorded
live, without the rigid feel of tracks entered in step time.
Tip: If you have the wizard “On,” the spacebar won’t stop playback. You need to press [Esc] key to stop playback when the Wizard
is on. This is to prevent stopping the song inadvertently if you mistakenly hit the spacebar while playing the wizard.
Importing Pre-Recorded MIDI Data
Standard MIDI files can be read in to the Melody or Soloist tracks from MIDI files or from the clipboard. You can
read in all of a MIDI file, or selected channels and a specific range of bars. Use one of the following two
commands:
1.
2.
Melody | Import Melody from MIDI File… to select a MIDI file from disk using the file dialog.
Melody | Import Melody from Clipboard - when the MIDI data is already copied from another program to the
clipboard.
Once chosen, the Import MIDI File dialog box opens.
Import Which Channel(s)?
You'll need to know which channel(s) of your MIDI file the melody is on. You then select these channels for Bandin-a-Box to read in. If you select all of the channels, Band-in-a-Box will read all of the channels and merge them to
the Melody track. You can import and play the complete file on the Melody track if the Track Type is set to “Multi
(16) Channel” in the Melody menu.
If you have such a MIDI guitar part that was recorded with separate pitch bend information on 6 channels, you can
import the 6 channels into Band-in-a-Box. Set the Melody track to be a guitar track (Melody | Track Type), and then
use the Guitar Settings dialog (in the Guitar window) to set the “Output guitar tracks on 6 channels for this song” to
be true. This has been done for the “Nashville Solos” files like NG001.MGU (available as an add-on to Band-in-aBox). When this option is set, the patch changes, panning and so on will be sent on all 6 MIDI channels.
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
175
# bars to offset from start
If you want to start reading from the beginning of the MIDI file, select 0 as the offset. If you want to be read
starting at bar 32, for example, select an offset of 32 (bars).
How many bars to import
Leave this setting at the default of 1000 to read-in the entire file (unless it’s longer than 1000 bars!), or set it to the
number of bars that you are interested in if you don't want the whole file.
# blank b. to insert at beginning
This will insert blank bars into the Melody track. Remember that Band-in-a-Box normally has a 2 bar lead-in count.
If your MIDI file has no lead-in, then you'll need to set this to = 2 to compensate for the 2 bars of lead-in.
Include notes early by (120 ppq)
If you’re reading in a MIDI file starting at bar 5, it would be annoying to have a note that was played 1 tick earlier
than bar 5 left out of the MIDI file that is read in. To include it, you can set this, and the note will be read in.
Include continuous controllers and pitch bend /Patch changes
Select the items you want to include when the track is imported.
Merge with existing data on Track
You can choose to merge the imported data with your existing Melody track.
Record using The Melodist
There’s always the option to let Band-in-a-Box do it all by writing an original melody with its Melodist feature. It
will do this over the chord changes you enter in the Chordsheet, or it will generate its own changes for whatever
style you select from the Melodist dialog.
This feature is useful for stimulating ideas, for creating instant songs for sight reading exercises, to demonstrate
different musical styles, or for background music.
176
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
Additional Options for Melody/Soloist Track
Manipulation of melodies is done with functions like insert/delete beats, time shift track, copy melody from bar... to
bar..., etc. Press Option+C to Copy Chords and /or Melody over a range of bars.
Time Shift Melody.
This will move (slide) the melody a certain number of ticks. There are 120 ticks per quarter note. For example, to
give the song a more laid-back feel, time shift it about 10 ticks ahead.
Intelligent Humanize of Melody and Soloist track.
Most quantize routines can leave the music sounding stiff and unmusical. Some attempt to “humanize” a part by
adding “randomization,” which rarely has the desired effect since humans don't randomly change timing or volume.
Band-in-a-Box uses intelligent humanization routines that can humanize a melody from one feel to another, from
one tempo to another, and vary the amount of swing to 8th notes. The results are very musical, with natural
sounding melodies.
Let's look at some of the parameters found under the Humanize menu items.
In this example, Melody | Humanize Melody was selected. This opens the Quantize to New Tempo or Feel dialog
box.
We have broken down the Humanize effect into 5 main categories:
1. Tempo
2. Lateness
3. 8th note spacing
4. Legato
5. Feel
The best way to learn how these parameters combine is to try them. You can always press [Undo] button if you
don't like the results. For example, try changing the tempo of a song to see the changes that this will make to the 8th
note spacing and lateness.
Tip: Usually, when a musician plays at faster tempos, he/she plays the swing 8th notes closer together, and a little later.
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
177
These categories are very straightforward and you should have no trouble achieving the desired results. Remember
to apply such parameters as Legato and Lateness sparingly.
Insert Beats/Delete Beats in Melody.
For example, to insert 2 bars in the melody at bar 5, Choose Melody | Insert Beats In Melody, and select bar 5, and
select 8 beats (2 bars) to insert.
Additional Copy function for Chords/Melody
This allows you to Copy Chords and/or Melody for a range of bars.
Press the [Copy] button to launch the dialog box or select the Copy From.. To option from
the Edit menu or press option+c.
178
Chapter 9: Recording Tracks
Chapter 10: Audio Features
RealTracks and RealDrums
With the introduction of RealDrums and RealTracks, Band-in-a-Box adds live audio to its mix. These “real” parts
add a human element that brings new life to any Band-in-a-Box arrangement. Any Band-in-a-Box part can be
played in audio by a “real” drummer or instrumentalist from tracks recorded by top session players and recording
artists. These features are fully described in their own topics, but using them is easy as 1-2-3.
Generating RealDrums
1.
Ctrl+click (or right click or double click) on the Drums part on the main screen. A
contextual menu will open.
2. Click on Choose Real Drums… to open the RealDrums Picker.
3. Choose a RealDrums style and press [OK].
Your song will play with an audio drum track generated from live recordings by a studio drummer.
Generating RealTracks
1.
Ctrl+click (or right click or double click) on the instrumental part that you want to convert to
audio. A contextual menu will open.
2.
Click on Choose RealTracks… to open the Assign RealTracks to Tracks dialog.
Chapter 10: Audio Features
179
3. Choose a RealTracks instrument and press [Generate Track].
Your song will play with an audio instrumental track generated from live recordings by a studio drummer.
Render MIDI Track to AIFF File
Any Band-in-a-Box MIDI track can be automatically rendered to an AIFF audio file from its contextual menu. The
menu opens with either a right mouse click, Control+click, or a double click on the part name. By selecting the
Menu command Save MIDI track as AIFF file the complete
Band-in-a-Box track will be rendered to an audio file.
The file can then be imported into another audio program, such
as GarageBand or Cubase.
Rendering Audio Files
Direct-to-Disk Audio Rendering
Audio rendering means converting a MIDI song to audio format, usually to an AIFF file or a compressed M4A file.
Press the [Audio] button on the main Band-in-a-Box screen to render your Band-in-a-Box song to an AIFF,
M4A, or WAV file. The song is rendered automatically in 5 – 10 seconds through the built-in Apple DLS
Music Device or Core MIDI. It’s that easy!
You can choose to render the full mix of MIDI tracks and RealTracks together, or just the mix of RealTracks or
MIDI tracks alone.
By selecting “Individual RealTracks” or “Individual MIDI Tracks” each track will be rendered to its own separate
file. This allows for complete control when the files are imported into another program for further editing and
mixing.
There is a choice of output formats.
180
Chapter 10: Audio Features
- AIFF (Audio Interchange File Format) is a lossless audio format most commonly used on Macintosh computer
systems. The audio data in a standard AIFF file is uncompressed pulse-code modulation (PCM). This is the
format to use for the highest quality, but the file size is large – typically 10MB per minute of stereo audio at a
sample rate of 44.1kHz and a 16 bit sample size.
- M4A is an audio file that uses high-quality MPEG-4 audio compression. It uses the same compression algorithm
as an MP4 video file, but an M4A file is audio-only and does not contain a video track.
- WAV is another lossless audio file format (usually PCM) based on the Resource Interchange File Format (RIFF).
It is more common on Windows systems, but can also be played by the Macintosh. Use this format to export
lossless audio files to a Windows computer.
When rendering audio files you have the choice of making stereo or mono files. The Auto Channels setting will use
the current Band-in-a-Box setup.
The Normalize option will normalize individual tracks or the complete arrangement. Normalizing boosts the
volume to a maximum level without distortion. Most professional music tracks are normalized.
To enable this, set the “Normalize Rendered Files” option to true.
By default, the rendered files are save to /Applications/Band-in-a-Box/Song Renders in a subfolder ending in
_Render Folder.
This example shows the default location for rendering the individual tracks of the =GeorgPG Demo file. The
=GeorgP Demo_RenderFolder will be created in Song Renders, and, since Individual RealTracks is selected, it will
contain separate AIFF files for both the pedal steel and guitar RealTracks.
Click on this button to specify a different folder location for the rendered audio file.
With the audio rendering feature you can save your files directly as audio files for use in other programs
(GarageBand, Cubase, etc.) or in Internet formats.
Audio Reverb Control
The Reverb control for individual tracks with RealTracks or RealDrums is added so you can easily add audio reverb.
At the top of the screen, there is an “A.REV” (Audio Reverb) control. Click on an instrument radio
button, and then set the Audio Reverb for it. The Audio Reverb varies from 0 to 127. Clicking on
the left hand side of the control allows you to enter a setting, or click on the up/down arrows.
Chapter 10: Audio Features
181
Note that this only applies to RealTracks, since MIDI tracks have MIDI Reverb, which is set via a
“REV” control.
There is also a feature that automatically adds reverb to RealTracks, according to instrument type. (No Reverb is
added to Bass for example, but most instruments get reverb.) This feature defaults to on, but you can turn it off in
RealTracks Settings or Reverb Settings dialog.
If you just want more or less added, you can adjust the “Strength %.” For example, the default adds a reverb of 40
to most tracks, but if you set the strength to 75%, then 30 will get added.
Reverb Settings
The default is a “room” type of reverb, but the reverb type is also settable and is saved with the song. To
do this, press the Audio Reverb toolbar button, and adjust the various parameters in the Reverb Settings
dialog.
You can enable/disable the audio reverb. If you disable it, this will save some CPU cycles, so this
might be advisable on an older/slower machine if you hear that the audio is clicking or not keeping up.
Click on the green Select a Preset button to open the list of presets. This list will show only the “Band-in-aBox Default Reverb” until you save some presets of your own.
182
Chapter 10: Audio Features
As you adjust the settings, they will be applied to the current song. The [Swap “Default”] button toggles between
your current settings and the default settings. This allows you to hear the effect of the changes you make to the
settings.
Use the row of “room” buttons to load typical settings for different types of spaces. These buttons are a convenient
way to either apply a particular effect or to load settings that you can then tweak to make your own preset.
Reverb Parameters
Pre-Delay is the time delay of first reflections.
Decay is the time it takes for reverb to decay. Reverb time is measured as RT60, the time it takes for reverb to
decay to a level -60 dB below the dry signal level.
LF Rolloff gradually reduces the bass frequencies. If you can’t add enough reverb because the sound gets too
muddy, try increasing the LF Rolloff slider. It is adjustable between 50 Hz and 500 Hz.
HF Rolloff is the rate at which the high frequencies die away as the reverb decays. Rooms with hard surfaces are
typically bright, but rooms with soft surfaces are usually darker. It is adjustable between 1 KHz (dark) to 11 KHz
(bright).
Density is the density of low-level echoes near the end of the reverb tail. High Density settings add a sheen to the
sound.
Level adjusts the final level of the plug-in.
Typical Reverb Settings
- A large hall might have long Pre-Delay, long Decay, and moderate Density.
- A hard large space, such as a gymnasium, might have long Pre-Delay, high Density and high HF Rolloff.
- A soft large space, such as a concert hall with carpet, padded seats, hangings, might have medium Density and
low HF Rolloff.
- A small hard space, such as a tile washroom, might have short Pre-Delay, medium-to-long Decay, high
Density, and high HF Rolloff.
- A small soft space, such as a large living room, might have short Pre-Delay, short Decay, medium-to-low
Density, and low HF Rolloff.
Saving Settings to Presets
You can save your reverb types as presets, and the current settings will also be saved with the song in a
Preferences/PGReverbSettings.bin file.
To save the current settings to a preset, type in a name for your preset in the “Preset Name” field.
Then click on the red Save a Preset arrow and choose a location in the Preset list. You can write over an
existing name.
A prompt will ask you to confirm that you want to save the preset.
Chapter 10: Audio Features
183
Select [Yes] to save the new preset to the chosen location.
Auto Reverb
Enable “Auto-Add Reverb to RealTracks” to automatically apply preset amounts of reverb to RealTracks according
to the instrument type. No reverb is added to the Bass part, for example, but most instruments get reverb.
If you just want more or less reverb added overall, you can adjust the “Strength %.” For example, the default Bandin-a-Box reverb setting is 40 for most tracks. If you set the strength to 75%, the Band-in-a-Box becomes 30.
You can save the current settings as the Default Reverb.
Click on [Restore Defaults] to go back to the original “factory” reverb settings for
Band-in-a-Box Default Reverb.
184
Chapter 10: Audio Features
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Band-in-a-Box is a favorite of musicians, students, and songwriters everywhere. They know that as well as creating
great accompaniments and arrangements, Band-in-a-Box has amazing wizards to save time and work, endless
opportunities for advancing musical skills, and, above all, it’s fun!
Want to play along on your computer’s QWERTY keyboard? That’s what The Wizard is for, and it doesn’t make
mistakes.
Got a recording to transcribe? The Audio Chord Wizard saves your time, your ears, and your patience by figuring
out the chords for you. In just a few minutes, you can be playing along with the recording by following the chords
on the screen.
Need to know the chords for a MIDI file? Just load the file with the MIDI Chord Wizard and turn it into a great
sounding Band-in-a-Box arrangement at the same time.
Band-in-a-Box knows chords. The Chord Substitution Wizard lets you choose 4-bar sections to substitute or
automatically substitutes chords for all or part of the song for you. Build and audition your own chords with the
Chord Builder and Chord Preview features.
Guitarists can view any part on the guitar fretboard in the Guitar Window, and use the Guitar Tutor to see how
different styles of guitar playing use different chords and positions.
The Animated Drum Kit is a MIDI feature that is fun to watch, and fun to play. You can play along on drums with
your computer keyboard, and record or overdub drum parts too! Use the Chord Breaks feature to take your own
instrumental breaks while brushing up on your timing too.
With these features, you might find that Band-in-a-Box becomes your best musical friend!
The Wizard
The Wizard is an intelligent play along feature that uses your QWERTY keyboard to play along with Band-in-aBox. This also allows you to record to the melody or soloist track without an external MIDI keyboard, and can even
be used to trigger the Soloist Wizard. Also, play along using the Wizard can use the harmony feature, so you can
play along live from your QWERTY keyboard in 4-part Saxophone harmony for example.
Turning the Wizard On/Off
Click on the Wz box to turn the Wizard feature On/Off, or select the Wizard Playalong option from the Song menu,
or press Option+W.
Playing the Wizard
The Wizard keys are only active during playback. The active keys are the lower 2 rows of the keyboard.
Changing Instruments / Settings For The Wizard
The Wizard is a play along instrument, so is treated just like the THRU instrument. Changing Instruments, Volume,
Reverb, etc. for the Wizard is therefore the same as for the THRU instrument. (i.e., Click on the THRU button, then
select instrument etc.) You can record the Wizard and it will use THRU harmonies if selected.
Play Regular Notes
There is now an option to play regular “non-smart” notes, for those of you up to the task of poking out actual
melodies on your QWERTY keys.
In the Song menu, toggle Wizard Uses 'Smart' Notes “Off” (unchecked) to have the Wizard provide you access to a
chromatic scale, and toggle “on” to have Band-in-a-Box provide you with notes based on the chord/key of the song.
Soloist Wizard
Additionally, you will find another great Wizard feature in the Soloist menu; the Solo Wizard. Toggling this option
“on” enables the Soloist Wizard. As you play notes on the MIDI or QWERTY keyboard, the program will play
“correct” notes in the style of the current Soloist! This means that you can play a perfect solo every time, simply by
pressing any key on your MIDI keyboard or QWERTY keys.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
185
Beyond impressing your friends with your newfound improvisational prowess, this feature has practical implications
as well. For example, you can concentrate on practicing your solo phrasing and playing “in time” without
concerning yourself with which notes to play (Band-in-a-Box will supply the correct notes: see the next section for
details.)
Recording Using the Wizard
To record the Wizard, press the [Rec] button to record, and play the Wizard. This will be recorded. You can use the
feature of recording the Wizard to enter music without a MIDI keyboard that doesn't sound as stiff as most music
entered in step time. This is how it works:
- Press [Rec] to record.
- As the song plays, play the melody that you want on any Wizard key, using the same key for each note, in the
rhythm of the melody. The Wizard notes won't be the exact melody, but don't worry about that as you record.
- When you're finished, go to the Notation window. You now have the notes with the correct durations and
times, but the wrong pitches.
- One by one drag the notes up to the correct melody note, holding down the shift, control, and key for sharps,
flats, and naturals respectively. You'll then have entered a melody that sounds like it was recorded from a
keyboard, without the stiff sound of a melody entered in step time!
Note: If you have the wizard on, the SPACEBAR won't stop playback. You need to press ESCAPE to stop playback if the Wizard is
on. This is because people mistakenly hit the spacebar while playing the wizard, which would stop the song inadvertently.
Audio Chord Wizard (“Chords from MP4”)
This amazing wizard automatically figures out the chords from any MP4, M4A, AIFF or other audio file
and displays them in Band-in-a-Box. Just load an audio file to instantly see the chords.
Launch the Audio Chord Wizard with the toolbar button or with the Windows | Run AudioChordWizard
menu command.
Audio Chord Wizard Window
The Audio Chord Wizard window shows an overview of the open wave file with the bar lines and chords as
interpreted by the wizard below. Controls and settings are found in the toolbar at the top of the window, and the
lower part of the window either shows chords and bars in a Chord Sheet view or notes in a Note Bars view.
The zoom buttons at the bottom of the screen adjust the scale of the display. The minus button shrinks
the display to show more bars, the plus sign expands the display but shows fewer bars.
186
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Primary Program Controls
Toggle Play/Pause (Space bar or multimedia Play/Pause key).
Stop play, rewind to start with Esc key or multimedia Stop key. Press the
letter W to rewind without Stop.
Set the Bar One location. The Audio Chord Wizard works best if you do
this first, before any other actions. Moves nearest bar line to current play
position. Tab key also sets bar lines.
Moves nearest bar line to current play position. Tab or F8 keys also set bar
lines.
Exit and send chords to Band-in-a-Box.
Average tempo, Control+click the tempo box for options.
Song time signature, 2/4 to 12/8 supported.
Song key signature.
Use to correct pitch of song if necessary to improve chord
recognition..
Select either the Chord Sheet view to follow along with the
chords of the song, or the Note Bars view to see the notes
interpreted by the Audio Chord Wizard in a piano-roll type
of display.
Keyboard Shortcuts
Keyboard shortcuts make it easier to navigate the song and tap in bar lines without having to work the mouse with
start/stop/scroll actions.
Play/Pause - Space Bar.
Stop – Esc.
Tap Barline- Tab key.
Jump To Song Start- W key.
Jump Forward One Bar- right arrow key.
Jump Back One Bar - left arrow key.
Jump Forward Four Bars - down arrow key.
Jump Back Four Bars - up arrow key.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
187
Chordsheet Overview
The Chordsheet window in the Audio Chord Wizard shows the chords for the whole song on a single screen. This
allows you to click on a bar on the Chordsheet to jump to that area of the song.
You can mark sections of the song using part markers, and the sections will begin on a new line with a line space
between so they are clearly seen. So you can then also learn the form of the song, as you can see the various
sections (intro/verse/chorus/break) at a glance, or quickly jump to the any section simply by double clicking on that
part of the Chordsheet.
For this discussion, open up /Band-in-a-Box/Tutorials/Frontier.m4a.
You will now see the song, and the Chordsheet window in the Audio Chord Wizard is visible.
Play the song.
Locate the start of bar 1 on the waveform and click on the [Set Bar One] button.
You may have to stop the song and start over again to pinpoint the location, but
once you do the Audio Chord Wizard can accurately mark the rest of the bar lines.
You can insert your own bar lines by clicking on this button or by pressing the
Tab key. When a new bar starts, hit the [Tap Barline] button (or Tab key). This
is called “tapping in a bar line.”
Bar lines can be tapped in as the song is playing or when it is stopped. You’ll see that if you tap a bar line near to an
existing bar line the existing line will be moved to the location of your tap.
The first time you do that, the program will consider that point to be “bar 1.” Tap in a few more bar lines.
Click on the Chordsheet, and the music will jump to that location.
Now, let’s define some sections in the song.
If a bar begins a new section, click on the bar # on the Chordsheet, or press the P key to put in a part marker.
Pressing P again will change the part marker, and then turn it off.
Now the song is divided into sections, with space between each section, and each section starting on a new line.
To change the # of bars per row, or rows per screen, right-click or Control+click on the Chordsheet.
188
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
The +/- buttons at the bottom right of the
window also change the row height.
Chords may be edited in the Audio Chord Wizard with a right mouse click or Control+click on the chord. When
Edit Chord is selected, a highlight cell opens at the chord location. Type in the name of the new chord using
standard Band-in-a-Box chord entry characters and press the Enter key to make the edit. The edited chord name is
colored blue.
Individual edits can be removed with the Remove Chord Edit command, or all edits in the song can be removed with
the Remove All Chord Edits command. Part markers, chord symbols, key signature, and tuning setting are saved in
Band-in-a-Box, and are passed back and forth to the Chord Wizard.
The Audio Chord Wizard is a great way to learn the chords of songs. You can add section markers and divide the
song logically into sections, so it is also a great way to learn the “form” of the song, an essential part of learning
popular songs.
As well as the chords of the song, the Audio Chord Wizard also figures out,
- the tempo of the file,
- bar lines throughout the song,
- fine tuning detection (e.g. 5 cents sharp from A440),
Note: Audio Chord Wizard estimates the chord progression of an audio file. It is NOT an Audio-to-MIDI transcriber, which
would be a much more elaborate program.
Note Bars
The Note Bars display is an alternative to the Chordsheet window. It shows many of the notes found in the file.
This serves as a helpful guide to transcription, and can also help to verify chord names.
The Audio Piano Roll is divided by a blue horizontal line. Notes below the blue line have been identified as the
bass part by the Audio Chord Wizard.
The note bars look like a MIDI Piano Roll, but they are not exactly the same as a MIDI Piano Roll. Audio Chord
wizard detects the strongest frequencies found in each eighth-note time slot, and displays them in the Note Bars
window.
Sometimes the displayed frequencies REALLY ARE instrument notes played in the audio file. But they could be
spurious information, such as the accidental loudest frequency of a drum beat. A midrange frequency note-bar
might be showing the sum of harmonics from several instruments, each instrument's harmonics contributing to the
strength of that frequency.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
189
The Notes Bars display information is real and useful, but try not to assume that every displayed note-bar is a real
note in the audio.
Opening Files
When the Audio Chord Wizard button is pressed, the program window will open and then launch the
Open Wave File dialog for selection of the audio file to be analyzed. There is a file named
Frontier.m4a in the /Band-in-a-Box/Tutorials folder that you can use to try out the Audio Chord
Wizard.
When you select a file to open you will see a series of Progress messages. The Audio Chord Wizard is then
launched, and more progress messages will flash on screen as the file is analyzed and imported. As well as
interpreting the chords, the program is also inserting bar lines and setting the tempo.
Chord Detection
Chord Detection accuracy depends on the accuracy of the bar lines. If bar lines are not well -aligned then the Chord
Detection can be expected to be rather poor. It is quick and easy to align the bar lines on most songs, once you get
the hang of it.
The first task is to locate the beginning of Bar One. Since an audio file could have an arbitrary amount of silence at
the beginning of the song, and many songs begin with a pickup partial bar, ACW cannot easily guess the first bar
without a hint from you.
The shortcut keys and mouse playback controls make it easy to find Bar One. Tap the space bar to begin play,
watch the Location Cursor, and listen for the downbeat. If the Location Cursor passes the downbeat and you were
not completely certain of the location, you can tap the W key to rewind to the song beginning and replay the first
part of the song, to audition the downbeat as many times as necessary to make sure of its location.
You can also single-click in the Chords panel to jump the playback position. If the rhythm is unusually complicated
near the downbeat, you could repeatedly click just a little before the suspected Bar One location, to zero-in on the
exact downbeat.
In the following example song, we have discovered the downbeat of Bar One, so we Control+click on that location
to Set Bar One.
Now the Bar One bar line is red (shown below). The red Triangle
bar indicator indicates that we have edited that bar line. The Red
Triangles are called Good Bar Lines (GBL's). The green Triangle
bar indicators are bar lines which ACW has automatically
inferred from its automatic tempo detection PLUS your edited
Good Bar Lines. We call the green automatic bar lines Inferred
Bar Lines (IBL's).
On this example song, the initial automatic tempo detection did a
pretty good job. Simply setting Bar One has caused the first four
bars to be properly aligned to the music. On some songs, Set Bar
One is the only action necessary to get good bar alignment for the
ENTIRE tune.
190
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Approaching Bar 5, the automatic tempo tracking begins to drift. The current position of the Location cursor is
where Bar 5 SHOULD be. That is easy to fix.
If you prefer real-time control, just tap Tab or the F8 key where the downbeat should actually be.
If you prefer stopped-time editing, you can either mouse-drag Bar 5 to its desired position, or drag the playback
Location cursor to the desired position and then tap Tab or the F8 key.
When we tap the Tab key, or alternatively click on the [Tap Barline] button, the Audio Chord Wizard will
automatically recalculate the bars to the right of the playback position as playback continues.
Now the Good Bar Line is drawn red to show that it was edited. The chords are now much better.
In the case of this song, setting this one bar line is sufficient to get good tracking to the end. Songs which have
drastic tempo changes, loose feel, or time signature changes could require a few more adjustments.
When satisfied with the bar lines and chords, click the [OK – Send to BIAB] button to return the chords and tempo
map to Band-in-a-Box.
Special Cases
Time Signature:
If a song is not in the default 4/4 time signature, set the Time Signature very early before you do anything else.
Bad Initial Tempo Estimates
Double/Half Tempo:
Sometimes Audio Chord Wizard will guess double or half of the tempo you might prefer.
Slightly Wrong:
Sometimes syncopated songs can have musical anticipations which make ACW guess a tempo slightly too fast or
slightly too slow.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
191
Completely, Horribly Wrong:
Some songs have rhythms difficult for a computer to understand. Sometimes a song's rhythmic beats are spaced in
such a way that a song with a perfect Tempo of 120, might mathematically BETTER fit the audio beats at some
simple (but wrong) related ratio such as 80, 100, 160, or 180 BPM.
If the initial Tempo Estimate is pretty good, the Tap Bar line function will be the easiest way to fix such errors,
requiring only a few keyboard taps during playback.
But if the initial tempo estimate happens to be horribly wrong, it helps to make the initial tempo “in the ballpark”
BEFORE you tap a few Tabs or F8's to make it completely right.
Control+click on the Average Tempo control for some easy automatic fixes.
Note: If you want to use the Avg Tempo Menu functions, use the menu very soon after you have opened a song, before you have
done much bar editing. If you invoke the Avg Tempo Menu functions after you have laboriously edited a lot of bar lines, the
automatic nature of these functions can ruin your previous editing.
In some cases, there is a good reason to initially set the tempo artificially slow by using the “Find Best Half Tempo”
function.
For example, if the initial tempo estimate is considerably faster than the tempo that you want to tap in, the Tap Bar
line function can mistakenly think that you want a very fast tempo, which fills the remainder of the song with
unwanted fast-tempo bars. In that case, if you initially set the tempo very slow, ACW will be unlikely to
misinterpret your Tap Bar Lines.
Set Key Signature
Once the chords look reasonable, for instance if your song looks like it is probably in the key of F, set the Key
Signature control to F for better chord spelling. This only affects the cosmetic display of notes and chords (flats and
sharps). The Key Signature control does not currently affect the basic accuracy of Chord Detection.
Adjust Fine-Tuning
If a song is significantly off from concert pitch, the notes are “in the cracks,” which makes chord detection less
accurate.
If your chords look reasonable, there is no need to bother with fine tuning. Most songs are recorded pretty close to
concert pitch.
But if you see numerous chord errors, it may help to adjust the Fine Tune control.
If you are playing along with a song on your keyboard, you might decide to make an ear-estimate of how far out-oftune is the song:
For instance, you could adjust the fine-tuning control on your keyboard until your keyboard matches the song's pitch
(according to your ear). Then you could look at your keyboard's tuning readout, and adjust ACW's Fine Tune
control to match. Either click-drag ACW's Fine Tune control (like a slider control), or Control+click the Fine
Tune control then type in a number.
The Fine Tune control currently does not change the pitch of playback, it only improves chord detection on mistuned songs.
The Fine Tune control is calibrated in cents, 1/100th of a semitone. Therefore, if a song is perfectly in the key of C,
but if you set Fine Tune to +100 Cents, ACW would display chords in the key of B. Similarly, if you set Fine Tune
to -100 Cents, it would display that song's chords in the key of C#.
That simple use of the Fine Tune control is just a backwards way to transpose the chords. But if you set Fine-Tune
somewhere in the middle, ACW looks for notes that are somewhere “in the cracks” between the piano keys. For
instance, if your song SHOULD be in the key of C, but it was unfortunately recorded 50 cents sharp.
There could be many reasons that a song was recorded off concert pitch. Maybe the recording studio had a broken
tape recorder. Perhaps the piano tuner was smoking crack , or the singer couldn't quite hit the highest note. Maybe
192
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
the vinyl record cutter was off-speed, or some record executive decided that the song was 10 seconds too long for
airplay, and instructed the mastering engineer to speed it up a little bit. In such cases, the Audio Chord Wizard can
get confused, mis-identifying some pitches too high and other pitches too low, detecting nonsense chords.
So if your favorite song was unfortunately recorded 50 cents sharp, you can set the Fine Tune control to +50 cents
so that ACW will properly display in the “original” key.
Auto Estimate Tuning
ACW can automatically estimate the tuning, which helps in some
cases. Since the estimation is math-intensive, ACW only analyzes
one bar of music at a time.
Control+click somewhere inside a bar and pick the Estimate Tuning
function.
After the process is finished, up pops the results dialog.
As advised in the dialog, results can be improved by carefully
picking the bar. Bars with relatively long notes are easier to analyze,
compared to bars containing flashy fast melodies.
It can be useful to spot-check a few bars. If several spot-checks give similar answers (within a few cents), you have
good confidence that the results are actually meaningful, not being randomly affected by out-of-tune melodies or
loud drums.
However, if the first estimate reads +43 and the next measurement reads -12, then it probably means that your song
is not a good candidate for automatic Tuning Estimation.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
193
Odd Length Bars and Drastic Tempo Changes
If a 4/4 song contains occasional bars of 3/4, 5/4, or whatever, or if there are sections where the music has an
extreme ritard or accelerando, sometimes you can just Tap Bar Lines to adjust it.
But it is sometimes more convenient to manually add or delete bar lines. The following example song has an overall
Time Signature of 4/4, but Bar 9 should have a time signature of 2/4. If you simply Tap Bar Line on 9:3 to shorten
the bar, then ACW will mistakenly decide that you wish to make all the following bar lines double-tempo 4/4.
Solution
First, Control+click on the beat 9:3, and Insert a bar line.
Now a new bar line is added, and three new GBL bar lines are flagged red.
Control+click on the new shortened Bar 9 and set the Time Signature to 2/4.
194
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Change Bar 10 to its desired duration. Hover the mouse over the red triangle marker at Bar 11, and the mouse
cursor becomes a drag cursor. Click and drag the bar line to the location marked 11:3.
Now we have edited bar 9 to have a 2/4 Time Signature and preserved the song tempo on both sides of the 2/4 bar.
Note Bars Display
The Note Bars display looks like a MIDI Piano Roll, but it is not exactly the same as a MIDI Piano Roll. Audio
Chord wizard detects the strongest frequencies found in each eighth-note time slot, and displays them in the Notes
Display.
Sometimes the displayed frequencies REALLY ARE instrument notes played in the audio file. But they could be
spurious information, such as the accidental loudest frequency of a drum beat. A midrange frequency note-bar
might be showing the sum of harmonics from several instruments, each instrument's harmonics contributing to the
strength of that frequency.
The Notes Display information is real and useful, but try not to assume that every displayed note-bar is a real note in
the audio.
Display Controls
Horizontal Scroll Bar
Scroll forward/back in the wave file.
Plus/Minus Zoom Buttons
Zoom the display to show more or less detail.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
195
MIDI File Chord Interpretation Wizard
Many people who play music by ear think of songs in terms of “Chords and Melody.” However many MIDI files
lack chord symbols, so they become difficult to learn without the user having to figure out the chords in a time
consuming process.
Now you can open up any MIDI file in Band-in-a-Box, and Band-in-a-Box will automatically figure out the chords
of the song for you. It automatically analyzes the MIDI file, figures out where the Bass, Piano, Melody, and other
tracks are, and then figures out the chord changes for the song. The chords are written onto the Band-in-a-Box
chordsheet like any other song. This allows you to quickly learn how to play a song from a MIDI file - just read it
into Band-in-a-Box and you'll see the chord symbols, and then learn the melody! You can also read tracks into the
Melody and Soloist tracks.
You can import the chords from a MIDI file. To do this, first blank the Chordsheet, by choosing File | New.
Then select the menu item File | Import Chords from MIDI File or press the keystrokes (Ctrl+Option+I). This
launches the Chord Wizard dialog.
Press the [Open (Change)…] button to select the MIDI file that you'd like to import. If you select the “All”
checkbox, then all files will be displayed. If you deselect the “All” checkbox, then only filenames ending with .MID
will be displayed.
Note: Any Band-in-a-Box song can quickly be converted into a MIDI file by pressing the [.MID] button, or with the keystrokes
Option+S, or from the menu File | Save Standard MIDI File. The song will be saved in the Band-in-a-Box folder with the
same file name, but the file type will be “.MID.” For example, the Band-in-a-Box song Violet.MGU becomes the MIDI file
Violet.MID.
196
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Once you've selected the file, you can press the [INTERPRET CHORDS NOW] button. When you do that, the
chords will be interpreted from the MIDI file, and written onto the Chordsheet.
Prior to pressing the button, you might want to make some custom settings.
When you load in the MIDI file, Band-in-a-Box automatically interprets many things from the MIDI file for you.
Normally you'd want this to happen, but if for some reason you'd prefer to make the settings yourself, you can set
“Auto Interpret settings from MIDI file” to false.
The settings that are determined automatically for you are:
- The key signature of the song (MIDI file). Some MIDI files contain a special event that states the key
signature of the file, but most don't. For the ones that don't, Band-in-a-Box analyzes the tracks and makes a
“best guess” at the correct key signature for the song. It usually gets it right, but if it’s wrong, it’s likely out by
a 4th or 5th interval.
- Tempo, time signature.
- The channels used for the Bass part, Piano (comping) parts.
- The channels used for the Melody parts.
- The number of bars in the song to import, including the number of lead-in bars in the song.
Once you have loaded in the MIDI file, (by pressing the [Open (Change)…] button), and assuming that you have
the “Auto Interpret” set to true, you'll see that the dialog displays the settings that the Chord Wizard has found in the
MIDI file for the key signature and channels used for the song.
Let's work with an example song called Violet Song.MID.
This should be included in your Songs folder. For this example, we're going to interpret the chords of this MIDI file
and read them into Band-in-a-Box.
Start with a blank chordsheet by choosing File | New.
Choose the MIDI file Chord Wizard dialog by choosing File | Import Chords from MIDI File.
Press the [Open (Change)…] button to select the MIDI file, and then choose
the file that you'd like to import. In this case it is called “Violet Song.MID.”
Once you load in the file, you'll notice that the Chord Wizard has analyzed the MIDI file and made these
determinations for you.
It has automatically determined that the “Violet Song.MID” file
-
-
has 2 bars of lead-in,
-
has 103 bars of chords,
-
is in the key of
F with a 4/4 time signature, and a tempo of 120.
-
The Bass part is found on channel 2.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
197
-
-
The chording (comping) parts are found on Channels 3, 6 and 7.
The Melody is found on Channel 4.
There are no other parts like the Melody that should be put on the Soloist track.
Presets for Chord Options
Now, after loading in the MIDI files, you'd normally have a look at these settings to see if they seem reasonable for
your MIDI file. If they are not, you can change the settings. For example, if you know that they key signature of
the song is not F but is C, then you would set that. Similarly, if you knew that the Melody channel was on channel
3, you could set that to override the Chord Wizard settings.
Once you’ve done that, choose one of the Presets to quickly enter the settings to the type of song that you are trying
to interpret. Preset choices are:
Jazz Standard, Jazz (Modern), Pop (with seventh chords), Pop (with no seventh chords), Rock, Pop Ballad, Solo
Piano and Solo Piano (Jazz).
198
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Presets
Chord Options
When you choose one of these presets, it automatically makes a number of settings in the Chord Options section of
the dialog, but you can override them in this dialog. These include,
Chord Resolution: (Range from 1 beat to 4 bars, default = 2 beats). This is the minimum number of beats for a
chord. For example, if you set it to 2 beats, then the Chord Wizard will never attempt to come up with different
chords that are only a beat apart.
Tip: If you have a song that has a short section that does include chords every 1-beat, you can redo that section of the song
with a 1-beat resolution.
Include Slash Chords: If set, the Chord Wizard will include “slash chords” like F7/A or Cm/G.
Bass Part Type: You can set this to “Root only,” “Root third and 5th,” or “Walking bass.” If you choose “Root
Only” the Chord Wizard will assume that any bass note is the root of the chord. Choosing “Root-3-5” will cause the
Chord Wizard to assume that the bass pattern is mainly on the root-3-5 of the chord. If you choose “Walking bass”
it will assume that the bass notes can be changing and can include many notes beside the root. Setting the “Walking
bass” line will likely result in fewer chords overall than setting the “Root only” option.
Chords Allowed: The setting for “Allow Sus” chords determines if chords like Csus or Bbsus7 will be included.
The “Allow 7th chords” specifies if 7th chords like C7 or Bbm7 would be allowed. Simple Rock songs might not
have 7th chords or SUS chords. Allowing chords with no thirds should be set in a hard rock song, or similar song
with “power chords” that might not contain the 3rd of the chords.
Bass Delay: Usually a bass player plays the root of the chord at or near the time when the chord changes. But in
solo piano playing or some bass styles, the bass doesn't state the root until later on, and this setting should be set to
“delayed” in a solo piano style of this type.
Method: You can also set the primary style of the song to Jazz or Pop using the Lead sheet Method combo box.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
199
Using the Chord Options Presets to make settings for Violet Song.MID.
For the song “Violet Song.MID,” we know that this is a Jazz Swing type of song,
so we press the preset called “Jazz Standard.”
By doing this, we see that the chord options have then been set to Chord Resolution of 2 beats, no slash chords,
walking bass, sus chords, 7th chords, and Jazz lead sheet.
These settings look OK for our Jazz song; if we wanted to customize it (for example to allow slash chords) we could
do it at this point.
So, to recap, using the Chord Wizard is a 3-step process.
We loaded in the song “Violet Song.MID.”
1.
Pressing the preset button called “Jazz Standard,” we then looked at the
Chord Options settings for the various channels and they looked OK so
2.
we didn't make any changes.
We then press the [INTERPRET CHORDS NOW] button
– this gets the Chord Wizard to interpret the chords and
3.
write them to the Chordsheet.
Once we've pressed the [INTERPRET CHORDS NOW] button, we can see the results by looking at the
Chordsheet. Here are the chords that were interpreted,
Chord Wizard results – interpreting from “Violet Song.MID.”
So that we can see how well the Chord Wizard did, we can compare it to the “correct chords” of the song, input by a
musician listening to the song. You can see these by loading in the song “Violet Song.MGU.”
200
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
The “correct chords” for the song “Violet Song.MID.”
As you can see, by comparing the two sets of chords, the Chord Wizard got almost all of the chords correct in this
example. The Chord Wizard purposely avoids chords like “C13,” it will put a simpler “C7” instead, since this is
more like a typical lead sheet.
If you've read in the entire MIDI file, you have 103 bars of chords on the Chordsheet. This actually contains 3
choruses of the song. You might want to reduce that to a single chorus, by setting the chorus end of the song to bar
36, and then erasing the excess bars (after bar 36) by choosing Edit | Erase.
Examining the song that has been interpreted by the Chord Wizard.
You'll notice that the title (Violet Song), key (F,) and tempo (120) have been set to the values found in the file. Part
markers are not set; the Chord Wizard doesn't try to guess where part markers might be occurring. You need to put
the part markers in yourself. You also need to choose the style to use (a Jazz Swing style in this case).
If you examine the Melody track by opening the Editable Notation window and option clicking on some notes, or
menu Windows | List Editor Window (Ctrl+Shift+L), you'll notice that the Melody track contains notes from
Channel 4, which is what we specified in the Chord Wizard dialog.
Importing part of a MIDI file, or redoing a section of the Chordsheet.
Normally we'd want to import an entire MIDI file worth of chords. But if you only want to import some bars, you
can deselect the “Import Complete Song” checkbox, and then specify where to start in the MIDI file (i.e. “the # of
lead-in bars in MIDI file”) and what bar to start at in Band-in-a-Box (“Insert to BB starting at bar #”) and the # of
bars to import (“How many bars to import”).
For example, using the song “Violet Song.MID,” we could redo a section of the song using different settings (for
example, a chord resolution of 1 beat instead of 2 beats). If we were unhappy with the results at bar 7 and 8, we
could redo this by making the settings as follows:
Other Settings for the Chord Wizard
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
201
Band-in-a-Box and PowerTracks Pro songs contain special events that write the exact chord names into the MIDI
file. So if the Chord Wizard sees these events, it will use them instead of interpreting the chords, since they are
likely to be completely accurate. If you'd prefer the Chord Wizard to ignore these chord events, you set the “OK to
use PG Music Chord names from MIDI file” to false.
Note: If you set this to TRUE, then the Chord Wizard won't be working – it won't be interpreting chords since it relies instead on the
chord names being present in the MIDI file.
The setting for “Write Chord Summary Notes to Soloist Track” is only used for diagnostic or special purposes. If
set, the Soloist track will contain a special track that has a chord written every 2 beats (or whatever the setting for
chord resolution is) that contains every note found for the chord. This shows you the type of logic that the Chord
Wizard was basing its decisions on. If you encounter a song that gives incorrect results for the chords, you can try
this setting, and then examine the Soloist track to see the actual notes of the chords.
You can optionally include controllers, pitch bend, and patch changes from the MIDI file.
The Reharmonist
Generate Chords for a Melody
Generate chords for a melody, or an improved chord progression for a melody, with the “Reharmonist” feature.
This feature generates a chord progression in the chosen genre, based only on the melody.
The idea of the Reharmonist is to generate a completely new chord progression for a melody, in a genre that you
choose (Jazz, Country, etc.). This ignores any existing chords in the song.
Chords for a Whole Song
This example uses the melody of Bach’s Brandenburg Concerto #1 in F, 1st movement, but you could use the
melody of any song you choose.
Press the [Re-Harm] button to open the Select Re-Harmonist dialog and
choose “Whole Song.” You could also use Windows | Auto-Generate
Chord Reharmonization.
Deselect “Show-All” and then select the “Bossa Nova (Latin)” genre.
202
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Note that the program has analyzed the melody, and decided that the key should be F (this is independent of any key
that was already set in the song).
Now press “OK – Reharmonize.”
You will then have an entire chord progression written for the song, in a Bossa Nova style.
The Chord Progression generated is different every time, so the one that you get will be different from this one.
Play the file that you have generated. Notice the “Bossa” style of chord progression, with 2-5
progressions, and other typical Bossa chords.
Revisit the Reharmonize dialog, and try generating a new chord progression, in a new Genre.
For example, “EZ listening (Pop)” will generate a Pop style chord progression, very different from the Jazz chords
in the Bossa version.
This dialog can also be opened from the menu command Windows | Auto Generate Chord Reharmonization.
Reharmonize Part of a Song
Now let’s use the Reharmonist in an “interactive mode” where it gives us choices of various chord progressions at
each bar. Let’s see if we can interactively improve on the chord progression, according to our own tastes.
The first 2 bars generated originally are:
Make sure that the currently highlighted cell is bar 1.
Now press the Re-Harm button, but this time choose “Part of Song”
and under “Set Range” enter Bar 1, Chorus 1, and the # bars as 2.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
203
Here are two of the possible variations the Re-Harmonist has suggested for the first two bars.
See a List of Possible Reharmonizations
This could also be done with the menu command Windows | Chord Reharmonist Dialog (choose your own).
In the Reharmonize melody – new chords for 2 bars of the melody dialog you can choose from a list of
reharmonizations for any 2 bar segment of the song. The reharmonization starts at the Bar # indicated. Use the [-2]
and [+2] buttons to navigate to the segment to be recompiled.
Use the feature interactively by displaying a menu of possible chord progressions for a portion of the melody, and
audition them to choose the best one using the “Bar Reharmonist.” This allows you to hear some new chord
progressions for existing melodies, or brand new progressions for tunes without chords.
Choose a chord progression, and press [Do-Reharmonize NOW] and the program will insert that progression.
The progressions are sorted in alphabetical order, or from “best to worst” depending on this setting.
Chord Breaks
Insert Breaks (silence) in arrangement, also called Chord Breaks, is found in the Preferences 2
dialog. This is a great feature for practicing tempo control.
204
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Select the # of bars, and Band-in-a-Box will play for, say 4 bars (selectable), and then will rest all instruments for
the next 4 bars. Once set, this feature works automatically with all songs until you turn it off.
During the silence, you keep playing (comping, drums, melody, etc.), trying to stay in tempo. Drummers can mute
the drum part.
When the band comes back in after the 4 bars, you’ll get instant feedback on how well you have maintained the
tempo, if the band comes in time with you or not.
Once set, this feature works automatically with all songs until you turn it off.
The Guitarist
Guitar Fretboard Window
This is a window for guitar and bass players!. The onscreen fretboard displays any Band-in-a-Box track on guitar or
bass. This Guitar window has features such as auto-setting of correct positions, notes named on screen, auto-octave
adjust to play in selected position, and sizable guitar fretboard. They are explained in detail in the Guitar Settings.
Guitar players will be able to “read-along” to a Melody/Solo simply by looking at the guitar fretboard. An easy,
intuitive, and fun way to learn guitar!
Launching the Guitar Window
To launch the Guitar Window, press the guitar button, or Ctrl+Shift+G or choose the menu item
Windows | Guitar Window.
Quick Tour of the Guitar Window
Once launched, you'll see the various areas of the Guitar window.
The top title bar states the key of the song is F, the Soloist track is displayed, and the guitar is at the 5th position.
The fretboard is displayed with the highest notes of the guitar at the top, and the open position of the guitar on the
left.
There are names for the open strings displayed on the left (E B G D A E).
There are fret positions marked at the bottom of the fretboard. You can mouse click on these positions to change
the current fret position. In the diagram above, the current position is position 5.
There are Note Names displayed. They are displayed for two positions on the guitar fretboard. One of the positions
is the scale beginning with the third of the scale on the lowest string. In the key of F, this is the 5th position
beginning on an A note (the third of the scale). Because it begins on the third of the scale, this position is referred to
as the Phrygian Position (since an A Phrygian scale is the same as an F scale). Similarly, the other popular scale is
the scale beginning on the 6th of the scale, in the key of F, this is up at the 10th position, and is called the Aeolian
Position.
There are note names displayed in color, with ellipses around the notes that are in the scale. The root note of the
scale is highlighted in red, the third and fifth of the scale are in purple, and the rest of the scale tones are circled in
gray.
Automatic Settings for Guitar Display
Band-in-a-Box does many things automatically on the guitar window, to insure that the notes are displayed
intelligently on a guitar fretboard. These include:
- Automatically setting the 2 positions that will display the note names based on the key.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
205
-
Auto-Scanning the track to be played, and adjusting the display octave on the guitar fretboard to insure that the
best octave is picked to minimize the number of notes that will be outside of the current position displayed on
the fretboard.
- After Auto-scanning the track, the best position for displaying the music on the guitar is determined. This is
always one of the 2 positions (Aeolian or Phrygian) as discussed above, though you may over-ride this by
clicking on any fret position.
- Color coding note displays. In addition to the note names being outlined in the colors (as discussed above),
when the note is played, it is highlighted in green if it is a scale note, and yellow if it is an out-of-scale note.
Guitar Window Toolbar
At the bottom of the Guitar Window is the toolbar.
These are the Guitar Settings. See below for details.
The position button toggles between the 2 popular positions displayed with note names.
When you open the Guitar window, the first thing
you'll want to do is choose the track that you want to display. Usually this will be a Melody track or a Soloist track.
In the illustration here, the Melody track is the current track, and it colored blue to indicate this.
To get to the Soloist track, click on the [S] button or use the keystrokes Ctrl+F5. Similarly, you can display other
tracks like Bass, Piano, etc.
The Guitar Settings Dialog
The Guitar Settings dialog opens with the [Settings…] button in the Guitar window. Use
these settings to control the appearance and output of the Guitar window.
206
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Note Display Options: If MIDI Thru is selected (Default=On), the Guitar will display the music played on a
MIDI keyboard. If Current Track is selected (Default=On), the current track will be displayed.
The guitar will display information on channels 11 to 16 on strings 1 to 6 if Multi-Channel Mode is set to on
(default). Channel 11 is referred to as the base channel (Default=11). You can edit notes on the notation to set the
channels of the notes. Guitar controllers will also record information in this manner, so you can record on a MIDI
guitar and see the display on the guitar fretboard.
The base channel is normally 11, but you can set it to any channel (e.g. if set for channel 5, this would mean that
channels 5 to 10 would be the guitar channels).
The Fretboard color can be brown or black. (Default=brown)
If you elect to not display note names, you can select “Use Inlays” and a Guitar inlay will be displayed along the
neck. The inlays will only display if note names are not being displayed.
If Send Notes to Notation Window (Default =On) is set, when you click on the Guitar notes (and the notation
window is open in editable notation mode or note roll mode) the note will be inserted at the current time line on the
notation window.
If you would like to have Melody and Soloist parts written specifically for guitar, set this to “Yes.” Then the notes
that are played on the six different strings will be assigned to six separate MIDI channels.
You can set the fretboard octave. For example, if the music is very low, and you need to boost the octave to
display it on the guitar, set the guitar octave to 1 or 2. There is an auto-octave setting (discussed elsewhere). If
selected, the Guitar Octave will get set automatically.
Use Index Finger position: If set, the scale will use the “index finger” to play notes that are one fret outside of the
normal position, instead of the little finger.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
207
Show out-of-range notes: If set, any note will be displayed on the guitar, regardless if it is the range of the guitar
or not.
The note names will get displayed in up to two positions, depending on the settings for Show Notes at Aeolian
Position and Show Notes at Phrygian Position (Default=True).
The Guitar can be sized using the Guitar Width and Guitar Height setting or the preset buttons that set the size.
The Auto-Switch position setting allows the program to automatically switch the display of the guitar when a new
track is loaded in. This auto-chooses the best position to display the track.
The [Set to Defaults] button sets the Guitar window to factory defaults.
Guitar Tutor
Use the “Guitar Tutor” to analyze any song. This feature will show the chords that are playing on the virtual guitar
fretboard, in your choice of a Jazz, Pop, or Folk perspective. The Guitar Tutor is a fun way to learn about new
guitar chords while playing along with your favorite Band-in-a-Box tune.
The Guitar Tutor is most useful on styles that aren't guitar styles. This would apply to styles that don't have an
exclamation point (!) in the file name. This is because the guitar styles already have a guitar part that you can learn
from, on the Guitar part.
Using the Guitar Tutor, you can see (and optionally hear) guitar chords played on the guitar fretboard. This teaches
you how to play the chords on guitar.
To turn the Guitar Tutor on, launch the Guitar window and
press the [Tutor] button.
208
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Using the Guitar Tutor
Enable the Chord Tutor display by setting that checkbox. This will silently display the chords on the guitar
fretboard. If you would also like to hear the notes, select the “Play chords through MIDI” checkbox.
The Tutor part uses the MIDI Thru part to playback on. You can control
volume, panning, etc. by using the Thru settings at the top of the main Band-ina-Box screen. You can select the patch in the Tutor dialog.
The tutor will display Jazz, Pop, and Folk voicings in easy, medium, and advanced forms. The advanced forms use
inversions, and changing patterns of chords, while the easy ones just stick to the common “campfire” chords.
One of the tutors uses 3-note Jazz voicings to simulate the famous Big Band chord guitar comping styles. If you use
this, you'll only see 3 notes in the chords of course. Since it sometimes helps to see the entire 4 chord voicing, in
this case there is the option to show the muted note as well.
Note: This applies to the Guitar Tutor. There is also the option to show this for the Guitar Styles. This option is present in the
Guitar Options Dialog.
The Guitar Tutor stays enabled until you change the Guitar track to another track (for example, to change it to the
Bass track). You can easily re-enable it by clicking on the [Tutor] button again.
Turn the tutor off by disabling the “Enable Chord Tutor Display” setting.
Chord Substitution Wizard
Reharmonizing a song with the Chord Substitution Wizard is a fun and educational way to perform or practice a
familiar song in a brand new way. This feature is very easy to use; simply highlight an area of chords and select
“Chord Substitution.” The possible chord substitutions are instantly displayed for you.
For example, if you had chords such as “Dm7 G7 Cmaj7,” a list of substitutions including the tritone substitution
“Dm7 Db7b5 Cmaj7” would be offered to you for use in your song. There are also helpful comments associated
with each substitution, showing you why a given substitution might work in each case (e.g., is the melody
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
209
compatible with the substitution, etc.). Or you can enable the “Auto-Substitution“ feature and the substitutions will
be selected according to the general preset preferences.
There are 2 ways to get chord substitutions, you can let Band-in-a-Box show you a list of possible substitutions to
pick from yourself (User | Chord Substitution Dialog), or you can let Band-in-a-Box pick them automatically (User
| Auto-Substitutions).
Chord Substitutions Dialog
The appearance of this dialog depends on what chords are present at the highlighted bar. This bar number is shown
in the dialog and may be changed. In the example above, the chord is an F7 chord, so the substitutions shown are
for an F7 chord. The substitutions shown may work for up to 4 bars, depending on the substitution. In the examples
above, the substitutions work for 2 bars.
You can control what types of substitutions to see by using the Jazz/Pop checkbox. Some substitutions include
more chords than the original, some simplify the progression, and these can be viewed using the checkboxes. You
can elect to exclude substitutions that have a chord on each beat.
The “Types of Substitutions to include” combo box will filter the substitutions to include only the best substitutions
or all of them.
The “reload” [Recompile] button is only used if you have edited the chordsub.txt file to add your own substitutions.
Once you see a substitution that you like, you can enter it onto the worksheet by pressing the [Do Substitutions now]
button, or double clicking on the substitution line. You can then move the current bar to the next part of the song
that you need a substitution for and repeat the process.
You can undo the substitution by pressing the [Restore] or [All] button.
210
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Auto-Chord Substitution Dialog
You can quickly auto-generate substitutions for an entire song or portion of a song using the auto-substitution dialog
(accessed from the User menu). For example, we can generate substitutions for the! Freddie.MGU song. Here is
the original chord progression.
By using the auto-substitution dialog, we can generate substitutions for the whole song, and we get this result:
You can see that Band-in-a-Box chose the substitutions for about 70% of the chords in the song (that's what we told
it to do in the dialog). It began by replacing the F7 chord with a Cm7 F9 progression. Some of the substitutions
chosen are more advanced than that (replacing an F7 with a B13 for example)
Here are the settings in the auto-substitution dialog that produced this result:
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
211
If you'd like Band-in-a-Box to only generate for a certain range of bars, you should first highlight that range of bars
in the Chordsheet, then launch the dialog. The Range will then be set to Part of the song and the bar # and # of bars
settings will also be set. You can override these settings with manual settings, if necessary.
Using the Chord Substitution Wizard
Load in the song !Freddie.MGU. The tune begins with an F7 chord for 8 beats. Let's make that part a little more
interesting by trying some substitutions for that chord.
- First, press Shift+Return with the highlight bar on bar 1. You'll hear the F7 chord played.
- Then choose Edit | Chord Settings (Option+Z), and the Chord Options dialog will be launched.
Notice the following buttons: Preview, Builder and Chord Subs:
The [Preview] button allows you to hear the chord, which is
similar to what we did above by pressing Shift+Return.
The [Builder…] button allows you to try different chords, and build up chords by selecting root and extension.
The [Chord Subs…] button is the one that we're interested in this time. By pressing this button you'll now see a
dialog with substitutions selected for the chord progression that begins with F7 for 2 bars.
There are a number of substitutions that have been identified. For example, the first substitution replaces the two
bars of F7 with a Cm7, F7 progression. The program has also looked at the melody of this song (which contains an
“a” note) and commented in the Memo that this “a” melody note is not compatible with the Cm7, so doesn't advise
this substitution.
212
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Choose one of the substitutions that you would like, and press the [Do Substitutions now] button (or double click on
the substitution). This will enter the substitution to the Chordsheet, and the dialog will show substitutions for that
new progression.
Press [Close] if you are happy with the substitution, or [Restore] to restore (undo) the substitution. Press [All] to
undo all of the substitutions that you have made.
Chord Builder
The Chord Builder is launched with the menu item User | Chord Builder, with the keystrokes
Ctrl+Shift+H or with the Chord Builder toolbar button.
This opens the Chord Builder dialog with a list of chord roots and their extensions.
This feature allows you to hear and build chords up by clicking on the root, extension (and alternate root if
applicable). Chords are previewed as they are built.
To enter a chord at the current bar, click on the root of the chord (in the “Root” group), the extension (Maj7 etc.),
and also an alternate “slash-note” root if desired.
For example, to make the chord F9/A, you would click on the “F” root, the “9” extension, and the Slash Root of
“/A.” As you click on them, you'll hear the bass note played on the Bass part, and the extension played on the Piano
track.
If you are happy with the sound of the chord, you can press the [Enter Chord] button. That enters to enter the
chord at the bar and beat specified. If you would like the chord to be inserted automatically when you click on the
note/extension names, select the “Enter chord when clicked” option.
Change the Bar/Beat settings to enter at a different bar.
The Chord Builder can be left open as you work entering chords into Band-in-a-Box. Remember that you can also
play chords in from the MIDI keyboard by pressing Ctrl+Enter after you've played a chord.
Animated Drum Kit
This sizable window is a cool animated 3D display of a complete drum kit, with all 61 Drum sounds displayed on
their instruments. Watch the various drum instruments being played, or play-along/record on any of the drum
instruments by using QWERTY keys or a mouse. Very educational and lots of fun!
To launch the Drum Kit window, click the Drum button, or choose the Windows | Drum Window option.
Then the Drums Kit window will display an animated display of a complete GM drum kit.
You can do several things with the Drums Window:
- Watch the Drum part being played on the Drums Window in real time.
- Play along with the drums in real time by mouse clicking on the Drum Instrument, or using QWERTY keys (the
key names to use are listed on the Drums Window).
- Record a drum part into Band-in-a-Box. To do this, simply press RECORD in Band-in-a-Box and play along.
Note: If you want to record a drum part to the Melody track, you'll have to set the Melody channel to 10 using the M | MIDI
Settings… menu item.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
213
Drum Display
All the General MIDI percussion instruments are shown.
Acoustic Bass Drum
Bass Drum 1
Side Stick
Acoustic Snare
Hand Clap
Electric Snare
Low Floor Tom
Closed Hi-Hat
High Floor Tom
Pedal Hi-Hat
Low Tom
Open Hi-Hat
Low-Mid Tom
Hi Mid Tom
Crash Cymbal 1
High Tom
Ride Cymbal 1
Chinese Cymbal
Ride Bell
Tambourine
Splash Cymbal
Cowbell
Crash Cymbal 2
Vibraslap
Ride Cymbal
Hi Bongo
Low Bongo
Mute Hi Conga
Open Hi Conga
Low Conga
High Timbale
Low Timbale
High Agogo
Low Agogo
Cabasa
Maracas
Short Whistle
Long Whistle
Short Guiro
Long Guiro
Claves
Hi Wood Block
Low Wood Block
Mute Cuica
Open Cuica
Mute Triangle
Open Triangle
Some percussion instruments are triggered by multiple MIDI notes. When controlled by more than one MIDI note,
a percussion instrument will show different behavior in response to the different notes. For instance, the Hi-Hat
responds differently to Close Hat, Pedal Hat, and Open Hat MIDI notes.
The on-screen instruments may be played by mouse-click or computer keys. When playing by mouse-click or
computer keys, the shift key adjusts velocity between two user-specified levels.
214
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Drums that you play show up in blue (the computer played drums are red). There is an option to display all the
QWERTY names on the drums at the same time, so that you can see what keys to hit without having to mouse over
the instrument. The drums can be moved off-screen without snapping back to the middle.
To display the QWERTY keys on the notes, select the option in the Drums Window Settings dialog to “Display
QWERTY Chars on Drums.”
Multi-note instruments send different notes depending on where you click on the instrument. For instance, the Kick
Drum can send three different notes, Ac. Bass Drum (MIDI note 35), Bass Drum 1 (MIDI note 36), and Square Kick
(MIDI Note 32).
The hint line at the top of the window describes the current control under the mouse cursor. Use the hint line to
learn the mouse-responsive areas of each drum instrument.
Multi-Note Drums Instruments
Kick Drum - Ac. Bass Drum, Bass Drum 1, Square Kick
Snare - Acoustic Snare, Side Stick
Hi Hat - Closed, Pedal, Open
Floor Tom - Low, High
Electronic Pad - Multi-zoned for Hi-Q, Slap, Electric Snare
High Conga - Mute, Open
Surdo - Mute, Open
Cuica - Mute, Open
Metronome - Bell, Click
Whistle - Long, Short
Triangle - Mute, Open
Guiro - Long, Short
Scratch - Push, Pull
Computer “QWERTY” Drum Keys
Numeric Keypad Drum Keys
Strike computer keys to play drums.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
215
Drums are grouped on the computer keyboard by category. The kick, snare, and hi-hat sounds are on the lowest
keyboard row. The lower-middle row contains toms and cymbals. The upper-middle row contains Latin drums, and
the top row contains Latin hand percussion.
The numeric keypad keys contain the remainder of the Latin hand percussion plus the electronic tones.
Drum Kit Main Window
The Drums main window can be resized to tile with other windows of interest.
On 256 color displays, the image does not look its best. The window looks its best if the computer is in Thousandsof-colors (16 bit) or Millions-of-Colors (24 bit) video mode.
Drum Transport Controls
Place the mouse cursor on each control to see its function.
- Record: Place Band-in-a-Box in Record mode so drum instruments can be recorded.
- Play: Start Band-in-a-Box song playback.
- Rewind: Stop and return to song start.
- Stop: Stop Band-in-a-Box playback.
- Size Buttons 1/1, 1/2, 1/4: Preset the window to full size, half size, or quarter-size. If the window has been
changed to a size different from these, by dragging a window border, none of the size buttons will be down.
Settings Dialog: Adjust program behavior.
Drum Window Settings
In the Drum window, press the [Settings] button (to the left of the Record button), to adjust the Drum Window
Settings.
Note: If your computer video is in 256-color mode, the colors in the Drums window may sometimes appear strange. To display the
drum window at its best, use Thousands-of-colors (16 bit) or millions-of-colors (24 bit) video modes.
Velocity: When playing drums with a mouse or computer keys, the shift key toggles between two levels of note
velocity. The default velocity is 90, with a default shift key velocity of 127.
The two velocity levels can be set any way desired. For instance, if you want the shift key to send quiet notes,
program the shift velocity lower than the non-shift velocity.
216
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
Randomize: Enables the Randomize checkbox to send random velocity levels when playing by mouse or computer
keyboard.
Range: Control the amount of velocity randomization. Usually a small range works best, around 10% to 30%.
If velocity is set to 127, and the random range is set to 20%, notes would randomly vary between a maximum
velocity of 127 and a minimum velocity of 102.
Instrument Hints: Customize appearance of the Hint line with Note Name, MIDI Note Number, and Computer
Key.
Display Qwerty Characters on Drums displays the QWERTY key names that play each drum in the kit.
Show:
- “Show All Instruments” shows all instruments in the drum window.
- “Show Used Instruments” displays the basic trap kit, but does not display any extra instruments unless they are
used in a song. The drum window is cleared each time Play or Stop is pressed.
Chapter 11: Wizards, Tutors, and Fun
217
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Band-in-a-Box offers users the ability to program many of its most powerful features from scratch. Those with the
interest and enthusiasm can actually create their own personalized versions of these features:
- Styles
- Harmonies
- Soloists
- Melodists
- Guitarists
Have fun!
The StyleMaker
Overview of the StyleMaker
The StyleMaker is the section of the program that allows you to create brand new styles or edit existing styles. This
is done by recording patterns for each of the Drums, Bass, Piano, Guitar, and Strings parts. If you don't want an
instrument in a style, you don't need to record any patterns for it.
The StyleMaker opens with the User menu commands Make A New Style (STYLEMAKER) or Edit Existing User
Style.
Styles with RealTracks and RealDrums
The StyleMaker has settings to assign RealDrums, RealTracks, Volume Adjustments, Timing Offset adjustments,
Long Style Name, Tempo, and Resolution. This allows you to create or edit styles to assign specific RealDrums or
RealTracks to the style.
To access this dialog, enter the StyleMaker and then press the [PATCH] button to launch the Misc.
Style Settings dialog.
218
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Using RealDrums in Styles
You can assign a RealDrums style to replace the MIDI drums in an existing Band-in-a-Box style with the
RealDrums Settings.
Enable “Style uses RealDrums” in order to designate a RealDrums style. If your style is in the correct directory, it
should appear when you press the “RD” button. You can then select your RealDrums style, and whenever the
current style is played, it will use your RealDrums style (provided that RealDrums are enabled).
Most RealDrums styles include several variations. Select “Vary ^styles with each play” to hear a different variation
each time the song is played.
There are also additional volume controls here. If you have your dB setting exactly where you want it in your style
file, but with this particular Band-in-a-Box style you want it a bit higher or lower, you can enter a setting here.
There are also fields for adjusting the ‘a’ or ‘b’ subsection volumes only.
You can also remove the check mark from either “Allow ‘a’ substyle RealDrums” or “Allow ‘b’ substyle
RealDrums,” which means that for this style, the one with the checkmark remaining will be used for the entire song,
regardless of what substyle is currently called for in the song.
There are many Band-in-a-Box styles with RealDrums. The style names begin with a minus sign.
They are listed in a separate category in the StylePicker.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
219
Using RealTracks in Styles
RealTracks can be assigned to any Band-in-a-Box instrument part in a style by using the “Assign Soloist (MIDI) or
RealTracks (audio) to style” feature.
To assign RealTracks to a style select the “Instrument” part that you want to replace with a RealTrack.
Then select the RealTracks instrument that you want for this part in the style.
Note: This list also includes soloists, the RealTracks listing begins at #361.
Styles can have multiple RealTracks. For example, you could have RealPedalSteel and RealAcousticGuitar. And
also RealDrums.
Styles with RealTracks
There are many existing Band-in-a-Box styles that have been made with RealTracks. The style names begin with an
equals sign.
RealStyles are styles that use only RealTracks and no MIDI instruments. These style names begin with an
underscore.
RealStyles and Styles with RealTracks have their own categories in the StyleMaker.
Soloists in Styles
Styles can also use MIDI soloists. For example, make a style with a banjo part that has the same quality as the
Band-in-a-Box Banjo Soloist. Here we are assigning an Earl Scruggs Bluegrass solo to the Strings part.
220
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Volume and Timing Offsets
The volume and the timing of the RealTracks or Soloist parts can be adjusted to match the rest of the style.
MIDI Styles
The simplest style consists of 1 pattern each for the instruments that you want in the style. If you like, you can use
options available to you called “masks.” Masks are options that you set for a pattern to specify when you want the
pattern to be played. There is a list of masks below.
Masks Available for Patterns
Complex styles can be made allowing patterns to be recorded that are played only at certain times. These are
referred to as masks.
Substyle masks
Substyle A or Substyle B
Chord duration masks
On chords lasting 1,2,4 or 8 beats
Bar masks
On certain bar numbers
Beat masks
On certain beat numbers
Chord masks
On certain types of chords
Roman Numeral masks
On certain Roman numerals (e.g., II chord)
Next interval masks
Only when next chord of song is certain
interval (e.g., up a fourth)
But the StyleMaker is loaded with options and features that allow your styles to grow in complexity and number of
patterns. For example, it is possible to input up to 600 patterns in a given style.
In addition, patterns can be classified by many ways allowing them to be played only at appropriate times. For
example, patterns can be given varying lengths or can be assigned to certain types of chords or only to be played on
even or odd number bars and many others. We believe that the StyleMaker satisfies both the need to create simple
styles with repetitive patterns and the ability to create complex styles intelligently.
To create a style you will be creating Bass / Piano / Guitar / Strings patterns (in the key of C) and Drum patterns.
Once made, the styles are saved to disk and are then ready to be used by the program for playing any song in the
selected “User style.” Styles end up as files with a .STY extension, different from song files, which have a .SG? or
an .MG? extension.
The StyleMaker has been designed to be as flexible as possible. A simple style would consist of three patterns (one
each for bass, drums, and piano) but more complex styles are created by using more patterns.
The styles consist of two substyles, “a” and “b.” Typically, the “a” sub-style would be the more “laid -back” portion
of the style such as a verse or, in the case of a Jazz Swing style, a two-beat part. The “b” substyle would be a chorus
section (bridge) or “Swing” part in reference to a typical Jazz Swing style.
On the StyleMaker page, you'll see rows of dots that line up with their respective instruments / substyle / length in
beats / etc. These are locations for your patterns that you'll be recording. In order to create a Style, you'll need a
MIDI instrument of some sort (keyboard, MIDI guitar, drum controllers) with a MIDI Out port. Styles are made by
entering Drum, Bass, and/or Piano patterns in the desired style.
Drum patterns:
- Are entered in step time, Tap mode, and Real Time from a typical drum programming screen (grid).
- Are always entered as 1-bar patterns (longer patterns may be chained together using BAR MASKS – described
below).
The drum patterns are entered from the drum screen in 4 sections (these 4 sections appear when you click on the
drum button).
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
221
A patterns
B patterns
Fills
Endings
This row is for 1 bar drum patterns for the “a” substyle.
This row is for 1 bar drum patterns for the “b” substyle.
This row is for 1 bar drum patterns for the “a” substyle.
This row is for endings. Endings are 2 bars (2 patterns of 1 bar each). If you‘ve made a style and
haven’t included an ending, a 2-bar “auto-ending” can be generated automatically, based on the style.
Tip: If you are making a simple style, you only need to use the top row (“a” patterns).
Bass / Piano / Guitar / Strings patterns:
- Are played in real time from a MIDI keyboard, MIDI guitar, etc. by clicking on [Rec] or typing “r” with the
cursor placed on the first dot of the A or B section of the desired instrument starting with 8 Beat.
- Are played in based on a C7 chord (C E G Bb) though all 12 notes may be used.
The patterns for Bass/Piano/Guitar/Strings are classified by the length of the pattern, i.e., the number of notes that
the chord lasts without a change of chord.
Click on the Piano/Guitar/Strings buttons to toggle between each instrument’s A/B
recording sections. You get to the instrument screen by mouse clicking on the
instrument name button.
For example, click on the Bass button and you will see similar to the following:
The important rows are indicated with an asterisk *, meaning that if you are making a simple style you'll only have
to use these rows. The “a” and “b” refer to the “a” and “b” substyles found in Band-in-a-Box. The numbers 1, 2, 4,
8 refer to the length of the recorded patterns in terms of number of beats. For example, a 2 bar pattern would be = 8
beats.
Explanation of the numbers on the StyleMaker screen.
The StyleMaker screen is full of patterns, mostly empty indicated by a period (.). When a pattern has been recorded, there is a
number in place of the period for example (5). These numbers indicate whether a pattern has been recorded at the location.
A period indicates no pattern and a number from 1 - 9 indicates that a pattern has been recorded with the actual value
corresponding to the desired weight the pattern is to be given relative to other similar patterns. Patterns that you don't want to
hear very often in the style are given low weights. Usually you will use weights in the range of 0 - 8 where
0 = no pattern recorded
1 -– 8 = pattern recorded
9 = special weight that is really given a much higher weight internally by the program. A pattern with a weight of 9 will always
be played (if not masked out by other options).
“a” and “b” refer to the 2 substyles available in the Band-in-a-Box program.
Explanation of the pattern lengths 8, 4, 2, and 1 beat.
You may ask, “Why would I need to have different pattern lengths in a style?” Whenever Band-in-a-Box
encounters a chord change in a song it will begin to playback a new pattern, starting at the beginning of the pattern.
222
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
It firsts scans the chord to see how long that chord is going to last without a chord change. For example, let's look at
these chords:
| 1a Dm7
| 2 G7 C6 | 3 FMAJ7 | 4 (These chords are in substyle “a.”)
When Band-in-a-Box is playing back your style, it starts by looking at the Dm7 chord, and counts that it lasts four
beats before the next chord change to a G7 chord. It then looks to the style that you have created and sees if you
have any patterns created in the A 4 beat line – if so, you will get an appropriate pattern that you have recorded for
chords lasting four beats.
Note: If you don't want to classify patterns according to this method (don't worry), you can just record all of your patterns on the A 8
beat line. When Band-in-a-Box sees that you haven't any 4 beat patterns it will choose an eight beat pattern and then only use the
first four beats of it.
Then when Band-in-a-Box encounters the G7 chord, it sees that it lasts two notes before the next chord change. So
Band-in-a-Box will look for any A 2 beat patterns. There is tremendous advantage to being able to record different
length patterns. Eight beat patterns might be blank for the first four beats for example; a situation that could not
apply for four beat patterns or the entire pattern would be blank!
Here is another example of chords with the durations of the chords displayed for you underneath:
4 bar e.g.
|F
| Bb
C7
| F6
|
|
chord duration 4
2
2
8
Patterns may be entered for chord durations of 1, 2, 4, and 8 notes. The Band-in-a-Box program sorts out everything
else about determining the length of the chord durations in the song and combining lengths for unusual lengths (3 =
2+ 1 etc.).
So now we know what the rows are for: they are for patterns of different lengths and different substyles (A and B).
The columns across the screen are used to contain multiple variations of similar sounding patterns. The program
will randomly pick between the similar patterns on playback. The number that is recorded and displayed on the
screen refers to the weight assigned to that pattern. Normally if you have three similar patterns with equal weight
they will be picked equally, but if you assign lower or higher weights in the range 0 - 8, you can fine tune how often
patterns are played.
Note: Normally weights are in the range 0 - 8. A weight of 9 may also be assigned when you have a pattern that only occurs under
certain conditions, but you want to ensure that whenever that condition occurs that the pattern will always be picked.
The Bass and Piano / Guitar / Strings patterns are always recorded in two bar chunks regardless of the chord
duration. If a shorter chord duration is entered, the remainder of the pattern is ignored. Patterns are also entered for
the A and B substyles.
Drum patterns are not of variable duration like the Bass and Piano patterns. The Drum patterns are always one bar
long. Longer patterns than one bar may be chained together using bar masks (see below). When you record a new
pattern (Bass / Piano or Drums), a dialog box will be displayed with several options, all set to defaults of 0. If you
are making a simple style, or if you don't understand all the options, just leave them at their default settings. When
you record a pattern with all the default settings, it is called a generic pattern. Generic patterns may be picked at any
time by the program.
Playback of patterns in the StyleMaker is done from the StyleMaker screen:
button plays pattern back exactly as played.
button plays pattern back as Band-in-a-Box would, e.g., on a specific chord set by the user from a
menu.
Stopping Playback:
Clicking the mouse button or pressing the < Spacebar > stops playback of the pattern.
Erasing Patterns:
Patterns are erased by assigning a weight of zero to the pattern. Type a 0 at the pattern.
NOTE: All user styles are entered in 4/4 time.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
223
The Band-in-a-Box Program is capable of playing back in any time signature (via the Bar Settings option on the Edit
Menu or Option+B) so user defined waltz styles would be made as 4/4 but played as 3/4.
Editing Existing Styles
The easiest way to become familiar with the StyleMaker is to start with an existing style and modify it. In this
tutorial, we will describe several ways to edit an existing style. These include:
- changing patches saved with style
- adding/editing drum patterns to a style
- copying and pasting drum patterns
- recording additional bass patterns
- adding strings to a style by importing strings from another style
Let's edit the Light Rock Style, which is called ZZLITROK.STY.
1. To select a style for editing from the main screen:
Mouse click over top of the style on the Title window. This area on the main screen indicates the style that is
currently in memory. If you want to edit the current style, (in this example it is ZZLITROK.STY) then choose
either User | Edit Existing User Style or press Option + Y.
If you want to edit a different style then load a different style from the StylePicker, or by selecting the Load Style
From Disk… option on the User menu, or press +u, or select a style from the Style menu.
2. The StyleMaker window is then opened and you will see the display of the style prepared for editing.
The StyleMaker shows you patterns that have been recorded for Drums and Bass constantly. If you would like to
see the patterns recorded for Piano, Guitar, or Strings, then select the appropriate instrument button to view them.
The currently selected instrument for Piano/Bass/Strings is indicated by the
highlighted instrument button. In the diagram, you'll notice that the Piano is the
current instrument. Clicking the mouse on a different instrument button will change
the instruments.
The StyleMaker begins by displaying the Drums and Bass. Let's have a closer look at the Drums.
The ZZLITROK.STY Drums screen will look similar to this:
You will notice that there are 4 rows of drum patterns:
A Pattern is the row to record drum patterns for the “a” substyle.
B pattern is the row to record for the “b” substyle.
Fills are recorded on the Fills row.
Endings are recorded on the Endings row. (2 consecutive patterns of 1 bar.) If you‘ve made a style, and haven’t
included an ending, a 2-bar ending based on the style can be generated automatically, based on the style.
Let's have a closer look at the A Pattern row.
Each of the numbers represents a drum pattern that has been already
recorded. There are 8 patterns that have been recorded on this line. The
numbers themselves are called weights. The weights can be from 1 to 8 (a weight of 9 is a special case explained
below). Most of the patterns have weights of 5, which is the default. Assigning a higher or lower weight will cause
224
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
that pattern to be played more or less often relative to the other patterns. The 2 patterns with a weight of 2 will be
played less often than the patterns with weights of 5.
Use of a weight of 9 on one of the patterns is a special case. Patterns with a weight of 9 will always be played
instead of any other patterns on the same row. These patterns usually have other options associated with them to
ensure they are played under certain circumstances only. For example the pattern on this row has an option set of
“Bar Mask = post fill” which means it will be the bar after a drum fill. In this case, the pattern has a Crash cymbal
on beat 1. This pattern will always be played when the song is at the first bar of a new part (which is the bar after a
drum fill).
You can examine the options for any pattern by selecting the pattern by mouse clicking on it, and then
clicking on the [EDIT] button. Move around the screen to different patterns by either using the cursor
keys or mouse clicking on the desired pattern.
Let's examine the Drum pattern by pressing the [REC] button. This opens the Drum Editor window.
This screen allows you to create or Edit drum patterns in step time.
There are 16 columns, representing 1 bar of 16th notes. The numbers on this screen represent velocities from 0 to
127. Using the bottom row of the computer keyboard i.e. the XCVBNM,. / keys is the fastest way to put in
commonly used velocities, or by selecting the various commonly used velocity buttons at the bottom right of the
Drum Pattern Entry screen. You can also just type in the number that you want. Try typing in some new drum
notes. Press the [PLAY] button to audition them.
Let's create a new drum fill.
- Move to an empty location on the “Fills” line.
- Press [REC] to open the Drum Pattern Entry screen.
- Type a drum pattern in the drum grid.
- Save the pattern by pressing [EXIT] to exit the Drum Editor.
- Accept the generic settings in the Drum Pattern Recorded dialog box.
You will see your new pattern on the Fills line as represented by a weight number.
Let's use COPY/PASTE to simplify creating a new drum pattern.
- To make another fill, move to an existing fill.
- Choose the [COPY] button to copy that drum fill to the clipboard.
- Move to an empty pattern.
- Choose the [PASTE] button to paste in the previous drum fill.
- Now press [REC] to launch the Drum Pattern Entry screen and step edit the drum fill. You will only need to
change a few notes of the fill to make a variation of the one you have copied.
Save the style by pressing the [SAVE] button. Save allows you to rename the style so you don't affect the original
ZZLITROK.STY.
Change the Patches that are assigned to the Style.
Each style can have patches assigned to it. For example if you want the style's Piano part to use a Rhodes piano,
you can select the piano patch of 5, which is the General MIDI number for the Rhodes Electric Piano.
- Press the PATCH button.
- This displays the Misc. Style Settings dialog box.
- Select the [Set Patches...] button.
- You will then see a dialog box allowing you to type in patches you would like for the style. If you don't need a
specific patch, use 0 for no change of patch number.
Let's add Strings to the Style.
There are 2 ways to do this.
1. You could move to the strings part (by clicking on the strings button) and then record the strings patterns.
- or -
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
225
2.
The easiest way is to import strings from another style that already has strings. This allows you to use existing
string patterns. For example, the Miami Pop style has a nice strings part.
Let's import the “Miami Pop” strings into our style.
- Choose the [LOAD] button.
- Select the ZZMIAMI.STY style from the file dialog.
- Select the [Strings] button to display the String patterns for this style.
- Select an 8-beat String pattern to copy and press the [COPY] button.
- Choose the [LOAD] button.
- Select the ZZLITROK.STY style.
- Press the OPEN button to open this style.
- Choose an empty 8-beat “b” String pattern (because that is where the String pattern was recorded in) and press
the [PASTE] button.
- Press the [SAVE] button to save the Lite Rock style with Strings.
The strings will play in the “b” substyle only, because that's how they were made in the Miami Pop style.
You could now import the Guitar from the ZZCONTRY.STY for example, using the steps above. It is quite easy
to quickly add instruments to styles by importing instruments from other styles.
Let's Record some new bass patterns.
Note: If you are not able to play patterns in real time (“live”), then you shouldn't record these Bass, Piano, Guitar, or Strings
patterns. You cannot enter them in step time.
Only Drum patterns can be entered in step time. If you can't enter them in real time, import an instrument from existing styles as
described above.
Recording a Bass Pattern
Move the highlighted cell to an unused Bass pattern. If you're recording a pattern lasting 8 beats, record this on the
top line “A 8 beat.” This pattern will be used when the song has chords lasting 8 beats or more without a chord
change.
Press the [REC] button to record the bass pattern. You will need to wait during a 2 bar lead-in. Then you record the
2 bar pattern.
Play the pattern on a C7 chord. You can use all 12 notes; just play a pattern that you would have normally played in
the song if the song were on a C7 chord (C E G Bb). When you're finished recording the pattern, you'll see a dialog
box listing all of the options available. Just accept all of the defaults by pressing the [OK] button.
Press the [SAVE] button to save your new style.
Press the [EXIT] button to close the StyleMaker window and exit. Make sure that you have saved the style first,
otherwise edits will be lost.
Creating New Styles
Making Drum Patterns
There are 2 screens in the StyleMaker associated with making drum patterns.
1. The StyleMaker screen with drum patterns.
2. The Drum Pattern Editor, allowing step editing of patterns.
1. The StyleMaker screen with drum patterns looks like this:
The screen will look like this. The solid box indicates the currently selected pattern. Empty patterns are indicated
by a (.), i.e., patterns that have not been recorded yet. If a pattern has been recorded there will be a number in place
of the (.) indicating the weight of the pattern.
The 4 rows are for the different types of patterns, “a” substyle, “b” substyle, Fills and 2 bar Endings.
226
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Drum Pattern Entry
Drum Pattern Entry screen is where the Drum patterns are made
To enter the Drum Editor: With the highlight bar on a pattern on the drum area of the StyleMaker screen press the
REC button to record the pattern in Step Time.
You'll now be in the Drum Pattern Entry screen. There are 16 rows across, indicating 4 beats with 4 divisions per
beat.
Changing Timebase of Drum Pattern
Change the time base to 12 by clicking the mouse on the [Timebase] button. This allows for drum patterns in 3/4
time. The program will ignore the 4th column of each beat. [Timebase 12] will then be displayed in the timebase
button.
Moving around the Drum Editor Screen
Move around the screen with cursor keys, or mouse click. The black flashing highlight bar indicates where you are.
The different drum instruments are named along the left side and the 4 beats are displayed along the top.
Tempo Changes
Tempo changes are done using the [TEMPO] button or press the [ and ] keys from the main
Stylemaker screen.
Entering notes onto the drum editor screen.
A typical pattern may look like this:
This pattern is in a time base of 12, you see 4 beats with 4 divisions per beat.
(In a Timebase =12, only the first three divisions of each beat are accessible.)
The numbers are velocities. Move around the Drum Pattern screen and type in the numbers as above. These are
velocities and should range between 0 and 127. The fastest way to put the numbers onto the screen is to use the hot
keys on the bottom row of the typewriter keyboard - XCVBNM,. or the velocity buttons, 0, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100,
110, 120 and 127 at the bottom right of the Drum Pattern Entry screen.
Using Alternate Drum Notes
What are alternate notes? Alternate notes can be entered for any note. This tells Band-in-a-Box to randomly choose
a different note to the one specified. For example:
- you might want a note to be a closed high hat 80% of the time, and an open high hat 20% of the time.
- you might want a note to be high conga 60% and low conga 40% of the time, or
- high tom 30% of the time and NO note the other 70%.
This allows one drum pattern to sound like many, because it will be played different ways depending on which of
the notes are picked.
How to put in an alternate note:
From the Drum Pattern Entry screen, press the [EDIT] button. This displays the Alternate Drum
Notes dialog box.
Select the Alternate Drum Note type, such as Open High Hat or Bass Drum, from the Alternate Note
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
227
drop down menu. When you exit the box,
you will see that the box has a border
indicating that an alternate note is located
there.
Playing the Drum Patterns
Play the drum pattern by pressing the [PLAY] button.
Stop playback by pressing the [STOP] button or the < Spacebar >.
Press the [PLAY] button again to hear the pattern again if you have made changes.
When the pattern is sounding like you want, press the [EXIT] button.
Drum Pattern Options
Relative Weight (USUAL SETTING =5)
Relative Weight is the number that you assign to the pattern from 1 - 9. Numbers from 1-8 indicate how often you
want the pattern to be played in relation to the other patterns on the same row.
A weight of 9 is a special setting that ensures that the pattern will ALWAYS be played. Patterns assigned a weight
of 9 usually have other options set which instruct the pattern to only be played at certain times (bar after a drum fill
for example).
Playback Bar Mask (USUAL SETTING =0)
Playback Bar Mask determines on what bars of the song the pattern will play.
The bar numbers are counted relative to the last part marker. Bar 1 is the first bar after a part marker for example.
Bar mask setting of 0 is the default. This lets the pattern be played at any time.
Other bar mask settings:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
228
pattern played at odd number bars only 1, 3, 5, 7, 9...
pattern played at even bars only 2, 4, 6, 8, 10...
pattern played on 3rd of 4 bar (3, 7, 11, 15..)
pattern played on 4th of 4 (4, 8, 12, 16, 20...)
pattern played on 5th of 8 (5, 13, 21...)
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
pattern played on 6th of 8 (6, 14, 22...)
pattern played on 7th of 8 (7, 15, 23...)
pattern played on 8th of 8 (8, 16, 24...)
PRE-FILL special value - refers to the bar before a fill
FILL refers to the bar of a fill (not applicable to drums because there is a special row for drum fills).
POST-FILL refers to the bar after a fill (same as the first bar after a part marker).
Drum Fill on Substyle (USUAL SETTING = Any)
This setting is only relevant on the Drum Fills line. It lets you specify if you want the drum fill to be used on the “a”
substyle, the “b” substyle, or either. The default setting is Any.
Late Triplets (USUAL SETTING =usual setting = 0)
This is only relevant in drum patterns with time base =12 (triplet feel). If you want the 3rd triplet to be played late
(as is usually done in slow jazz style), then set a number from 0 - 11. Default is 0 (not late at all). A typical setting
for a slow triplet style is triplets late =5 (the units are 120/beat).
Now let’s make the ending drum pattern.
Endings are 2 bars long. In the case of the drums, this is done by 2 consecutive 1 bar patterns on the ending row.
Move to the Endings row. Input a 1 bar pattern in the first column and then another 1 bar pattern in the 2nd. These
2 patterns are the ending patterns so you should make the 2nd pattern an ending drum pattern typically with a crash
cymbal on beat 3 for example.
“Auto Endings”
If you‘ve made a style, and haven’t included an ending, a 2-bar ending can be generated automatically, based on the
style.
Making Bass Patterns
Bass patterns are recorded live from a MIDI keyboard. If you can't play in real time, or if you don't have a MIDI
keyboard you'll have to import these instruments from other styles (as we will be doing with the strings).
The Bass Screen
If you're making a simple bass pattern you'll only need to record pattern(s) on the A 8 beat row (the top row).
These patterns will be chosen for every chord, regardless of the length. But if you want the style to play different
patterns when the song is encountering chords that last 1, 2, 3, or 4 notes, you should record separate patterns on
these rows.
Recording a Bass Pattern
Move to the top row of the bass area, in column 1. Press the [REC] button. This will begin the recording of the
bass pattern. You will hear a 2 bar lead-in and then you record a 2 bar bass pattern. For your bass pattern, you will
play a pattern based on a C7 chord. You can use all 12 notes, but should just play the pattern as you would if the
chord was a C7. You should center the bass patterns around MIDI note 48 (C3).
Tip: If you are uncertain what to play, edit another style that comes with the program by pressing the [LOAD] button and selecting
another style - you can then play the bass patterns by pressing the [PLAY] button to see what patterns we used to make it, and
imitate them in your style.
After you have recorded the bass pattern, a dialog box with options will appear. This allows you to specify the
conditions that must occur for this pattern to be played back in the song. These are called masks. Usually you can
just accept all the defaults, which allow the pattern to be played at any time.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
229
Bass Pattern Options
Relative Weight Usual Setting = 5
Set this number higher/lower if you want the pattern to be played more/less often than the other patterns on the same
row. This number is also displayed on the main StyleMaker screen.
A setting of 9 (always) is a special setting that instructs the pattern to always be played instead of the other patterns
on the same row. These patterns always have other options set which specify the times that this pattern would be
eligible to be played.
Playback Bar Mask Usual Setting = 0
Playback Bar Mask determines on what bars of the song the pattern will play. The bar numbers are counted relative
to the last part marker, and range from 1-8. Bar 1 is the first bar after a part marker for example. Other bar mask
settings:
1. pattern played at odd number bars only 1, 3, 5, 7, 9...
2. pattern played at even bars only 2, 4, 6, 8, 10...
3. pattern played on 3rd of 4 bar (3, 7, 11, 15...)
4. pattern played on 4th of 4 (4, 8, 12, 16, 20...)
5. pattern played on 5th of 8 (5, 13, 21...)
6. pattern played on 6th of 8 (6, 14, 22...)
7. pattern played on 7th of 8 (7, 15, 23...)
8. pattern played on 8th of 8 (8, 16, 24...)
Special bar masks
1. PRE-FILL special value - refers to the bar before a fill.
2. FILL refers to the bar of a fill (this allows you to put in “bass fills” for example).
3. POST-FILL refers to the bar after a fill (same as the first bar after a part marker).
230
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Playback Beat Mask Usual Setting = 0
Set the beat mask to a beat from 1-4, if you want the pattern to only be played on certain beat numbers. 1= Beat 1,
2= Beat 2, 3= Beat 3, 4= Beat 4.
Roman Numeral Mask Usual Setting = 0
If you have a pattern that should only be played on the I chord or the IV chord (of the key), you can use these
Roman Numeral Masks. This setting is rarely used.
Chord Type Usual Setting = Any Chord
This setting is very useful. This allows you to record patterns that will only work on certain types of chords. For
example, you can record a specific riff that will only work on a minor 7th chord. You then play the pattern on a
Cmin 7 (not a C7). There are chord types for most types of chords.
Interval - Next Chord Usual Setting = Any Interval
This setting allows you to restrict the pattern to be played only if the next chord is a certain interval away. For
example, you can record a bass pattern that is walking up a fourth and then assign an Interval of Up 4th so that the
pattern would only be played if you're going up a 4th.
Half Octave Range Usual Setting = Full Octave
This is a new setting in the StyleMaker. Usually a pattern will be picked on any of the 12 roots. You can select a
smaller range, either A to D, or Eb to Ab. In this case, the pattern would only be picked if the chord in the song is in
that range.
Play Pushed - how often % Usual Setting = 0 %
#ticks to push pattern Usual Setting = 0
Pushed patterns are patterns that are played before the chord begins. Jazz styles typically use pushed patterns for the
piano. Patterns are recorded in the normal way (non -pushed) and then you assign the % of time and amount (in
ticks, 120 ticks = 1 beat) to push the pattern. The pattern only plays pushed in the song (not in the StyleMaker).
Ok To Use Macro Notes (Bass) Usual Setting = No
Bass Macros are special notes that you record. When they are played back they are replaced by a function,
List of Bass Macro Notes
-
-
Note number 72 (C): Pop Walking Note(s).
On playback, the note number 72 will be replaced by intelligent notes walking in a Pop/Country mode to the next chord.
Maximum 4 walking notes per pattern.
Note number 76 (E): Note a semitone below Root of Next Chord.
Note number 77 (F): Root Of Next Chord.
Note number 78 (F#): Note a semitone ABOVE Root of Next Chord.
Note number 79 (G): Best Fifth (a Fifth above or below the Root depending on how high the root is. Also stays on the root
if in a slash chord (C7 /E).
Remember to get Bass Macros Working you must:
Hit the right note number (you may be out by an octave).
Check the “OK To Use Macro Notes” box.
Playback the pattern with the [CHORD] button. (The [PLAY] button gives you an “as played” playback with the strange
sounding high macro notes.)
Making Piano, Guitar, and Strings Patterns
Piano, Guitar and Strings are all considered together because they have all the same options available. They, like
the Bass patterns, are recorded live from a MIDI keyboard. If you can't play in real time, or if you don't have a
MIDI keyboard, you'll have to import these instruments from other styles (as we'll be doing with the Strings).
In this section we will refer to Piano patterns, but this information applies equally well to Guitar and Strings
patterns.
Moving to the Piano Pattern Screen
Move to the Piano area by mouse clicking on the [Piano] button.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
231
If you're making a simple piano pattern you'll only need to record pattern(s) on the A 8 beat row (the top row).
These patterns will get chosen for every
chord, regardless of the length. But if you want the style to play different patterns when the song is encountering
chords that last 1, 2, 3, or 4 beats, you should record separate patterns on these rows.
Recording Piano Patterns
Move to the top row of the piano area, in column 1. Press the [REC] button. This will begin the recording of the
piano pattern. You will hear a 2 bar lead-in, and then you record a 2 bar piano pattern. For your piano pattern, you
will play a pattern based on a C7 chord. You can use all 12 notes, but should just play the pattern as you would if
the chord was a C7.
Tip: If you are uncertain what to play, press the LOAD button and edit another style that comes with the program - you can then
play the piano patterns by the pressing the PLAY button to see what patterns we used to make it, and imitate them in your style.
After you have recorded the piano pattern, a dialog box with options will appear. This allows you to specify the
conditions that must occur for this pattern to be played back in the song. These are called masks. Usually you can
just accept all the defaults, which allow the pattern to be played at any time.
Playback Weight (Usual Setting = 5)
Set this number higher/lower if you want the pattern to be played more/less often than the other patterns on the same
row. This number is also displayed on the main StyleMaker screen.
A setting of 9 (always) is a special setting that instructs the pattern to always be played instead of the other patterns
on the same row. These patterns always have other options set which specify the times that this pattern would be
eligible to be played.
Playback Bar Mask (Usual Setting =usual setting = 0)
Playback Bar Mask determines on what bars of the song the pattern will play. The bar numbers are counted relative
to the last part marker, and range from 1-8. Bar 1 is the first bar after a part marker for example.
Other bar mask settings:
1.
2.
232
pattern played at odd number bars only 1, 3, 5, 7, 9,...
pattern played at even bars only 2, 4, 6, 8, 10...
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
3. pattern played on 3rd of 4 bar (3, 7, 11, 15..)
4. pattern played on 4th of 4 (4, 8, 12, 16, 20...)
5. pattern played on 5th of 8 (5, 13, 21...)
6. pattern played on 6th of 8 (6, 14, 22...)
7. pattern played on 7th of 8 (7, 15, 23...)
8. pattern played on 8th of 8 (8, 16, 24...)
Special bar masks:
1. PRE-FILL special value - refers to the bar before a fill.
2.
FILL refers to the bar of a fill (this allows you to put in “piano fills” for example.)).
3.
POST-FILL refers to the bar after a fill (same as the first bar after a part marker).
Playback Beat Mask (Usual Setting=usual setting = 0)
Set the beat mask to a beat from 1-4, if you want the pattern to only be played on certain beat numbers. 1= Beat 1,
2= Beat 2, 3= Beat 3, 4= Beat 4.
Roman Numerals (Usual Setting usual setting = 0 )
If you have a pattern that should only be played on the I chord or the IV chord (of the key), you can use these
Roman Numeral Masks. This setting is rarely used.
Chord Type (Usual Setting usual setting = Any Chord)
This setting is very useful. This allows you to record patterns that will only work on certain types of chords. For
example, you can record a specific riff that will only work on a minor 7th chord. You then play the pattern on a
Cmin 7 (not a C7). There are chord types for most types of chords.
Half Octave Range (Usual Setting = Full Octave)
This is a new setting in the StyleMaker. Usually a pattern will be picked on any of the 12 roots. You can select a
smaller range, either A to D, or Eb to Ab. In this case, the pattern would only be picked if the chord in the song is in
that range.
Interval - Chord Usual Setting(usual setting = Any Interval)
This setting allows you to restrict the pattern to be played only if the next chord is a certain interval away. For
example, you can record a bass pattern that is walking up a fourth and then assign an interval of Up 4th so that the
pattern would only be played if you're going up a 4th.
Play Pattern Pushed - how often % Usual Setting(usual setting = 0 %)
# ticks to push pattern (120 ppq) Usual Setting(usual setting = 0)
Pushed patterns are patterns that are played before the chord begins. Jazz styles typically are pushed patterns for the
piano. Patterns are recorded in the normal way (non -pushed) and then you assign the % of time and amount (in
ticks, 120 ticks = 1 beat) to push the pattern. Pushed patterns only play pushed in the song, not in the StyleMaker.
Use Macro Notes Usual Setting(usual setting = No)
Piano Macros are special notes that you record. When they are played back they are replaced by a function, as listed
below:
List of Piano Macro Notes (same as Guitar/String macro notes)
MIDI Note number 83 B
Pop Chord Diatonic Below
MIDI Note number 84 C
Pop Chord
MIDI Note number 85 C#
Pop Chord Diatonic Above
MIDI Note number 88 E
Jazz Chord Chromatic Below
MIDI Note number 89 F
Jazz Chord
MIDI Note number 90 F#
Jazz Chord Chromatic Above
Remember to get Macro Notes Working you must:
Hit the right note number (you may be out by an octave).
Check the “Use Macro Notes” box.
-
Playback the pattern by pressing the [CHORD] button. (Pressing the [PLAY] button gives you an “as played” playback
with the strange sounding high macro notes.)
Transpose Root Pattern Usual Setting(usual setting = No)
This is a rarely used setting. It only is relevant when voice leading is set to smooth (see below). It determines
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
233
where the center of the pattern is considered to be. If checked, the center of the pattern will be moved to the song's
key.
Embellish Pattern Usual Setting (usual setting = No)
If checked, the pattern will be embellished. This is useful in Jazz styles.
Transpose Down Limit (usual setting = Usual Setting = 6)
This setting is quite useful. It controls the range that the pattern will be played over. For example, if the transpose
down range is set to = 2 the pattern (recorded in C) will be transposed a maximum of 2 semitones down, and
therefore up to 10 semitones up to play all 12 possible roots of the chords.
Type Of Voice Leading Usual Setting(usual setting = Transpose Only)
Transpose Only = C7 chord based
Smooth voice leading
Riff based
The easiest type of voice leading is transpose only. If the notes C E G Bb were played as a C7 pattern, the Band-in-a-Box would
transpose that voicing to a F7 chord as F-A-C-Eb, which is fine but not very smooth. A more pleasant setting would be smooth
voice leading then the F7 would be voiced automatically as C-Eb-F-A.
Riff based voicing is used when you have recorded a pattern with a melodic riff in it. This setting ensures that
Band-in-a-Box will not try to transform any of the notes into chord tones.
Chord Selection Dialog Box
This section is accessed by the [CHORD] button. This plays back a pattern on a specific chord that you choose.
You can hear what patterns will sound like in a style by “trying them out” on certain songs. Macro notes recorded in
a pattern will play their corresponding chords; smooth voice leading is demonstrated etc.
Just choose a chord and then press [OK].
Note: This does not apply to drum patterns, since drum patterns don't play any differently on different chords.
Miscellaneous Style Settings, RealDrums, and RealTracks
From within the StyleMaker, press the [PATCH] button. The Misc. Style Settings dialog box
opens, which allows you to set some miscellaneous settings for the style. These include settings
to assign RealTracks and RealDrums to a style.
Waltz
If you want to make a Waltz style, check the Waltz checkbox. Then the StyleMaker will record and play patterns in
3/4 time. The “8 beat row” will record “6 beat” (2 bar) patterns, the “4 beat” will record 3 beat (1-bar) patterns. The
234
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
2 -beat and 1 -beat still record 2 and 1 beat patterns. The new style is made as a waltz, and will play with a 3/4 leadin. There is no need to put a 3/4 time signature change in bar 1.
You will also notice that any style will play better if set to 3/4 time. This makes songs like “'Take Five” sound
better, which are written as 3/4 + 2/4 bars. Try out the swingSwing_number9 demo of 5/4 time signature. So, if we
haven't made as Bossa Waltz for example, you can set a time signature of 3/4 in bar 1, and get a Bossa Waltz.
Pattern Pushing
Patterns can be pushed individually or on instrument basis (random % of time).
Pushes can get a Velocity Boost, so that they are played louder than other patterns. Usually a setting of 10 is a good
boost to give pushes.
# ticks to push: Choose the number ticks for each push to use. 30= = 16th note, 40 ticks= = triplet, 60 = half note.
In this example, the Bass part patterns will be pushed randomly 10% of the time, in the A substyle, and 20% of time
in the B substyle.
Since Rests can be “Shots,” that play a chord on beat 1, the style can define what instrument to use for this, and at
what velocity.
Similarly, each Push is accompanied by a drum stab, and the style can define what instrument to use and at what
velocity.
Set Patches…
The Set Patch and Volume for Style dialog box allows you to assign instruments to a style including default
instrument volumes. When the song is played back using the style, these patch changes will be sent to your
synthesizer along with the default instrument volumes. Remember to always use General MIDI Instrument
numbers, not the Patch numbers of your synth, unless you have a General MIDI synth. If you don't require a
specific instrument for the style, type a 0 for no patch change. The patch changes take effect immediately in the
style, so that when you are recording Bass parts for example, you will hear the bass patch that you have selected.
Thru Patch
If you set the Thru Patch to other than 0, the instrument that the user plays along with, using your style, will be the
Thru patch that you set. If you're making a “heavy rock” style, you might want to set the thru patch to be Rock
guitar if you expected that the user would want to always play along on Rock guitar.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
235
Melody Patch
If set to other than 0 all melodies will be played on the specified instrument. If you're making a “Grover
Washington” style for example, you might want any melodies to be automatically set to Saxophone.
Volumes
You can set a default volume for each instrument in your style. The default volume is 90. The volume range is 0 127.
RealDrums Settings
RealDrums are actual recordings of studio drummers, pieced together by Band-in-a-Box to create a unique “real”
drum track that is played along with the MIDI tracks created by Band-in-a-Box styles.
RealDrums Settings (Audio Drums, instead of MIDI drums)
Enable “Style uses RealDrums (audio drums)” in order to designate a RealDrums style, then press the [RD] button
to select your RealDrums style. Whenever the current style is played, it will use your RealDrums style provided that
RealDrums are enabled in the RealDrums Settings dialog. There are also additional volume controls here.
To make your overall dB setting a bit higher or lower for this particular Band-in-a-Box style you can enter a setting
here. There are also fields for adjusting the “a” or “b” subsection volumes only.
If you remove the check mark from either “Allow ‘a’ substyle RealDrums” or “Allow ‘b’ substyle RealDrums” the
one with the checkmark remaining will be used for the entire song, regardless of what substyle is currently called for
in the song.
Choose “Vary ^ styles with each play” to hear a different variation each time [Play] is pressed, so the song sounds
fresh each time. One time you’ll hear it with brushes, the next time with sticks and ride cymbals, etc.
Long Name (32 chars)
A long style name can be stored in the style (up to 32 characters), and this will appear on screen and in the
StylePicker.
Jazz Style?
This lets Band-in-a-Box know if the style you've made is a Jazz style or not. If it’s a Jazz style it will use the Jazz
Snare/Bass Drum instead of the Pop Snare/Bass Drum, and also makes some other decisions based on this setting.
Tempo
This allows you to set the default tempo for the Style. This is stored with the style. You can also change this tempo
by the tempo button on the StyleMaker main screen. Tempos can also be changed by the [ and ] keys. When
creating a new song the tempo will be set to the default tempo for the style/
236
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Resolution
Styles can either have Triplet (swing eighth notes) Straight (even eighth or sixteenth notes) resolution.
‘Riff’ voicing type uses chord tones
This is an option for piano, guitar, and string patterns. If selected, voicing modifies to match the chord and scale.
Deselect for a simple transpose ignoring chord type.
Assign Soloist (MIDI) or RealTracks (audio) to style
Styles can contain RealTracks and RealDrums or MIDI soloists.
To assign RealTracks to a style set the “Instrument” to use, and the RealTracks #. In the example, we are using
RealGuitar for the Guitar track.
Styles can have multiple RealTracks. For example, you could have RealPedalSteel and RealAcousticGuitar. And
also RealDrums.
Styles can also use MIDI soloists. For example, make a style with a banjo part that has the same quality as the
Band-in-a-Box Banjo Soloist. Here we are assigning an Earl Scruggs Bluegrass solo to the Strings part.
Use the dB or volume offset to match the level of the Soloist or RealTrack to the other instruments in the style. The
acceptable range is a MIDI setting of –127 to 127. When applying this offset to audio (RealTracks) a value of 32 is
approximately 6dB.
The Timing offset (RealTracks or MIDI) in ticks (120 per beat) setting allows you to make a song or style with a
more "laid-back" feel for a certain RealTracks.
The Timebase option allows styles to use Half Time and Double Time RealTracks.
For example, you can make a Jazz Ballad style (tempo 65) that uses a Sax Soloist at tempo 140 (playing double
time).
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
237
Multistyle(s)
Enter the name of a style: zzjazz, or multiple styles separated by semicolons: zzjazz;zzbossa and these will appear
as MultiStyles, substyles c/d/e/f etc.
You can click on the [STY] button to choose the styles for your MultiStyle from the StylePicker window.
Importing Patterns into a Style
Importing a pattern into a style is a powerful feature that greatly speeds up the making of new styles. In the interests
of not “re-inventing the wheel” with each new style, this allows you to import a pattern from another style.
How to Import a Pattern into a Style
A pattern can be copied from one style to another by copying and pasting. The Miami Pop style has a nice Strings
part, in this example we’ll import the Strings from Miami Pop style into the Light Rock style, ZZLITROK.STY.
Let's import the “Miami Pop” strings into the Light Rock style.
- Choose the [LOAD] button.
- Select the ZZMIAMI.STY style from the file dialog.
- Select the [Strings] button to display the String patterns for this style.
- Select an 8-beat String pattern to copy and press the [COPY] button.
- Choose the [LOAD] button.
- Select the ZZLITROK.STY style.
- Press the OPEN button to open this style.
- Choose an empty 8-beat “b” String pattern (because that is where the String pattern was recorded in) and press
the [PASTE] button.
- Press the [SAVE] button to save the Lite Rock style with Strings.
The strings will play in the “b” substyle only, because that's how they were made in the Miami Pop style.
You could now import the Guitar from the ZZCONTRY.STY for example, using the steps above. It is quite easy to
quickly add instruments to styles by importing instruments from other styles.
238
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Intelligent Guitar Styles
Would you like to hear some realistic, accurate MIDI guitar from Band-in-a-Box styles, with strumming, picking,
and accurate fret fingering? You'll get it with Version 11! “Guitar Styles” are styles that show strummed and
picked guitar parts accurately on the guitar fretboard, and they sound great. These styles also play accurate guitar
voicings, in your choice of Pop, Jazz, Country, or Folk Guitar chording. There's even a “walking guitar comping”
style that plays guitar that emulates the famous “Basie Big Band” Jazz style. The “Guitar Styles” play like any
regular style, and when you view them on the virtual guitar fretboard you can see exactly which strings and frets are
used so it is a great learning tool as well.
Information about Guitar Styles for Playback.
Guitar Styles are identified by the exclamation point (!) in the style name. This is not a requirement, but is usually
present in the style name. Guitar styles require Version 11 of Band-in-a-Box. With an earlier version the guitar
track will play wrong notes. For the typical user who is just using the styles for playback and isn't making their own
styles there's not much that you need to know about the styles, since they play normally like other Band-in-a-Box
styles.
You can see which tracks have intelligent guitar parts by looking at the title window of the Guitar fretboard, when
the track is highlighted. If it is a guitar style track, it will say [Guitar voicings] after the name of the track. The
usual track that has the intelligent guitar styles is of course the Guitar part. Some of the styles have more than one
guitar, so the Piano and/or Strings part might also have an intelligent guitar part. In these cases, you can also view
the guitar on those tracks.
The styles can be set to use different types of voicings for guitar. For example, there are Jazz, Pop and Folk (open
position) voicings. Also, some of the styles allow the guitar to play advanced chords and inversions. Some of the
styles play chord patterns, so the chord in the song might be F7, but the guitar plays a “walking-chord” pattern of
F7, Cm7/G, Abdim, F7/A on each beat. There can be “finger-picking” styles that have a lowest note alternate
between root and 5th.
Guitar parts use channels 11 to 16 for the notes, corresponding to strings 1 to 6 of the guitar. When the notes are
output to MIDI, they are re-channeled to the Guitar channel, so that it only uses 1 channel. When you make a MIDI
file, the notes will all be written on the single guitar channel. Some other sequencers (e.g., PowerTracks Pro for
Windows ) will recognize guitar parts on all 6 channels, so if you want to write the MIDI file from an intelligent
guitar style, you can set Band-in-a-Box to do this from the Preferences “Write Guitar part on 6 channels” option.
As previously mentioned, you don't need to be aware of the details of how this is done; you just play the styles as
usual.
Let's Examine the Intelligent Guitar Styles
Load in the song! Freddie.MGU from the “Songs” folder. This is a demo song for the style! Freddie.STY. The
exclamation point (!) in the name of a style is a convention to indicate that the style is an “intelligent guitar style.”
This means that the patterns on the guitar part will play with correct guitar voicings on the fretboard.
Play the !Freddie.MGU song.
Open the Guitar window and click
on the [G] button to view the Guitar
track on the guitar fretboard.
As the song plays, you'll see and hear the guitar played on the fretboard using correct Jazz voicings. For some
chords, you'll notice that the guitar plays different voicings on each beat in a walking pattern. For example, on an
F7 chord lasting 4 beats, the guitar might play “F7, Gm7, Abdim, and F7/A,” with each chord lasting one beat, just
as a professional Jazz guitarist might do.
The !Freddie.MGU style uses 3 note chord voicings in order to
emphasize the lower range and to enhance the percussive rhythm
effect.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
239
Since in these cases the guitarist is usually fingering the 4th note and muting it, if you want to see what the 4th note of
the voicing would be you can set this option by pressing the [Settings] button in the Guitar window and checking the
box for “Show muted note of guitar style comping” in the Guitar Settings dialog.
Note: Remember that for any style you see with an exclamation point (!) in the style name (an intelligent guitar style) you can
view and hear the guitar part played on the guitar fretboard as described above.
The Harmony Maker
The Harmony Maker editing module allows you to create (or edit) your own harmonies. This can be used in the
program to harmonize melodies, solos, or live playing on the Thru channel.
Sophisticated options control usage of passing harmonies (diatonic, dominant approach and chromatic), drop octave
voicings (e.g. drop 2), octave doubling, patch selection, and more. An unlimited number of harmonies can be
created and can be saved to disk as harmonies files. Changes in harmonies can be heard “live” as a song is playing.
To get to the Harmony Maker you can open either the Melody [M] or Thru [T]
dialog to select a harmony, and then click on the [Edit] button. Or you could go
to the Harmony menu and select Edit Current Harmonies File.
The Harmony Maker screen allows you to design a harmony.
This harmony can be used in the future for the melody or the thru harmony part.
Each harmony can use up to 3 channels, Harmony Channel A, B, and C.
If your harmony only has one instrument, then you will use Channel A for all the voices. If your harmony uses
Flute and Bass, then you could use Flute on Channel A, and Bass on Channel B.
Let's make the Harmony called Shearing Quintet. The Shearing Quintet was a famous Jazz quintet with a distinctive
sound that consisted of:
- Piano playing a 4-part harmony with the melody doubled one octave below.
- Vibes doubling the melody.
- Electric Guitar doubling the melody one octave below.
240
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Let's hear our Shearing harmony playing as we develop it. To do this, we need a song with a melody to be playing
before we enter the Harmony Maker. So let's exit the Harmony Maker, and start a song with a melody playing (like
Old Folks at Home.mgu). Now go back into the Harmony Maker.
Voices
You'll see the voices down the left side of the dialog box.
Mel is the melody.
Voice 2 is a chord tone below the melody.
Voice 3 is 2 chord tones below the melody.
Voice 4 is 3 chord tones below the melody.
Voice 5 (rarely used) is an additional chord tone, usually the 9th or 11th in the scale.
Mel2 and Mel3 are used to double the melody.
Settings for Each Voice
Channel is described above. A 1-instrument harmony will use Channel A only. Additional instruments can use
Channel B and C.
Note: These channels are set to numbers in the Harmony Channels dialog box, available in the M | MIDI Settings… dialog box.
For the Shearing Quintet harmony, we will set the Piano to Channel A, the Vibes to B, and the Guitar to C.
Octave
This allows the harmony to “drop down” or “go up” by a number of octaves. This octave change will only happen
in a certain range, as chosen in the Low and High settings.
For example, in the Shearing Quintet harmony, we want the 2nd voice of the Piano part to drop down an octave
when the melody note is higher than MIDI note 68 (the Ab above middle C). So when the melody is higher than
this, the harmony will become a “drop 2” voicing.
There is also an Overall Harmony Octave setting, available by pressing the [More…] button that changes the octave
of the entire harmony.
O. Double (Octave Double)
This setting lets you double any voice. Usually you want to do this by doubling an octave below (i.e. octave =-1),
but you can set the octave from -2 to +2. (The doubling will always be on the same channel, if. If you want a
different instrument to double the voice, then use the Melody Doubling Voices.)
For the Shearing Quintet harmony, the only voice that needs a doubling like this is the Piano melody, so we'll set
this to = -1 on mel (the melody voice).
V. Boost (Velocity Boost)
This allows you to increase or decrease the velocity (loudness) of each voice, to make the voice stand out more or
less in the harmony. Default =0.
For the Shearing Harmony, we set the Melody to a boost of 10, and the vibes and guitar to a negative boost of (-5,
and -20). This makes the piano stand out, and the vibes and guitar quieter.
The Patches setting at the bottom allows you to assign a patch to the harmony. If you set “No Patch change” the
harmony won't change the patch. This is a useful setting for making a generic harmony that doesn't change the
patch of the Melody or Thru channel for example.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
241
For the Shearing Quintet harmony, we will set the patches as follows:
Channel A: Piano
Channel B: Vibes
Channel C: Guitar
When we have made changes to the harmony, we will hear these changes on the harmony channel.
Important note: You need to press the UPDATE button after you've made any changes for the changes to take effect.
You make Copy a Harmony to the clipboard, and then move to a new
harmony and PASTE the harmony to the new location.
For example, if you want to make a harmony similar to the Shearing Quintet harmony, choose [Copy], move to a
new harmony, and choose [Paste]. Then rename that harmony “Shearing - modified” and you can make changes to
it (such as using different instruments).
You should never have to press these [Save] buttons since the harmony is
saved automatically for you. All of the 256 harmonies are saved in a
single .har file called default.har. If you have run out of harmonies, you can start a new harmonies file by pressing
the [SaveAs]. For example, if you want to make a disk of add-on harmonies, you can make one and save it as
MyName.HAR. Then you could share it with other Band-in-a-Box users who could load in your bank of harmonies
(from the Har| Edit a Harmonies File…) without disrupting their own existing default.har file.
As stated above, each .har file has 256 harmonies, so you probably need
only 1 file (default.har) for all your harmonies. But if you've made a great
harmony and want to give it to your friend for example, you can export a single harmony as a.h1 file. Your friend
can then import this harmony into their .har file. Or, you could upload some.h1 files that you've created to your
favorite web site for other Band-in-a-Box users to enjoy by importing them into their default.har harmonies file.
The best way to develop a harmony is to hear it as it’s playing. The preferred way to do this is to have a song
playing that has a melody in it. Any changes to the harmony will be heard on the melody as soon as you press the
[Update] button. You can also play along as the song is playing, and hear the new harmony on the Thru channel.
If you don't want to have a song playing, and want to hear the harmony, then set
the Test Chord to a certain chord. Then you can play on the MIDI keyboard
(with no song playing) and hear your harmony. This allows you to examine
exactly what notes Band-in-a-Box is using to make your harmony.
Additional harmony settings are accessed by pressing the [More] button, which brings up the
Additional Harmony Options dialog box:
242
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Use Close Harmony
This only applies to 2 and 3 part harmonies.
If set to =0, then it will use only close harmonies (mainly 3rds for 2 part harmonies).
If set to =1, it will use mostly 3rds, with some 6ths for 2 part harmonies.
If set to =99, it will use mostly 6ths, with some 3rds for 2 part harmonies.
If set to =100, then it will use only wide harmonies (i.e. mainly 6th for 2 part harmonies).
If set to between 2 and 98, it will vary between close and open harmonies (for 2 and 3 part harmonies).
Use Passing Chords (Melody)
Default = 100 %
Band-in-a-Box will sort out when to use passing harmonies, based on factors like the duration of the note, the next
note, the chord tone, the velocity, previous notes, and other factors. You don't need to be aware of any of this. You
can visually see when the harmony is using a passing chord. The harmony display is usually blue, but when there is
a passing chord, it displays as RED.
If you don't want passing chords, set this value to = 0. We usually leave it at 100%.
Lowest Harmony Note
You can set a lowest note for the harmony to play. When the melody is low, harmonies begin to sound “muddy,” so
you can avoid the harmony being played below a certain note.
Overall Harmony Octave
This is very useful setting. It sets the overall octave of the harmony. For example, when we made the 5-part
Trumpets harmony, we wanted the harmony to always be played an octave higher than the recorded melody. This is
because the 5-part harmony is spread over 2 octaves and needs a high
Volume Adjust of Entire Harmony
You can set an overall adjust to the entire harmony, so it will be quieter.
No harmony if duration less than
If harmonies such as “Garner Piano” harmonize every note, they produce unrealistic harmonies, since a piano player
(like Garner) wouldn't harmonize notes of a short duration. You can specify a harmony to only occur for notes
longer than a certain duration. In the example of Garner, we set the threshold to 200ms, notes shorter than that will
not be harmonized.
OK to make new harmony with chord
This option is for how the program fixes the harmony when chord changes occur during a sustained note harmony.
Most harmonies have a feature that changes the pitch of the harmony voices under the Melody note when the chord
changes, if the underlying voice wouldn't be a chord tone. This sounds unrealistic for certain types of harmonies
like “Garner” or “Guitar harmonies,” since it would be unrealistic for those instruments to change the inner voicings
in this manner. If you de-select the option to “Make new harmony with new chord,” the voices that would conflict
with the new chord merely stop playing instead of changing to new notes.
Use Guitar Harmony Voicings
This harmony type uses real guitar chord voicings that display correctly on the guitar fretboard. Setting the “Use
Guitar Harmony Voicings” checkbox means that guitar chord voicings will be used, instead of any other voicings
specified in the Harmony Maker. Check out Harmony #32 (J Pass) for an example of this.
The Soloist Maker
This module allows you to define your own soloists. For example, let's say you want to create a soloist in a style
similar to John Coltrane, the great Jazz saxophonist. The Soloist Maker allows you to define the parameters
essential to a soloist's playing, such as instrument range (i.e. tenor saxophone), extra legato playing, playing more on
top of the beat than most jazz musicians, and playing straighter 8th notes than usual swing 8th notes.
In addition, you can set phrasing options, such as how long the phrase should be, and how much “space” to leave
between phrases. You can also set how “outside” the playing should be. In the case of a John Coltrane style, you
set that to the maximum! Then “turn it loose” and hear the soloist play over any song!
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
243
10 easy steps to make a Soloist:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Bring up the Soloist window by pressing the [Solo] Button or Shift+F4.
Select a blank spot in your list of soloists and press the Soloist Maker [Edit] button.
Insert the title of your soloist and any memo note you wish to add. (The Num field will be filled in for
you.) Call this one “Bebop Saxophone.” For the memo, you can put in information like, “Basic bebop Sax
solo, will work with most swing styles. Check “Double Time?” if tempo is slower.”
Choose the type of soloist, i.e., Swing 8th notes, Even 8th notes, Swing 16th notes, etc. This should be set
to Swing 8ths.
This style uses the default ST2 database, J_SWING.ST2. Another choice could be made from the Soloists
folder by clicking on the [.ST2] button.
Press the [Choose] button to select the instrument the soloist should play (i.e. Tenor Saxophone).
Note: You may also select an instrument from the Patch Change window, but selecting an instrument with the 'choose' button also
fills in the note range information specific to that instrument. You'll notice that the correct range for tenor saxophone has been filled
in to the Note Range settings.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Modify (if required) the phrase length, space length, and outside range parameters.
Change the Legato Boost to 10 %. This will % to add 10% to the duration of the notes.
Increase the Lateness by -5. This will play the notes more “on the beat” than other jazz soloists.
Increase the 8th Note spacing by -5. This will play the 8th notes in a more even feel than other Jazz
soloists.
If your screen looks something like the one shown, press [OK]. Then, give Band-in-a-Box a few moments to load
its knowledgebase of solo ideas and new parameters, and an additional few moments to analyze the chords.
Playback will then begin automatically. Enjoy the solo!
244
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
The Melodist Maker
In addition to the Melodists supplied with the program, this module lets you define or edit your own melodists. You
can choose the parameters to control the type of chords, melody and intro to be generated, as well as a number of
settings controlling song form, theme continuity, endings type, anticipations, feel, style, harmony, soloist, patch
changes and more.
Launching the Melodist Maker
The Melodist Maker is launched from the Melodist selection dialog. Press the Melodist
Maker [Edit…] button to launch the Melodist Editor dialog.
Melodist Editor Dialog
This dialog has settings that allow you to create a Melodist.
The Num selection box allows you to select the Melodist that you'd like to edit.
The top area of the Melodist Maker screen allows you to set the Title of the Melodist and supply a Memo.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
245
The ST2 area allows you to select the associated ST2 database for the Melodist. Here are some ST2 Melodist
databases.
- MEL1Melody1.ST2 (Jazz Swing, 8th notes)
- MELPOP1MelodyPOP1.ST2 (Pop Ballads, 16th notes)
- MELWLZ1MelodyWLZ1.ST2 (Waltzes, 8th notes)
- MELROK1MelodyROK1.ST2 (Rock, 8th notes)
Note: Soloist databases also have extensions of ST2, but they are not compatible with Melodists. Melodist databases can be
easily identified, as they all begin with MEL.
The Patch change area of the Melodist Maker screen allows you to select a Patch (instrument), Harmony, and
Change Instrument setting (each chorus). You can also Change Style for the Melodist, and specify the feel for the
style in the “.STY is” box.
-
246
The Legato Boost changes the legato (length) of the notes generated. Instruments like Saxophone have longer
legato phrasing.
Lateness refers to how much after the beat the notes are played. This is normally left at zero for Melodists.
8th note spacing is usually left at zero. If set to a non-zero value, the 8th notes will be farther apart (units of
120ppq).
Increase velocity is used to increase or decrease the volume of the Melodist.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
The next section of the Melodist Maker allows you to select options that control what type of melody will be
generated. Here's an explanation of these options.
Unique Themes
Default=100
This is normally left at 100%. But if you want to force the Melodist to stick with the same theme throughout the
song, set this to a lower value (say 80%). It shouldn't be set much lower than 80.
Unusual Placed Phrasing
Default =0
The Melodist tries to make phrases that are appropriate for the position in the song. For example, the first 2 bars of
the melody are appropriate for “opening phrases.” But if you want to experiment with phrases that don't follow
these rules, set the Unusual Placed Phrasing to a value higher than 0% (e.g. 30%).
Default= = 80%
Simple 1st and 2nd Endings
This setting only applies to Melodists that are using the Jazz Swing (MEL1Melody1.ST2) or Waltz
(MELWLZ1MelodyWLZ1.ST2) databases. This determines the % of time that endings of the A sections (in AABA
forms) will be simple endings (1 or 2 notes) instead of complete phrases. Usually AABA tunes end with simple
phrases at the end of the A section, so this option is normally left at 80% or higher.
Choose Unusual Chord Progressions
Default= = 0
If set to a value other than zero, the Melodist will generate a typical chord progressions. For example, instead of a
Dm7 | G7 | Cmaj7, the Melodist might generate Dm7 | Db7 | Cmaj7 Am7.
Force Long Phrases
Default= = 20
This determines the % of time that the Melodist will try to generate long phrases (4 bars or more). The “downside”
to setting it higher than 20 will be a loss of uniqueness in the phrases generated. The setting shouldn't be set much
higher than 20.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
247
Mix Minor and Major Chord Progressions
Default= = 0
Typical 'major key” chord progressions have progressions like (in the key of C) Dm7 | G7 | Cmaj7, whereas in the
key of Am, they would be | Bm7b5 | E7 | Am6. This setting determines how much the two types of progressions
should be mixed in a single song.
Chord Substitutions Throughout the Form
Default= = 0
Normally an AABA song has identical chords for each “a” section. If this setting is greater than zero, the Melodist
will generate chord substitutions throughout the various “a” sections, while preserving the identical melodies!
Number of Variations to Choose From
Default= = 15
As the Melodist is determining what type of phrase to generate, it will narrow the possibilities to the number of
variations set in this variable. Setting a higher number results in more interesting melodies, but the chord
progressions are more unusual.
Default from 110 to 180 bpm
Tempo Range
The Tempo Range setting determines the tempo range that the tune will be created with (it will be a random tempo
in the range). The auto-tempo setting must be set on the Melodist Selection screen for the tempo range to work.
Transpose A2 Section
Default = 30
In songs with an AABA form, it is common for the second “a” section to be transposed. For example, the first “a”
section might be in the key of Eb, and the second would be transposed up to the key of Gb. Melodists store these
settings, and some Melodists are set to transpose the A2 sections. This setting determines the % chance that the
song will be generated with a transpose. The transpose will be usually 2, 3, or 4 semitones. The song will only be
transposed if the “A2 transpose” setting isn't set to “none” on the Melodist selection screen.
Anticipations in Phrases
Default = 20
Melodic phrases often begin a little before the beat; this is referred to as an anticipation. This setting determines
what % of the phrases will be anticipated.
Since Melodists can also generate Solos, a specific Soloist can be set in this setting. If set to “0 - no Soloist,” the
program will intelligently pick a Soloist.
Melodists can be copied and pasted to quickly make new Melodists that are variations of each other.
You can export (save) and import (load) individual melodists to/from .M1 files.
This would be useful if you wanted to send a Melodist to a friend for example.
The entire Melodist file, with 256 Melodists may be saved to a .MEL file. The usual file is DEFAULT.MEL. The
DEFAULT.MEL file is auto-saved every time the OK button is pressed, so you don't need to explicitly save by the
[Save As] button unless you want to save alternate .MEL files and go beyond 256 Melodists.
248
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
The Guitarist Maker
The [Edit…] button in the Guitarist Selection window launches the
Guitarist Editor, where you'll see the options for making or editing
Guitarists.
-
-
The Guitarist is selected from the “Num” field.
You can title the Guitarist using the “Title” field.
The Memo field allows a 100-character memo about the Guitarist.
The Guitar Patch is selected using the Guitar Patch field.
Frets To Move field: If set to zero, the guitar chord solo will be limited to chords that can be played within the
current position. If set to 5 (for example), the chords will be limited to chords that can be played within the
current position and up to 5 frets away from the current position.
Force Open Position forces all of the guitar voicings to the open position. The exception is when the melody
notes are so high that they can't be played using open position voicings. If the melody is in a high range, and
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
249
you want a “forced open position,” you should likely transpose the melody to a lower octave prior to generating
the solo.
The settings for Note duration thresholds to get a chord refer to the length that a note must be before a chord will be
generated.
Looking at the settings above (for Guitarist #2), these would be interpreted as follows:
- If a note occurs and it is the “First Note of a New Chord,” and the note is not followed by another note for at
least 50 ticks (120 ticks = 1 quarter note), then a chord will get voiced 90% of the time.
- If a note occurs (not the first note of a chord), that is on “Beat 1 of a bar,” and the note is not followed by
another note for at least 50 ticks (120 ticks = 1 quarter note), then a chord will get voiced 90% of the time.
- Similar interpretations for notes occurring on “Beat 2, 3, and 4.” You can see that the threshold is higher for
notes on beat 2 and 4, which is how a guitar player makes chord solos.
- “Passing notes” are defined as short duration notes that aren't on the beat, and are followed by a note that is on
the beat. In the example above, passing notes will never be voiced as chords, since the tick threshold is set to
zero.
There is a further threshold applied to whether or not a note is voiced to a chord. These are durations in
milliseconds.
In the settings as illustrated, if the note occurs less than 100ms after the previous note, the note will not be voiced as
a chord. If the note is followed by another note within 80ms, then the note will not be voiced as a chord.
Strumming Settings
If the Guitar Chord were all played at the same time, it would sound as if it was “plucked.” Guitar playing is more
typically a strum.
Strum Speed: If you set the Speed of the strum to, say, 80ms, then the guitar chord will be “strummed” over a
period of 80ms.
250
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Strum Delay: If the Delay start time is left at zero, the strum will end at the original time of the melody note. If
you set it to 50% delay, the strum will be in its midpoint at the original start time of the Melody note, and if it's set to
100%, the strum won't start until the time of the original note. The most musical setting is about 50% delay. A
delay of 0% also sounds good, and has the added advantage that it doesn't shift the actual time of the Melody note
(relevant if you keep regenerating the solo on the Melody track).
The [Plucked] or [Strummed] buttons apply preset values.
Chord Types to Include
You can decide which types of chords should be included in the chord solo:
Chord Types (Best/Good/Advanced/Unusual/Barre/Open Strings).
- Best Chords are the most commonly played chords by pro guitarists.
- Best Chords if nothing else will consider best chords for inclusion if no other chords are found.
- Good chords are popular alternate chords.
- Advanced chords are chords that are difficult to play, or have advanced voicings.
- Unusual chords are voicings that should be avoided in most cases, but have some uses.
- Barre chords are chords that require the index finger to be played in a Barre position.
- Lenny B Chds sets the percentage of shell type Lenny Br. voicings, usually a shell of two notes on strings
4/5 or 5/6 and then a higher note on strings 1 or 2.
- Include Open Strings can be set to Never/Sometimes/Favor. If set to “Never,” no chords that require and
open string will be played. If set to “Favor,” it will play open strings whenever possible, and “sometimes”
is a “middle ground” setting.
OK to use chords with this # of Notes. You can select the # of notes for chords to be included in the chord solo.
In the example above, chords with 2-6 notes will be included.
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
251
Embellishment types allow setting of the types of embellishments to do,
- “Pop” Guitarists should be set to use 9ths only. This will change C7 chords to C9 and Cm7 to Cm9.
- The “7ths/9ths” setting should be used for Jazz. This adds the embellishments of C to Cmaj7 and Cm to
Cm7.
- The “7/9/11/13” embellishment should be used for “Advanced Jazz” Guitarists and add 11ths and 13ths
voicings.
If you make changes to the Guitarist settings, you need to manually save them, by pressing
[Save As], and then finding the Band-in-a-Box folder and saving the file as default.git.
Individual Guitarists can be copied, pasted, exported, or imported
to/from disk.
252
Chapter 12: User Programmable Functions
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth Tutorial
Selecting a MIDI Driver
Band-in-a-Box offers two MIDI Output options - Apple DLS Music Device (Built-in Mac sounds) and CoreMIDI.
The Apple DLS Music Device (Synth) does not require a Mac MIDI Interface or external synthesizer, and is the
simplest way to quickly make Music with Band-in-a-Box.
Hint: The Apple DLS Music Device is an Audio Unit softsynth which has properties very similar to the QuickTime Music Synthesizer.
CoreMIDI is the OS X standard MIDI driver method. CoreMIDI facilitates communication with external MIDI
devices, and it also enables inter-application “piping” of MIDI data between MIDI applications.
CoreMIDI requires some setup, but is not terribly complicated.
CoreMIDI with a MIDI Interface and External Synthesizers
If you have not done so already, follow the manufacturer’s instructions to install your MIDI interface. Installation
details may vary, depending on the manufacturer and the model of your MIDI Interface.
Hint: It is helpful to occasionally check your manufacturer’s web site and download/install MIDI Interface driver updates which might
become available.
Apple “Audio MIDI Setup” Application
Audio MIDI Setup is usually found in your Applications folder. It can be helpful to locate Audio MIDI Setup in the
Finder, then drag its icon to the Dock, so it will be easy to launch the program (from the Dock) when necessary.
Audio MIDI Setup can also be launched from Band-in-a-Box...
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
253
Specific details of your Audio MIDI Setup screen will differ from this example, depending on your MIDI interface
and your connected external MIDI devices. This is a relatively complicated example, with an eight port MIDI
interface and four different synthesizers.
If your MIDI Interface has been properly installed, the picture of your MIDI Interface will automatically appear in
the Audio MIDI Setup window, showing input/output “pins” for each MIDI input and output socket on your MIDI
Interface.
You need to inform Audio MIDI Setup about your external devices (keyboards, synthesizers, drum machines,
mixers, etc.). Click the [Add Device] button for each of your external devices, and then double-click each new
device to set Manufacturer, Model, number of Send/Receive MIDI channels, and other relevant information.
After your external devices have been created and configured, the last step is to “wire them up” to the picture of
your MIDI interface. For instance, in the above illustration, the KX-88 keyboard controller is connected to MIDI
input/output pair #8 on the MTPII MIDI Interface. Click on an input/output “pin” on the picture of your MIDI
Interface, and drag to an output/input “pin” of the picture of an external device.
After supplying this information, CoreMIDI will know what devices are “on the other side” of your MIDI
interface(s).
254
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
Band-in-a-Box MIDI Port Selection for External Devices
This example shows Band-in-a-Box configured to receive/record from a MIDI keyboard on MIDI Interface Port 8.
Band-in-a-Box transmits tracks on an assortment of synthesizers, connected to various MIDI Interface ports. This
scheme would be useful on a large MIDI setup, if your best Drum sounds are on a Port 5 synthesizer, best Piano is
on a Port 2 synthesizer, etc.
Your setup does not have to be so complex. If you want all tracks to be played on a single synthesizer (the most
common situation), set the desired destination in the Bass popup menu, and then click the ‘set all ports to this’
button, to quickly set the destination for all tracks. You can get excellent results with all instruments assigned to a
General MIDI compatible device, such as an Apple DLS synth module.
Apple DLS Synth and a Controller Keyboard
If you have a small MIDI controller keyboard, but you do not have any external MIDI Synthesizers, Band-in-a-Box
can easily support this.
Select the port that your controller is connected to as your MIDI Input, and then select QT Music Instruments for
your output ports. Band-in-a-Box will receive/record from a keyboard connected to the MIDI interface, but
playback and keyboard MIDI Thru will go to the built-in Mac synth.
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
255
Inter-Application Communication with IAC or Virtual Ports
Virtual Ports can be used to “pipe” Band-in-a-Box MIDI playback into most CoreMIDI-compatible sequencers and
other MIDI software. This means that when you play a song in Band-in-a-Box, the MIDI information will be sent to
another application, rather than directly to a MIDI interface or Apple DLS softsynth.
One reason to do this would be to use a third party application as an Audio Unit or VST plug-in host. An example
of such a program is Rax (http://www.audiofile-engineering.com/rax/).
With Band-in-a-Box, you can either use the BIAB Virtual Ports or the IAC (Inter-Application Communication) bus.
These are just two different ways of accomplishing the same thing.
To use the IAC bus, you first need to enable the IAC driver in the Audio MIDI Setup window (MIDI Devices).
Double-click on IAC Driver, make sure “Device is online” is checked, and add at least one port.
Hint: If Band-in-a-Box is running when you enable the IAC driver, you may need to quit and re-open the Band-in-a-Box application
before it is recognized.
In Band-in-a-Box, go to the CoreMIDI Choose Ports dialog, and select IAC on all output ports.
256
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
Next, launch your third party MIDI application, and select IAC as the input port. This is often done in the program's
Preferences | MIDI window.
Hint: It can sometimes make a difference which MIDI application you open first. For example, you may need to launch the third
party application before you launch Band-in-a-Box.
On Non-GS Synthesizers, Avoid GS Commands
GS is a Roland-authored set of SysEx commands. GS is recognized by many (but not all) Roland synthesizers. GS
is also recognized by some non-Roland synthesizers.
In a perfect world, the worst that would happen to a non-GS synthesizer is that the synthesizer would simply ignore
GS messages (and therefore GS parameters like Master Volume or Reverb would not work).
However, there are many synthesizers available, especially amateur-written softsynths. It is possible that you may
find occasional devices that can get confused and malfunction, if presented with GS messages.
In order to make sure you get the control response you expect, and avoid possible malfunctions on some
synthesizers. Unless you know that your synthesizer understands GS messages, make sure to specify MIDI control
messages.
Chapter 13: CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth
257
Chapter 14: Reference
Band-in-a-Box Menu
About Band-in-a-Box gives important program information such as the version and build and the people who make
it possible. There is also contact information for PG Music Inc., technical support, and the PG Music web page,
www.pgmusic.com.
Preferences is a direct link to the Preferences dialog, which is also available with the [Prefs] toolbar button.
Services opens a submenu of the available services in the operating system.
Hide Band-in-a-Box will minimize the Band-in-a-Box window. Restore it by clicking the Band-in-a-Box icon on
the dock.
Hide Others/Show All either shows or hides other open windows and applications.
Quit Band-in-a-Box exits the program.
258
Chapter 14: Reference
File Menu
New is used to blank the Chordsheet and start a new song.
Open song… is used to open an existing song.
Open Filtered by Style lists only the songs in a folder with current style.
Open Song with Melody lists only the songs in a folder with melodies (*.mg?).
Open Favorite Songs opens the dialog listing the last 150 songs played.
Open Song by Title opens the Song List with the full title, file name, and style of each song in the folder. A “Find”
function allows you to search the title list for a word or phrase to find a title quickly. For example, type in “Old
folks” and the search will find the song title “Old Folks at Home,” plus any other songs with “Old folks” in the title.
Import Chords from MIDI File uses the MIDI file chord wizard to interpret chords from any MIDI file, and also
read tracks to the Melody and Soloist tracks.
(re)-make Song Titles list makes the list of song titles for the current folder. It can be used to update the list when
new songs are added to a folder.
Save saves an existing song to the same folder with the same file name.
Save song As… saves songs using the file dialog to name the file and choose a folder for the saved file.
Chapter 14: Reference
259
Save Standard MIDI File makes a standard midi file. You can save in Type 1 (multi-tracks) or Type 0 (single
track) files. Karaoke MIDI files are also supported. See the settings in the Preferences dialog box to control how
the Melody, Solo, and Harmony are written to a MIDI file.
Save song with Patches... If you would like to save certain patches with a song, then type in the number of the
patch (instrument) that you would like. Leave the other instruments at zero (0) for No Patch change. Remember
that - as with all other Band-in-a-Box functions - you use the General MIDI number for the instrument, regardless of
the synth you are using.
File utilities…
Open Next Song and Open Previous Song will open the next/previous song in alphabetical order. For
example, if the song loaded has a file name of “Paul,” choosing load-next-file will find the next file in
alphabetical order after Paul; maybe it would be “Peter.” The hot keys for this are Shift+F8 and
Ctrl+Shift+F8.
Auto Rename 8 Character song filenames will rename all song files in a folder using the song title as the
name. The Auto Rename Song Files dialog will open.
If you have a folder with files that are in the short filename format, you can quickly convert the filenames
to long file names. Band-in-a-Box will use the title of the song as the file name, so if you have a file called
oldFolk.mgu, Band-in-a-Box read the actual song title stored within the song, and rename the filename to
"Old Folks at Home.MGU."
You can set options as follows:
Convert names in ALL CAPS to Upper /Lower Case: If the song title found is OLD FOLKS AT
HOME, setting this option would allow the file name to be called Old Folks at Home.
Convert names to ALL CAPS converts a song title with upper and lower case to an upper case file
name.
Replace Underscore with Space Char / Replace Space char with Underscore are options to make
the file names with either spaces or underscores between words.
Rename files even if the title is “Untitled Song.” Since Band-in-a-Box's default song title is
Untitled Song, setting this option would rename the files to names like Untitled Song. If enabling
this option results in a duplicate file name, Band-in-a-Box will append the original file name (e.g.,
MySong.MGU), so the full name would be 'Untitled Song MySong.MGU. This ensures that all file
names will be unique, even if the song titles are the same.
Maximum # characters for filename. Since song titles are a maximum of 65 characters, you can
auto-rename song file names up to this 65 character limit.
After renaming the files, Band-in-a-Box will offer to remake the songlist.doc file. This file is used by the
SongPicker dialog that shows you the songs with full titles and other information.
260
Chapter 14: Reference
Rename any Song on Disk… or Rename Current Song on disk… allows you to rename files.
Delete a Song from Disk… deletes a song file without exiting the program.
“Erase it!” (Delete Current Song from Disk) deletes the current song.
Load Previous Style/Load Next Style This function, (analogous to the Load Next Song function) loads in
the previous (or next) style in alphabetical order of the file name. To load the next style, in alphabetical
order, choose the menu item File | File Utilities | Load Next Style, or use the hot key Command+Shift+F8
(Control+Command+Shift+F8 for the previous style).
Render Current Song To Audio opens the Render to Audio File(s) dialog, which automatically renders
the full mix or selected tracks to either a compressed or an uncompressed audio file in mono or stereo.
Play Song generates an accompaniment and starts playback of the current song.
Replay Already Constructed Song plays an existing song arrangement from the beginning without regenerating a
new arrangement.
Notation Window opens the Notation.
Page Setup… takes you to the setup dialog for your printer.
Print… opens the Print Options dialog.
Lyric Window opens a lyric entry line above the Notation Toolbar where lyrics can be typed in line by line. Use
the esc key to exit from the Lyric window.
Chapter 14: Reference
261
Edit Menu
Edit | Undo and Edit | Redo allow you to undo or redo most operations.
Edit | Cut functions like a delete command. It removes bars of chords from a song.
Edit | Copy and Edit | Paste are to copy chords from one part of the song to another. Copying a section of chords
can be done in the same manner as copying text in a word processor.
262
Chapter 14: Reference
Copy From…To… / Copy Rests / Erase From… To…
One of the best ways to copy chords is the Copy From… To… command, or pressing Option+C, which will launch
the Copy Chords and/or Melody dialog.
The Copy Rests command will similarly bring up a dialog to allow copying of rests.
The Erase From… To… command launches the Erase Chords and/or Melody dialog. These dialogs allow you to
specify the number of bars to copy or erase, the location to copy to, and the option to copy or erase the Chords,
Melody, and/or Soloist.
Intro Bars Auto-Generate
This command will launch the Generate Chords for Intro (or Remove Intro) dialog where you can specify the
characteristics of the intro you wish to generate.
Clear LeadSheet blanks the Chordsheet and restores the default song settings.
Insert Measure(s) inserts a certain # of bars into the Chordsheet.
Delete Measure(s) removes a certain # of bars from the Chordsheet.
Shrink cuts chord durations by 50% (e.g., 4beats>>2beats; 2beats>>1beat).
Expand doubles the durations of chords (e.g., 1beat>>2beats; 2beats>>4beats).
Unfold (convert to 1 BIG chorus)
Choose this command to unfold a multi-chorus song into one BIG chorus. When selected, Band-in-a-Box will
display all choruses and verses of a song without loops or repeats. It is useful, for instance, when you have a song
with 3 choruses and want to convert it to a single large chorus, or to customize a song with the “Edit Bar Settings”
feature to change meter, tempo, patches, styles, and/or harmonies and generate a MIDI file for export.
Set Time Sig Of Scrap allows a new time signature to be selected for highlighted bars on the Chordsheet.
Transpose opens a dialog where the song can be transposed up or down by a semitone, or by any number of
semitones. These operations can also be performed with keystrokes.
Blank Lyrics removes the lyrics from a song.
Slide Tracks
This allows you to move any of the Bass, Drums, Piano, Guitar, Strings, Melody or Soloist tracks ahead or behind
by a certain amount. You could, for example, slide the Bass track so it plays a little ahead of the rest of the band.
This has the effect of making the bass player “drive the band,” and is useful in Jazz styles to make the music sound
more exciting.
Chord Settings
This launches the Chord Settings dialog box, where you can put in rests and pushes. You can launch the Preview,
Chord Builder, or Chord Substitution functions from this window.
Bar Settings
This command opens the Edit Bar Settings dialog where you can change meter, tempo, patches, styles, and/or
harmonies at the current bar.
Song Memo…
A song memo of up to 2000 characters may be added. When a song has a memo associated with it, a little red
square is visible around the [memo] button (located to the right of the song title). Clicking on the [M] button
launches the Song Memo dialog, where you can type in a short memo about the song, style, etc.
Enter Lyrics at Current Bar opens the lyric entry window for the current location in the song.
Copy Lyrics to Clipboard puts a copy of the lyrics in the clipboard.
Move Lyrics up/down Row(s)… allows previously entered lyrics to be shifted up or down in a range of +/- 24
rows.
Edit Chord “Shortcut.txt” will edit the file SHORTCUT.TXT using Teach Text. This is the chord shortcuts file.
Refresh Chord Shortcuts saves changes to the SHORTCUT.TXT file. Changes must be saved with this command
or they will be lost.
Chapter 14: Reference
263
Song Menu
Title/Key/Tempo/Embel…
Opens the Main Settings dialog. This dialog offers you the option to set the title, key, and chorus begin/end, etc.
These settings are usually entered on the main screen.
Chorus begins at
Shows the bar number for the start of the chorus. Choose this command to set a new beginning for the chorus by
clicking on the bar in the Chordsheet.
Chorus ends after
Shows the current bar setting for the end of the chorus. Use this command to set a new ending for the chorus by
clicking on the bar in the Chordsheet.
Total Choruses =
Show the number of choruses for the song, click to change.
Vary Middle Style
If checked, the middle chorus(es) of the song will be played in the “b” substyle.
Overall Loop
If checked the song will play again from the beginning each time it reaches the end.
264
Chapter 14: Reference
Additional Song Settings
These additional song settings are saved with the song.
Vary Style in Middle Choruses
Default =
If checked, the song will play in substyle B throughout the Middle Choruses. The Middle Choruses include all
choruses except the first and last. If not checked, the middle choruses will play “a” and “b” substyles as set in the
Chordsheet with part markers.
Chapter 14: Reference
265
For example, in Jazz Swing, since the B substyle is Swing, all of the middle choruses will have swing bass. (The A
substyle is playing half notes on the bass.)
Allow Pushes in Middle Choruses
Default =
This is used if you have put pushes into a song, but don't want the pushes to play in the middle choruses. The
middle choruses are usually used for soloing, so you may not want the pushes to play.
Rests
Allow Rests in First Chorus
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the first chorus.
Allow Rests in Middle Choruses
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the middle choruses. The middle
choruses are usually used for soloing, so you may not want the rests to play.
Allow Rests in Last Chorus
Default =
This is used if you have put rests into a song, but don't want the rests to play in the last chorus.
Allow Pedal Bass in Middle Choruses
Default =
This determines whether Pedal Bass effect will be allowed in middle choruses.
Allow Embellishment of Chords
Default =
The Jazz styles include embellishment of chords. This means that if you type a C7 chord, the piano player may play
a C13 or a C7b9. This makes the arrangement sound more authentic.
Tip: If you are hearing flat 9 and flat 13 embellishments on a C7 chord that is clashing with the melody, you should rename the
chord C9 or C13, which will ensure natural 9 and 13 embellishments. To disable the embellishment for a certain song,
uncheck this option. There are very few situations that you wouldn't want it on, especially if you name some chords as C9
instead of C7 (in situations where the melody clashes with the embellishment as discussed above.) You would need to
uncheck it for any song that you don't want it on.
Tag Settings
A tag (or coda) is a group of bars that are played in the last chorus of a song. If you check the “Tag Exists?” field,
then the tag will play during the last chorus of the song. The tag begins after the bar you specify as “Tag Jump After
Bar #.” The song then jumps to the “Tag Begin at Bar #” and plays until “Tag Ends After Bar #.” At the end of the
tag, the song then plays a 2 bar ending as usual.
Generate 2 Bar Ending for This Song
Default =
You can disable the ending for a certain song. You can disable the endings for all songs by clearing the checkmark
for the “Allow Any Endings” setting in the Preferences dialog.
Use 4-Bar Ending for RealTracks adds two bars on the end of the song for the ending note on RealTracks
to fade (decay).
Start the 2 bar ending early
The usual Band-in-a-Box ending is 2 bars appended to the end of the song. This option gives you an alternative to
end the song on the last bar of the song. Band-in-a-Box will still play an ending on the chord that you specify, and
the ending will occur as a 2 bar phrase beginning 2 bars before the end of the form. This results in more natural
endings for many songs.
Note: “Auto Endings”
If you‘ve made a style, and haven’t included an ending, a 2-bar ending can be generated automatically, based on the style.
Fadeout ending # bars
You can quickly choose a fadeout ending. Just press the Fade button and Band-in-a-Box will fade out the last “X”
bars of the song (you can specify how many bars). Or customize the fadeout with precise values for each bar.
266
Chapter 14: Reference
Solos should have a “bluesy” feel.
Check this setting for solos with more syncopation, flatted thirds, and sevenths.
Allow RealTracks substitution based on tempo
Default =
When set, the program will find the best RealTracks to use at the current tempo.
Allow RealTracks Shots, Holds, and Pushes
Default =
When set, this song will support Shots, Holds, and Pushes for those RealTracks that have them (as shown in the “H”
column of the RealTracks Picker).
Play
Generates a new arrangement and plays the song.
Stop
Stop playback with this command or the esc key.
Hold (Pause)
Pauses the song. Repeating this command resumes play from the exact location where the song was paused.
Play From Bar#
Choose a chorus and bar to play from in the current arrangement. Parts are not regenerated. Use this command
during playback to jump to any bar in the song.
Play From Current
When the song is stopped this command starts playback again at the bar with the highlight cell.
Go (Open and Play)
Launches a file dialog for selection of any song in any folder. The selected song loads and plays automatically in
Band-in-a-Box.
Juke Box Play
Opens the Juke Box Options dialog to select and play a jukebox list.
Previous Juke Song/Next Juke Song
Navigate back and forth in a jukebox set list.
Wizard Playalong
Enables the Wizard feature for play along on the computer keyboard.
Wizard Uses ‘Smart’ Notes
Toggle this on so the Wizard will only play notes based on the chord/key of the song. Toggle smart notes “Off”
(unchecked) to have the Wizard provide you access to the chromatic scale.
Freeze all Tracks
Freeze all tracks so that Band-in-a-Box will not overwrite them with new arrangements.
Un-Freeze all Tracks
Un-freeze all frozen tracks.
Freeze a single track
Freeze any track so that it will not be overwritten by Band-in-a-Box. You can use this menu command repeatedly to
freeze individual tracks in a song.
Generate (even if tracks are frozen)
Force generation of a song that is frozen.
Chapter 14: Reference
267
Styles Menu
Use this list for a quick pick from the list of 24 original Band-in-a-Box styles.
You either can pick a musical style before or after you have entered the chords to a song. Once you load a style, the
song will be played back using your chosen style. All style files have a .STY extension.
Besides these built-in styles, there are many more styles available for use with the Band-in-a-Box. Here are other
ways to access styles.
Pressing the [Style] button will bring up the StylePicker window with information on all the styles
found in your Band-in-a-Box folder.
The [F] button brings up the Recently Played/Favorites dialog where you can choose from the
styles that you use most often or from your list of favorites.
268
Chapter 14: Reference
User Menu
Load Style From Disk…
Go to the file dialog and open a style from the Styles folder.
Load Favorite Styles…
Opens the Favorites/Recently Played dialog.
Save Style As…
Save a new style or and edited style, or rename an existing style.
Make A New Style (STYLE MAKER)
Launches the StyleMaker with a blank new style.
Edit Existing User Style
Launches the StyleMaker with the current style selection loaded. This allows you to edit an existing style (*.Style)
from disk. The resulting style can then be saved with the same name or a different name.
Current Style:
This shows the file name of the current style in use.
Style Information…
Shows a summary of information about the current style.
Chapter 14: Reference
269
OK to Load Styles w/ songs
Normally this is checked so that songs load with the associated style. But let’s say we’ve discovered a new style,
and want to try it out on many different songs. In that case, we would ensure that this item is NOT checked. Then
when a song is loaded, it will play in the new style we are trying out.
Mute Melody during middle choruses
This gives the Soloist(s) a chance to play on a given song during the middle choruses. Toggle this option “On” if
you would like the melody to be muted during these choruses.
Kill Melody in Middle choruses
This command will permanently erase the middle choruses of the Melody.
Force song to # choruses
Toggle this option “On” if you would like a given song to have a preferred number of choruses.
Auto-Generate Song Title
Band-in-a-Box will generate an infinite variety of titles for your songs.
‘Jazz Up’ the Chords
This will “Jazz Up” the chords by changing chords like C and Cmaj to 7th and 6th chords. Song embellishment will
be turned on for the song. Select the type of 7ths from the list box then click on the [OK – Jazz UP] button.
‘Jazz Down’ the Chords
This will “Jazz Down” the chords by changing chords with 7ths (e.g. C7) to triads (e.g. C) and 9ths and 13ths to 7th
chords. Song embellishment is turned off. Press [OK – Jazz Down] to proceed.
Chord Substitution Dialog (choose your own)…
This allows you to see a list of possible chord substitutions for the current chord progression.
Auto-Generate Chord Substitutions…
This will automatically pick chord substitutions for all or part of the song.
Chord Builder…
Allows you to build up chords using mouse clicks. You can enter chords “by ear” without having to know the actual
chord names or any music theory. This feature also illustrates the differences between various chord types.
Play Current Chord
Click on any chord and use this command or press Shift+Return to instantly hear how it sounds.
270
Chapter 14: Reference
Melody Menu
Import Melody from MIDI File… allows you to import MIDI data from a file (*.MID) into the Melody track.
Import Melody from Clipboard… allows you to import MIDI data that has been pasted into the clipboard (e.g.,
from a sequencer).
Record Melody… launches the Record Tracks dialog to record a MIDI melody.
Record Melody From Bar #... lets you click on any bar to start recording there.
Step edit Notes… allows you to enter/edit a melody in step time using an event list.
Chapter 14: Reference
271
Quantize Melody…
The Quantize Melody… and Quantize Soloist…menu commands open the Quantize dialog, where all or part of the
Melody and Soloist tracks can be quantized. The dialog and settings are identical for both tracks.
Resolution
Choose the division you would like the track quantized to. Choosing 16 will quantize to 16th notes.
Starting at Bar# and Chorus #
Quantization will begin at the place you select and applied for the number of bars.
#Bars to quantize
Leave at 999 to quantize the entire track, or specify 1 or more bars.
Quantize durations %
Choose 100% if you want the notes quantized exactly to the division. Otherwise, the notes will be moved
the % toward the target quantization.
Quantize Start Times. By default, this option is set to “Yes.” If you don't want the beginnings of the
notes quantized, set it to “No.”
Quantize Durations. This quantizes the END of the notes. By default, this is set to “Off.”
Humanize w/ straight feel and Humanize w/ swing feel
Band-in-a-Box uses intelligent humanization routines, which can humanize a melody from one, feel to another, from
one tempo to another, and vary the amount of swing in 8th notes (but not randomly). The results are very musical
with natural sounding MIDI melodies.
Humanize Melody…
Opens the Quantize to New Tempo or Feel dialog. The humanize effect is broken down into 5 main categories:
Tempo, Lateness, 8th Note Spacing, Legato, and Feel.
Transpose Melody…
Transpose the melody track without affecting the other tracks in the song.
Copy 1st chorus to all song
This stretches the melody track out over the entire song (all choruses).
Kill entire melody
Erases the melody track and any data that was contained therein.
Kill Melody Choruses
Eliminates the Melody from the First Chorus, Middle Choruses, or Last Chorus as selected from a list box.
272
Chapter 14: Reference
Adjust Level of Melody…
Allows you to increase or decrease the volume (velocity) of the Melody track without affecting the other tracks.
TimeShift Melody (ticks)…
Allows you to move the Melody forwards or backwards in small increments relative to the rest of the song tracks.
(Measured in ticks or parts per quarter, PPQ.)
Insert Beats In Melody
Allows you to insert a blank beat or beats into the song relative to the current time signature.
Delete Beats in Melody
Allows you to delete a beat or beats from the song relative to the current time signature.
Copy to Soloist Track
Copies the entire contents of the Melody track to the Soloist Track. Useful for a temporary holding area for your
Melody or bouncing tracks.
Move to Soloist Track
Copies the entire contents of the Melody track and erases the original data from the Melody track, preparing it for a
new track or data.
Swap Melody and Soloist Track
This performs a “double copy/move” so that the data that was in the Melody track is transferred to the Soloist track
and visa versa. This is also known as track bouncing.
Melodist – Generate Chords and Mel launches the Melodist feature.
Melody Maker
These sub-menu items allow you to edit Melodist files using the Melody Maker.
Track Type
Normally you'd leave the track type set to Single. But you can set it to:
- Guitar – Channels 11 to 16 will display on the guitar as strings 11 to 16, TAB will show, the notation will be up
an octave, and the MIDI file will contain the channels preserved.
- Multi – All channels are preserved and output on the channels. This would be useful for importing an entire
MIDI file, and playing it from the Melody channel (using a silent style).
- Piano – In this mode, channels 8 and 9 are treated as the left and right hand of a piano part.
Note: When saving a MIDI file and the track type is Guitar, any notes on the guitar channels (11 to 16) are preserved, so that any
fret positions are preserved. (Channels 11 to 16 correspond to strings 1 to 6, so that a G5 note on Channel 11 would be shown on
the high E string at the third fret.)
Embellish Melody during playback
This toggles the Melody Embellisher feature on or off.
Embellish Melody Dialog…
The Melody Embellisher dialog opens, allowing you to customize the settings of the Embellisher, choose an
embellisher type from presets, and make a particular Embellishment permanent.
Chapter 14: Reference
273
Convert Harmony to Melody Track
Converts a single line Melody track to include the current harmony selection.
Remove Harmony (or guitar solo) from Melody Track
Removes a harmony from a track, providing that the harmony was put there by Band-in-a-Box in the first place
using the Convert Harmony to Melody Track command.
Generate Guitar Chord Solo…
Opens the Select Guitarist dialog for generating a guitar chord solo.
Rechannel to Guitar Display…
This takes a melody, and converts it to Guitar Channels 11 to 16. When it encounters a chord, it will determine the
fret position that it's most possible to play that chord with. Otherwise, if it’s a single note, it will play it at the
current position at the guitar neck. If you want to convert an existing melody to a customized Guitar part, this
command is a good starting point, and you can edit the track further to achieve a better result.
Utilities
A Utilities sub-menu has utility functions to eliminate note overlap and transpose the Melody.
274
Chapter 14: Reference
Eliminate Note Overlap – Preserve Double Stops / Eliminate Note Overlap – Remove Double Stops eliminates
note overlap while double stops are either preserved or eliminated.
Transpose One Octave DOWN / Transpose One Octave UP transposes the Melody part one octave in either
direction. This is often useful if the Melody instrument has been changed. Transposing can be done while the song
plays.
Transpose Waltz Melody & Soloist to 4/4
If you have a song with a 3/4 time signature, you can instantly hear it as a 4/4 feel.
To use this feature, load in any song in 3/4 time. Then load in a 4/4 style. If there’s a Melody (or Soloist) present,
you’ll be asked if it’s OK to change the Melody from 3/4 to 4/4. If you click YES to that, the transformation will
occur and you can listen to the Melody in 4/4 time.
If you click NO to the offer to transform the Melody, you can still convert it later by choosing Melody | Edit |
Utilities | Transform 3/4 to 4/4. Note that if you choose the manual command, the Melody prior to transformation
should have 6 beats before bar 1 beat 1 of the Melody begins (as it normally would in a 3/4 style)
Transpose 4/4 Melody & Soloist to Waltz
You can automatically transform any 4/4 song/melody to a Waltz 3/4 feel. To use this feature, load in any song in
4/4 time. Then load in a Waltz style. If there’s a Melody (or Soloist) present, you’ll be asked if it’s OK to change
the Melody from 4/4 to 3/4. If you click YES to that, the transformation will occur and you can listen to the Melody
in 3/4 time.
If you click NO to the offer to transform the Melody, you can still convert it later by choosing Melody | Edit |
Utilities | Transform 4/4 to 3/4. Note that if you choose the manual command, the Melody prior to transformation
should have 8 beats before bar 1 beat 1 of the Melody begins (as it normally would in a 4/4 style)
Chapter 14: Reference
275
Soloist Menu
Generate and Play a Solo... opens the Select Soloist dialog where a preset Soloist style can be selected or your own
Soloist can be defined.
Start a Soloists File… allows you to make and edit Soloist styles saved under the filename of your choice. See
Soloist Edit dialog for additional details on importing/exporting/saving Soloists.
Edit a Soloists File… opens a file dialog where you can select any Soloist file (*.Soloist) to edit. If you have not
created any of your own Soloist files or if you want to edit the one you are using, use the Edit Current Soloist File
command.
Band-in-a-Box comes with over 100 Soloists built-in. If you want to make your own or modify an existing Soloist,
use the Soloist Maker (edit) module. The Soloist Maker allows you to define the parameters essential to a soloist's
playing, such as instrument range (i.e. tenor saxophone), extra legato playing, playing more on top of the beat than
most jazz musicians, and playing straighter 8th notes than usual swing 8th notes.
In addition, you can set phrasing options, such as how long the phrase should be, and how much “space” to leave
between phrases. You can also set how “outside” the playing should be.
Edit Current Soloists file… opens the Select Soloist dialog with the currently installed Soloists file.
Refresh Soloist allows the Soloist full access to all solo ideas contained in its database. Use to refresh after several
Soloists have been made.
OK to Load Soloists w/ song
Enable this option if you want Soloists to be automatically loaded with a song that was saved with Soloist
information.
Allow Soloist Harmony (on THRU)
Enable this option to permit the Soloist to utilize the Harmony features. This will allow the Soloist to make a
harmonized solo with the harmony of your choice. See the Select Soloist dialog for additional details.
Edit Soloist Track
This menu command opens a sub-menu of editing options.
Import Soloist from MIDI File allows you to import MIDI data from a file (*.MID) into the Soloist track.
Import Soloist from Clipboard allows you to import MIDI data that has been pasted into the clipboard (e.g.,
from a sequencer such as PowerTracks).
Record Soloist … records a MIDI part to the Soloist track instead of recording to the Melody track.
Record Soloist From Bar # … records at the current location of the highlight cell. When you click to select
the bar to begin recording a prompt will ask you to select which chorus to record. At the end of recording the
regular Band-in-a-Box confirmation dialogs will open.
Step edit Notes… allows you to enter/edit a solo in step time from an event list.
276
Chapter 14: Reference
Quantize Soloist opens the Quantize dialog. The Humanize feature is an advanced version of this function.
Resolution per bar
Chapter 14: Reference
277
Choose the division you would like the track quantized to. Choosing 16 will quantize to 16th notes.
Starting at Bar# and Chorus #
Quantization will begin at the place you select and applied for the number of bars.
#Bars to quantize
Leave at 999 to quantize the entire track, or specify 1 or more bars.
Quantize durations %
Choose 100% if you want the notes quantized exactly to the division. Otherwise, the notes will be moved
the % toward the target quantization.
Quantize Start Times. By default, this option is set to “Yes.” If you don't want the beginnings of the
notes quantized, set it to “No.”
Quantize Durations. This quantizes the END of the notes. By default, this is set to “Off.”
Humanize w/ straight feel and Humanize w/ swing feel
Band-in-a-Box uses intelligent humanization routines, which can humanize a Soloist from one feel to another,
from one tempo to another, and vary the amount of swing in 8th notes (but not randomly). The results are very
musical, with natural sounding MIDI solos.
Humanize Soloist … opens the Soloist: Quantize to New Tempo or Feel dialog. The humanize effect is
broken down into 5 main categories: Tempo, Lateness, 8th Note Spacing, Legato, and Feel.
Transpose Soloist … allows you to transpose the Soloist track without affecting the other tracks in the song.
Copy 1st chorus to all song stretches the Soloist track out over the entire song (i.e. first, last, and middle
choruses).
Kill entire Soloist erases the soloist track and any data that was contained therein.
Kill Soloist Choruses eliminates the Soloist from the First Chorus, Middle Choruses, or Last Chorus as
selected from a list box.
Adjust Level of Soloist … allows you to increase or decrease the volume (velocity) of the Soloist track without
affecting the other tracks.
TimeShift Soloist Part (ticks) … allows you to move the Soloist forward or backwards in small increments
relative to the rest of the song tracks. (Measured in ticks or parts per quarter, PPQ.)
Insert Beats in Soloist allows you to insert a blank beat or beats into the song relative to the current time
signature.
Delete Beats from Soloist allows you to delete a beat or beats from the song relative to the current time
signature.
Copy to Melody Track copies the entire contents of the Soloist track to the Melody Track. This is useful for a
temporary holding area for your soloist or for bouncing tracks.
Move to Melody Track copies the entire contents of the Soloist track and erases the original data from the
Soloist track, preparing it for a new track or data.
Swap Melody and Soloist Track performs a “double copy/move” so that the data that was in the Soloist track
is transferred to the Melody track and vice versa. This is also known as track bouncing.
Convert Harmony to Soloist Track… converts a single line Soloist track to include the current harmony
selection.
Remove Harmony (or Guit solo) from Soloist Track removes a harmony from a track, providing that the
harmony was put there by Band-in-a-Box in the first place using the Convert Harmony to Soloist Track
command.
Generate Guitar Chord Solo opens the Guitar feature dialog for generating a guitar chord solo.
Rechannel to Guitar Display converts channels on a track to channels 11 to 16. Channels 11 to 16 are used by
Band-in-a-Box to indicate strings 1 to 6 of a guitar. It uses the current position marker on the guitar for this
command.
Utilities
There is a Utilities sub-menu that has utility functions to eliminate note overlap and transpose the Solo.
278
Chapter 14: Reference
Eliminate Note Overlap – Preserve Double Stops / Eliminate Note Overlap – Remove Double Stops
opens a Choose Range dialog to select the range of bars where note overlap will be eliminated while
double stops are either preserved or eliminated.
Transpose One Octave DOWN / Transpose One Octave UP transposes the Soloist part one octave in
either direction. This is often useful if the Soloist instrument has been changed. Transposing can be done
while the song plays.
Track Type
Normally you'd leave the track type set to Single, but you can set it to:
- Multi (16) Channel – All channels are preserved and output on the
channels. This would be useful for importing an entire MIDI file, and
playing it from the Melody channel (using a silent style).
-
Guitar – Channels 11 to 16 will display on the guitar as strings 11 to 16, TAB will show, the notation will be up
an octave, and the MIDI file will contain the channels preserved.
Piano – In this mode, channels 8 and 9 are treated as the left and right hand of a piano part.
Chapter 14: Reference
279
Harmony Menu
Melody Harmony…
Shows the current Melody harmony selection. Click to open the Select Melody Harmony dialog.
Thru Harmony…
Shows the current Thru harmony selection. Click to open the Select Thru Harmony dialog.
Favorite Melody Harmonies…
This option brings up your favorite 50 Harmony styles (based on recent usage) and allows you to choose one to use
on the Melody track.
Favorite Thru Harmonies…
This option brings up your favorite 50 Harmony styles (based on recent usage) and allows you to choose one to use
on the Thru track.
Start a New Harmonies File… allows you to make and edit Harmony styles saved under the filename of your
choice.
Edit a Harmonies File… allows you to edit a Harmony file that is in your \bb directory.
Edit Current Harmonies File… allows you to edit the Harmony file that is currently loaded on your system.
OK to Load Harm. w/ songs
Toggle this option “On” if you want to load any harmony settings that were saved/embedded in a given song.
Save Harmony with this song
280
Chapter 14: Reference
Toggle this option “On” to allow Band-in-a-Box to embed the Save Patches and Harmonies W/Song dialog where
you can chose to save the Melody and/or Thru harmony settings for the currently open song so that they may be
recalled automatically later.
Change Harmony with new chord
Toggle this option “On” to allow the program to vary the harmony characteristics (i.e. inversions) each time a new
chord is encountered in the song.
Allow Melody Harmony
Toggle this option “On” to allow the Melody MIDI channels to utilize the harmony features.
Allow Thru Harmony
Toggle this option “On” to allow the Thru MIDI channels to utilize the harmony features.
Allow Soloist Harmony (on THRU)
Toggle this option “On” to allow the Thru MIDI channels to utilize the harmony features for the Soloist track.
Convert Harmony to Melody Track…
This converts a single line Melody track to include the current harmony selection.
Convert Harmony to Soloist Track…
This converts a single line Soloist track to include the current harmony selection (On the Thru harmony).
Use Passing harmonies for THRU
When you play along on a MIDI keyboard (or the wizard), and use a Thru harmony, you can use passing harmonies.
For example, on a C7 chord, with an Ab note, the harmony might be a B diminished chord, which is a passing
harmony.
MIDI Menu
MIDI Settings
The MIDI Settings dialog box allows you to setup settings for each part (Bass/Drums/Piano etc.). You can also set
the Harmony channels by pressing the [Harmony] button inside this dialog box.
Chapter 14: Reference
281
**Select MIDI Driver or Apple DLS Synth…
Opens the MIDI Drivers dialog where you can choose from the installed drivers.
When CoreMIDI has been selected as the MIDI driver the selections in the MIDI menu changes to provide access to
CoreMIDI features.
282
Chapter 14: Reference
CoreMIDI Audio MIDI Setup launches the Apple Audio MIDI Setup dialog.
**CoreMIDI (choose ports) opens the Select Ports/Instruments dialog.
**Select MIDI Driver or Apple DLS Synth returns to the MIDI Drivers dialog.
MacOS X CoreMIDI
The MIDI | CoreMIDI Audio MIDI Setup menu item opens the Apple Audio MIDI Setup dialog, which controls the
system settings for audio and MIDI.
There are two separate windows for Audio Devices and MIDI Devices, selected by clicking on the one you want in
the bar at the top of the dialog.
Each window has its own Apple Help topic, which opens by clicking on the [?] button.
Chapter 14: Reference
283
CoreMIDI is the OS X standard MIDI driver method. CoreMIDI facilitates communication with external MIDI
devices, and it also enables inter-application “piping” of MIDI data between MIDI applications.
This opens the Select Ports/Instruments dialog where MIDI ports are configured.
When Mac OS X CoreMIDI has been selected in the MIDI Drivers dialog (MIDI | **Select MIDI Driver or Apple
DLS Synth) the Select Ports/Instruments dialog opens for your assignments.
Click on the [CoreMIDI Help] button for detailed instructions and also see the
CoreMIDI and Apple DLS Synth chapter..
Make General MIDI Patch Map…
Band-in-a-Box makes its patch (instrument) selections from the standardized General MIDI patch list, which is
identical to the basic set of Roland GS Patch numbers. If you are using a non-GM (General MIDI) device you will
need to remap the patch numbers for the GS instrument list by selecting the MIDI | Make General MIDI Patch Map
command.
This opens the GS Patch Numbers dialog, where you can make a customized General MIDI patch map for your
non-GM instrument.
284
Chapter 14: Reference
Type in the patch number that your synth uses for each instrument listed. For example, suppose that your sound
source has Acoustic Piano at patch location 41. In the GS Patch Numbers dialog, select the box beside Acoustic
Piano and type 41. Do the same for all of the instruments in the General MIDI patch list. If your synth doesn't have
an exact match, use a close sounding patch that it does have.
(GS Patch Numbers)
Once you have made a patch map in this way, whenever Band-in-a-Box encounters Acoustic Piano (which is
General MIDI instrument #1), it will look up this Patch Map Location and then send out Patch 41 to your
synth/sound module.
Furthermore, you will never have to refer to instruments in Band-in-a-Box by your synth's number. Instead, you'll
use the General MIDI instrument numbering (e.g., Acoustic Piano = 1). So if you are Saving a Song with Patches or
Assigning favorite instruments or combos you will still type #1 to tell Band-in-a-Box that the patch is Acoustic
Piano.
Set Favorite Patches/Combos…
For each of the 8 parts (Bass, Piano, Drums, Guitar, Strings, Melody, Soloist, and Thru) you can assign up to 10
“favorite” instruments. Once assigned, these instruments can be quickly and easily set.
Use General MIDI instrument numbers. If you use a custom patch map it will handle the conversion to your synth’s
non-GM patch numbers, always enter GM patch numbers for the favorite instruments.
A Favorite Combo is a group of patch changes (1 for each part) that are sent out as a “batch” when you send one of
the combos.
Edit Drum Kit (Note Values)…
If you have been unable to find a preset drum map that matches your synth's drum notes, then you may need to type
in the drum notes that your sound source uses. This is done in the Assign Drum Map dialog.
Chapter 14: Reference
285
If you already know the MIDI note numbers assigned to the MIDI drum kit you are using (check the manual for
your synth or drum machine) just type them into the drum map. Another way to enter them is from your MIDI
keyboard.
To do this, you need to hook your MIDI controller up to play the drum sounds from the synth or drum machine.
Play up and down the keyboard to hear all the drum sounds.
Type the MIDI note numbers for the various instruments as you find them on your drum machine or keyboard.
Save/Load MIDI Setup/Drum Kit…
Allows you to save different custom MIDI setups or load in preset or custom setups.
Send Sys-Ex File… is a command that sends SysEx information to your MIDI device.
Style Aliases
Let's say you have a new style for jazz called “Dizzy.” You can create an alias so that when Band-in-a-Box looks
for a Jazz Swing style, it will load in “Dizzy” instead, so you don't have to make changes to all your songs. And
when you have found a new favorite style, just change the alias. You can also load or save sets of “Alias” files and
share them with others.
To make an alias, click on the original style then select the style you would like to load (substitute) in its place. If
you want to type in a style name that you don't have, use the Custom button. When you have successfully made an
alias, you will notice that there will be a small arrow in the Styles box on the main screen indicating that you have
an alias loaded.
286
Chapter 14: Reference
Choose Patch from Higher Bank…
This will display a list of higher bank patches as found in *.PAT text files. Choose a .PAT file from the Synth Kits
folder.
Insert Current MIDI Chord
Enters the last MIDI chord played on the MIDI controller into the current location in the song.
Output chords to external device…
This is useful with an external arranger that can read chords in real time. Band-in-a-Box will output chords in root
position on the selected channel during playback.
Thru Transpose Settings…
Transpose the Thru part, which is the live playing on the MIDI keyboard, so you can play any song in any key.
Filter for Recording…
Used to filter the MIDI information that is recorded to the Melody track.
Return to Factory Settings…
This will return program options to factory defaults, excluding MIDI Drivers and patch map set in the MIDI
Settings dialog.
What add-ons do I have?
One of the greatest strengths of Band-in-a-Box is the ability to add-on and enhance the program through add-on
RealTracks, RealDrums, Styles, Soloist, and Melodist disks. The list off available add-ons is large, and it keeps
growing. The "What Add-ons" feature scans your computer's Band-in-a-Box directory and displays what add-ons
are and aren't found.
Choose MIDI | What add-ons do I have? to analyze your current installation and see which add-ons have been
found.
Chapter 14: Reference
287
This dialog displays the add-on styles and soloist disks you have installed in your Band-in-a-Box program folder. If
any styles or soloist add-ons incorrectly appear in the "Not Found" window try reinstalling the appropriate add-ons
from the original disc or download.
288
Chapter 14: Reference
GS Menu
Reset Sound Canvas to Factory… resets the module to factory settings.
Reset Sound Canvas And Send BB… sends a reset message to the Sound Canvas and then sends the startup Bandin-a-Box patch changes.
Adjust Master Volume… sets the overall output level for Band-in-a-Box.
Reverb Type … or Chorus Type … Roland GS instruments allow different type of reverb and chorus settings.
These settings boxes allow you to make a selection.
Assign Part/Chan/Patch/Bank… If you are using a Roland GS synthesizer or sound module you can customize its
settings with the GS | Assign Part/Chan/Patch/Bank menu command.
The Part Settings/Roland GS are for GS compatible synthesizers only.
Chapter 14: Reference
289
These synthesizers have 16 parts. The default is for part 1 to be channel 1, part 2 channel 2, etc., but you can change
a part to another channel. This allows you to use the same channel for 2 parts, so that you hear a layer of 2
instruments playing the same part.
Send General MIDI Mode ON sets the external module to General MIDI mode. This command will ensure that
the module is ready to accept GM-specific MIDI data such as Bank, Controller, and Patch information.
Send GS mode On Message (Roland) / Send XG Mode On (Yamaha): Since the inception of the GM (General
MIDI) standard, there have been two major subsets/extensions of this standard - GS (Roland) and XG (Yamaha).
Therefore, in addition to the GM Mode-on menu item feature there are additional commands to send a GS mode ON
or a XG mode ON message at any time by accessing the GS menu.
Auto-Send GM mode at start sends a “General MIDI mode on” message when the program boots up.
Auto-Send GS mode at start sends a Roland GS system on message when the Band-in-a-Box program boots up.
Auto-Send XG mode at start sends a Yamaha XG system on message when the Band-in-a-Box program boots up.
Panic! (send all MIDI note-offs)
This sends a sweep of all MIDI notes “Off.” Use if notes are stuck “On.”
Turn Local OFF (external MIDI keyboard)
Turn Local ON (external MIDI keyboard)
If you are hearing the information played on your keyboard played twice (an echo effect) then Turn Local OFF. If
you can’t hear what you are playing at all, set then Turn Local ON.
When program quits, turn Local ON
Normally while using Band-in-a-Box the “local-off” setting for your MIDI keyboard is best, since the THRU part
will be coming from Band-in-a-Box and you don't want to hear your MIDI keyboard doubling the notes that are
being played. However, when you exit Band-in-a-Box, you might want the “local on” setting for your synthesizer
turned back on. This option defaults to true.
Set Panning to Mono / Set Panning to Stereo
Mono/Stereo menu options are available to easily switch all parts to mono or stereo. Also, if your current settings
are mono, the program will offer to convert to stereo when you exit the MIDI Driver selection dialog.
290
Chapter 14: Reference
Windows Menu
Notation Window toggles between the notation and the Chordsheet views.
Drum Window launches the animated Drum Kit.
Guitar Window launches the on-screen Guitar fretboard.
List Editor Window launches the List Edit utility for editing MIDI events.
(The Event List Editor is not present in the OS X version, though it should be added in the future.)
Switch to Next Track / Switch to Previous Track selects parts in the row of Notation buttons.
Chord Reharmonist Dialog (choose your own) shows you the current bar in the song with a list of suggested
chord progressions for the current melody, based on the melody and genre that you choose.
Auto-Generate Chord Reharmonization generates an entirely new chord progression for a complete song or a
portion of a song. Selecting this menu option opens the Reharmonist dialog.
RealDrums Settings launches the dialog for enabling RealDrums substituting them in styles and songs.
RealDrums Picker opens the list for choosing a RealDrums style for the current song.
RealTracks Settings opens the dialog for enabling RealTracks and showing notation and saving RealCharts.
RealTracks Picker opens the Assign RealTracks to Track dialog for assigning RealTracks to any BB part.
Run Audio Chord Wizard (standalone) launches the Audio Chord Wizard program.
Run Audio Chord Wizard (with Audio file) presents an Open Wave File window for the Audio Chord Wizard.
Read Chords from AudioChordWizard enters the chords into Band-in-a-Box.
Plugin Mode for Sequencer-DAW enters the plug-in mode. The Band-in-a-Box window becomes smaller and you
can use it with your DAW (GarageBand, etc.). To export a Band-in-a-Box track, drag the radio button for the part
you want to export into the blue “drop station” rectangle in the upper left corner of the main screen. When the
rectangle turns green, drag and drop it to your DAW or the Finder.
Chapter 14: Reference
291
Help Menu
Search will list all menu items related to the search term.
View Band-in-a-Box manual opens a comprehensive .pdf manual with bookmarks for reference.
Panic! All Notes Off!!
This sends a sweep of all MIDI notes “Off.” Use if notes are stuck “On.”
Visit web site www.pgmusic.com … Launches your Internet browser and loads the PG Music Inc. home page.
Keystroke Commands – “Hot Keys”
It's often faster to use keystrokes instead of picking up the mouse. We've added many keystroke “hot keys” to mute
instruments or to adjust volume, panning, reverb, chorus, or bank of instrument without using the mouse.
If a hot key is not performing as expected, it might be because the operating system has assigned a different function
to that key. You can disable the operating system hot keys assignments by going to the Apple System
Preferences/Keyboard & Mouse and clicking on the Keyboard Shortcuts tab. Scroll down to find the key you are
looking for, and uncheck it in the “On” column. Then your Band-in-a-Box hot key should work properly.
Keystroke List
This is a list of keystroke “hot keys.” These keys are also listed on the pull down menus beside the function.
Play the song
A
Set the first bar of the Chorus
B
Copy
C
Delete the Highlighted Chord Area
D
Set the Last (Ending) bar of the Chorus
E
Display and edit Favorite Patches Dialog
F
Reset Sound Canvas and send BB MIDI
G
settings
Melody Harmony
H
Insert x bars in the highlighted chord area
I
Jukebox play
J
Previous jukebox song
[
Next jukebox song
]
Open Main Settings dialog (title, key, tempo,
K
etc.)
Set the number of choruses in a song
L
Display and edit the MIDI Settings
M
New song
N
Open song from disk
O
Print current song
P
Quit the program
Q
Replay already constructed song
R
292
Chapter 14: Reference
Save already open song to disk
Thru Harmony
Load style from disk
Paste
Set the number of lead in bars
Cut
Load a “SETUP.DK” file from disk
Undo song settings
Send General MIDI mode On
Panic! All notes Off
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
=
/
Additional Hot Keys
Press [=] 4 times to set tempo and play a song.
Press [+] to just set the tempo.
Records a melody to the currently loaded song.
Plays the song from the current cursor position.
Enters lyrics in the Lyrics window.
Moves the cursor to the right.
Moves the cursor to the left.
Help
Save song
Save song with patches
Open song
Load favorite song
Load songs with melodies
Play song
Select Soloist
Quit + end program
Edit current bar options
Melodist Generate Chords/Melody
Save MIDI file
Open filtered by style
Refresh Soloist
Jukebox start/stop
Load next song
Choose a user style
Choose a favorite style
Edit user style
Allow Melody harmony
Select Melody harmony
Allow Thru harmony
Select Thru harmony
Panic – all notes off
[=]
[+]
r
x
l
tab
Shift+Tab
F1, Shift+1, Ctrl+F1
F2
+F2
F3
Shift+F3
+F3
F4
Shift+F4
+F4
F5
Shift+F5
F6
F7
Shift+F7
F8
Shift+8
F9
Shift+F9
+F9
F10
Shift+F10
F11
Shift+F11
F12
Chapter 14: Reference
293
Quick Song Settings
These are for entering songs quickly in the Chordsheet and Notation windows. Typing special words, instead of
chord names, will make the following settings:
begin <Enter>
- sets the beginning of the chorus to the current bar
chorusend <Enter>
- sets the end of the chorus to the current bar
end <Enter>
- sets the end of the song to the current bar
tkc <Enter>
- sets key signature to C, tkbb would set it to Bb
trc <Enter>
- transposes song to key of C
t125 <Enter>
- sets tempo to 125
Direction
Arrows
[ ]
< >
l
p
Move the cursor in the appropriate direction.
Adjust the tempo by increments of 5.
Advance page # in either direction.
Displays the Lyric Mode. Hit ESC or '=' to exit.
Set/Advance Part Marker at cursor location.
During Playback
delete
[+] or [=]
[+]
shift [+]
shift [+]
0+9
esc
Ctrl+ +1
Pauses Song / Resumes Playing Song.
Increments Patch number by +1.
Decrements Patch number by +1.
Increments Patch number by +5.
Decrements Patch number by +5.
Select Favorite Instruments/Combos
Stops Song
Transposes Melody down 1 octave
Muting Parts
You can also mute a Part by Option-Clicking its button at the top-left of the Main Window.
Mutes the Combo (all the instruments)
2
Mutes the Bass
3
Mutes the Piano
4
Mutes the Drums
5
Mutes the Guitar
6
Mutes the Strings
8
Mutes the Melody
9
Mutes the THRU
0
Selecting Parts
Selects the Combo
Ctrl+2
Hold down Ctrl+Shift and the letter to change the value for the selected part:
Decrease/Increase Reverb
E,R
Decrease/Increase Chorus
T,Y
Decrease/Increase Panning
U,I
Decrease/Increase Bank
O,P
Decrease/Increase Volume
Q,W
Holding down Ctrl+Shift and 1+9 and 0 keys (on top row of keyboard) selects favorite instrument patch.
Hold down Ctrl+Shift and [+] and [=] keys to decrease /increase patch by 1.
294
Chapter 14: Reference
For example, let's change the Piano part to Rhodes Piano using keystrokes.
1. Press Ctrl+4 to select the Piano part.
2. Press Ctrl+Shift+2 to select the Favorite #2. That is Rhodes Piano.
Chord List
(Commonly used chords are displayed here in bold type)
(Major chords)
C, CMAJ, C6, CMAJ7, CMAJ9, CMAJ13, C69, CMAJ7#5,
C5b, Caug, C+,
CMAJ9#11, CMAJ13#11,
(Minor chords)
Cm, Cm6, Cm7, Cm9, Cm11, Cm13,
C-7: You can type C-7 for Cm7 (i.e. use the minus sign) or C7-9 for C7b9
Cmaug, Cm#5,
CmMAJ7,
(Half diminished)
Cm7b5,
(Diminished)
Cdim,
(Dominant 7th chords )
C7,7+, C9+, C13+, C13, C7b13, C7#11, C13#11, C7#11b13, C9,
C9b13, C9#11, C13#11, C9#11b13, C7b9, C13b9, C7b9b13, C7b9#11,
C13b9#11, C7b9#11b13, C7#9, C13#9, C7#9b13, C9#11, C13#9#11, C7#9#11b13,
C7b5, C13b5, C7b5b13, C9b5, C9b5b13, C7b5b9, C13b5b9, C7b5b9b13,
C7b5#9, C13b5#9, C7b5#9b13, C7#5, C13#5, C7#5#11, C13#5#11, C9#5,
C9#5#11, C7#5b9, C13#5b9, C7#5b9#11, C13#5b9#11, C7#5#9, C13#5#9#11,
C7#5#9#11, C13#5#9#11
( suspended 4 chords )
Csus,C7sus,C9sus,
C13sus, C7susb13, C7sus#11, C13sus#11, C7sus#11b13,
C9susb13, C9sus#11, C13sus#11, C9sus#11b13, C7susb9, C13susb9,
C7susb9b13, C7susb9#11,
C13susb9#11, C7susb9#11b13, C7sus#9, C13sus#9, C7sus#9b13, C9sus#11,
C13sus#9#11, C7sus#9#11b13,
C7susb5, C13susb5, C7susb5b13, C9susb5, C9susb5b13, C7susb5b9,
C13susb5b9, C7susb5b9b13, C7susb5#9, C13susb5#9, C7susb5#9b13,
C7sus#5, C13sus#5,
C7sus#5#11, C13sus#5#11, C9sus#5,
C9sus#5#11, C7sus#5b9, C13sus#5b9,
C7sus#5b9#11, C13sus#5b9#11, C7sus#5#9, C13sus#5#9#11, C7sus#5#9#11,
C13sus#5#9#11,
Notes about entering chords:
- It is not necessary to type upper or lower case. The program will sort this out for you.
- Any chord may be entered with an alternate root (“Slash Chord”) e.g.: C7/E
= C7 with E bass
- Separate chords with commas to enter 2 chords in a 2 beat cell e.g.: Dm7,G7
Chapter 14: Reference
295
New chords added:
• C5b: This is C flat 5. It is spelled this way to avoid confusion. C2 C5 C4 C69 C7alt Cm7#5
Chord Shortcut Keys: Speed up chord entry with these shortcut keys.
• J = Maj7 (To type CMaj7, just type CJ. It will be entered as CMaj7.)
• H = m7b5 (H stands for Half diminished)
• D =dim
• S =Sus
Files and Folders
Band-in-a-Box Folder
The Band-in-a-Box program installs by default to its own Band-in-a-Box folder inside the /Applications folder.
Unless there is an important reason to install it to a different location, we suggest that you accept the default
location.
Band-in-a-Box
The /Band-in-a-Box folder has a clean look with only one program file in the folder (the Band-in-a-Box
application). The rest of the files are in subfolders.
AudioChordWizard
The powerful Audio Chord Wizard feature can be run as a stand-alone program from this folder to interpret the
chords from popular audio file types such as MP4, M4a, AIFF, and CD audio.
Data
These files contain the lists and data for the various Band-in-a-Box features. Most of them are not directly edited,
but user edits to the program features are saved to them. For example, if you add or make new styles and rebuild the
list in the StylePicker the file BBW.LST is updated.
One file that can be edited is pgshort.txt. Follow the directions given to add your own shortcuts for entering chords
in Band-in-a-Box.
Drums
This folder has subfolders containing the files for all of the RealDrums sets installed in your program. It is the
default location recognized by Band-in-a-Box when it installs RealDrums sets and generates a RealDrums part.
If this folder is moved or the RealDrums files are installed in a custom location, the new location must be entered in
the RealDrums Settings dialog so that Band-in-a-Box knows where to find them.
296
Chapter 14: Reference
Drums – Demos
Every RealDrums style has a Band-in-a-Box demo song, which can be loaded directly from this folder as a song file.
Once a demo song has been played from this folder, you can then use the SongPicker (Select Song by Title) dialog
to choose songs from a list.
Manuals
This folder includes a manual with a guide to latest features in the current Band-in-a-Box upgrade, Band-in-a-Box --- Upgrade Manual.pdf, plus a recent version of the full manual named Band-in-a-Box ---- Mac Manual.pdf. These
files are bookmarked for easy reference, and individual pages can be printed out as required.
Helpful supplements are sometimes included, such as the Band-in-a-Box CoreMIDI help.pdf that explains how to
set up external MIDI devices to the Macintosh.
Melodist Demos
These are Band-in-a-Box songs made with the Melodist feature that generates complete songs with chords and
melodies. You can select individual songs to hear an example of the different Melodist styles, or you can play them
all by clicking on the [Juke Songs Now] button in the Melodist dialog.
Preferences
The Preferences you set in the program are saved in the Preferences folder, and this folder also has a file named
Intrface_X86.BBW with all the program settings including MIDI and audio driver setup. If this file is removed to
the trash the program will open like a new installation the next time it runs. It will prompt for all of the initial setup
selections. This is useful as a “global reset” if system settings have been changed by accident and are difficult to
restore.
RealTracks
This folder has subfolders containing the files for all of the RealTracks instruments installed in your program. It is
the default location recognized by Band-in-a-Box when it installs RealTracks sets and generates RealTracks.
If this folder is moved or the RealTracks files are installed in a custom location, the new location must be entered in
the RealTracks Settings dialog so that Band-in-a-Box knows where to find them.
RealTracks – Demos
Every RealTracks instrument has a Band-in-a-Box demo song, which can be loaded directly from this folder as a
song file. Once a demo song has been played from this folder you can then use the SongPicker (Select Song by
Title) dialog to choose songs from a list.
Soloist Demos
These are Band-in-a-Box songs made with the many soloist styles available. There are subfolders for every Soloist
set. Once you select a song from the File | Open menu command you can use the [Song] button to choose from a
list of songs in the subfolder.
Soloists
Soloist files are stored here, both for MIDI soloists and solos that use RealTracks instruments. If you install soloist
add-on sets this is where to put them.
Songs
This is the default folder for storing your Band-in-a-Box songs, the default folder that is selected by the File | Open
Song menu command. It includes the basic Band-in-a-Box song library, and the songs you make yourself will be
stored here unless you specify a custom folder for them.
Band-in-a-Box accompaniments are saved with the file extension *.sgu. If a melody has been recorded the file
extension will be *.mgu. The “u” indicates a song made with a user-editable style.
The original 24 Band-in-a-Box styles are an exception, they use song file names ending in numbers from 1-9 and
letters from A-O, but all later styles end in “u.”
Songs and Lessons
Band-in-a-Box comes with a large library of songs that demonstrate some of the most popular styles of music as
well as songs for listening, learning, and jamming. This folder is packed with musical content for a variety of tastes
and purposes.
Chapter 14: Reference
297
Style Demos
Every Band-in-a-Box style has a demo song stored in this folder. There are a lot of them, the easiest way to play
them is to pick the style that interests you in the StylePicker dialog and then click on the [Song Demo] button to
hear the demo song for that style.
Styles
Band-in-a-Box styles use the file extension .sty and are stored in this folder. These are the styles that are listed in
the StylePicker. If you add new styles, they will be installed in this folder and added to the StylePicker list by
clicking on the [Re-Build] button.
Synth Kit Documentation
These are documents that describe the synth kits provided in the Synth Kits folder.
Synth Kits
Even though the General MIDI and GM2 patch lists have been widely adopted, Band-in-a-Box supports many other
MIDI patch lists and drum kits.
The .DK files in this folder are pre-formatted GM patch lists for most of the popular synthesizers, GM and non-GM,
in use since the introduction of Band-in-a-Box.
The .PAT files are for the patches found on higher banks GM and other synths, and include the custom bank change
commands to provide access to any patch on any MIDI synthesizer.
Users can write custom .DK and .PAT files and save them to this folder.
Tutorials
This folder contains the files provided for use with the tutorials found in the help file.
298
Chapter 14: Reference
PG Music Inc.
Band-in-a-Box
®
is protected by copyright and is the property of
PG Music Inc. and its licensors.
Copyright © 1989-2010 PG Music Inc.
All rights reserved.
PG MUSIC INC.
29 Cadillac Avenue
Victoria, BC V8Z 1T3
Canada
Contacts:
E-mail: [email protected]
Phone: toll free in the United States and Canada
1-800-268-6272, 1-888-PG-MUSIC (746-8742),
Or 1-250-475-2874 (tolls apply)
Universal International Freephone Service:
Outside of the United States and Canada (where available).
+ 800-4PGMUSIC (800-4746-8742)
Fax: toll free in the United States and Canada
1-877-475-1444,
or 1-250-475-2937 (tolls apply)
Technical Support:
Phone: toll free in the United States and Canada
1-866-9TECHPG (866-983-2474),
Or 1-250-475-2708 (tolls apply)
E-mail: [email protected]
Live Internet Chat: www.pgmusic.com
Be sure to visit the FAQ pages at www.pgmusic.com for information about known troubleshooting issues as well as the latest
technical support bulletins.
PG Music Inc.
299
Index
Bar settings ................................. 99
Bar/Beat settings............... 102, 213
Bass part type ........................... 199
build chords ...................... 102, 213
Builder button........................... 212
change patches............................ 47
change style .............................. 100
Channels
Setting................................................................131
chord......................................... 101
outputting to external device .............................135
Chord breaks..................... 123, 204
Chord Builder ............. 14, 101, 213
dialog .................................................................102
Chord display types .............. 40, 97
chord options .................... 102, 212
Chord Preview .......................... 101
chord progression ..................... 211
Chord settings............................. 94
chord shorcuts........................... 130
Chord Subs button .................... 212
Chord Substitution Wizard ....... 209
auto-substitution ................................................210
comments...........................................................209
chord substitutions............ 209, 212
range of bars ......................................................212
undo ...................................................................210
Chord Substitutions Dialog....... 210
types...................................................................210
chord tones................................ 144
Chord tutor................................ 209
Chord Wizard ....... 14, 60, 103, 196
chord options .....................................................199
dialog .................................................................196
summary ............................................................202
Chords
List.....................................................................295
Typing in -how to ................................................90
chordsheet................................. 212
Chordsheet............................ 40, 89
bar settings...........................................................99
breaks...................................................................91
2 bar ending
early .....................................................................87
generate................................................................87
A2 Transpose............................ 151
alternate root..................... 102, 213
anticipations.............................. 167
Apple Audio MIDI Setup ......... 253
Assign RealTracks to Tracks ...... 72
Audio
generate RealDrums ..........................................179
generate RealTracks ..........................................179
render MIDI track..............................................180
render song ........................................................180
rendering............................................................180
Audio Chord Wizard ................ 188
chord detection ..................................................190
chords from MP4 ...............................................186
chordsheet..........................................................188
chordsheet overviewchord sheet........................188
controls ..............................................................187
errors..................................................................191
fine tuning..........................................................192
key signature......................................................192
more features .....................................................189
note bars.............................................................189
notes display ......................................................195
opening files ......................................................190
special cases.......................................................191
drastic tempo changes....................................194
odd length bars...............................................194
window ..............................................................186
zoom ..................................................................195
Audio Reverb............................ 112
parameters..........................................................125
presets ................................................................126
settings.......................................................113, 124
Auto-Chord Substitution dialog 211
settings...............................................................211
auto-substitution ....................... 210
Band-in-a-Box
guitar chord solo ................................................159
bar settings.................................. 65
300
Index
chord entry...........................................................40
color...................................................................123
context menu .....................................................102
copy and paste .....................................................96
delete bars............................................................91
erase chords .........................................................91
font size .............................................................123
held chords...........................................................92
insert bars.............................................................91
part markers .........................................................98
pushes ..................................................................93
rests......................................................................91
shortcuts...............................................................91
shots.....................................................................92
typing chords .......................................................90
chorus
unfolding............................................................129
Clipboard .................................. 175
comping .................................... See
Concert Pitch adjust.................. 133
copy chords................................. 62
Copyright.................................. 299
CoreMIDI ......................... 253, 284
custom chord shortcuts ............... 91
pgshortc.txt ..........................................................91
shortcut.txt ...........................................................91
customize
patches .................................................................34
DAW plug-in mode .................. 126
De-Strauss
convert 3/4 to 4/4...............................................275
Digitech Vocalist ...................... 134
doubled notes............................ 167
Drum window
enhancements ....................................................215
Drums
Computer 'QWERTY' Keys...............................215
Multi-Note Instruments .....................................215
Sizing Window ..................................................216
Transport Controls.............................................216
Embellisher checkbox................. 35
Embellishment.................... 87, 266
Endings ....................................... 87
Expand...................................... 128
extension........................... 102, 213
extra notes................................. 167
Fakebook .................................. 146
favorite combos .......................... 33
favorite instruments .................... 33
favorite styles...................... 40, 105
filter styles ................................ 107
Freeze tracks............................. 113
From button .............................. 111
grace notes ................................ 167
GS menu ................................... 289
Guitar
display settings ..................................................205
launching ...........................................................205
Toolbar ..............................................................206
window ..............................................................205
Guitar Chord Solo..................... 159
about ..................................................................161
Guitar enhancements
fret position........................................................274
Guitar fretboard ........................ 205
Guitar Styles ............................. 239
guitar channels...................................................239
information ........................................................239
inversions...........................................................239
patterns ..............................................................239
tracks .................................................................239
voicings..............................................................239
Guitar Tutor .............................. 208
chord tutor .........................................................209
fretboard ............................................................208
Guitarist ............................ 159, 205
chord solo ..........................................................159
generate chord solo............................................159
redo....................................................................161
save solo ............................................................162
Select Guitarist ..................................................159
settings...............................................................159
Guitarist Editor ......................... 249
chord embellishments ........................................252
chord types.........................................................251
Guitarist Maker......................... 249
Hard drive version ........................ 8
harmonize melody ...................... 53
301
Harmony
changing ............................................................101
setting channels..................................................133
Harmony area ............................. 40
Harmony Enhancements........... 145
convert harmony to notation..............................145
remove .......................................................145, 146
Hold button............................... 111
How to register ......................... 307
humanize................................... 167
Humanize
melody and solo.................................................177
IAC port.................................... 256
import chords.............. 61, 103, 196
part file...............................................................201
redo section........................................................201
import MIDI chords.................... 14
Installation and setup .................... 7
MIDI and audio .....................................................8
MIDI drivers........................................................10
USB hard drive ......................................................8
instrument panel ......................... 32
instrument settings...................... 33
intelligent guitar parts............... 239
intelligent guitar style ............... 239
interpret chords
auto interpret......................................................197
custom settings ..................................................197
Intros........................................... 88
Jazz down chords...................... 104
Jazz up chords........................... 104
jukebox ....................................... 59
Jukebox..................................... 136
JukeBox .................................... 135
Hide Titles .........................................................136
Options ..............................................................135
key ........................................ 17, 62
Kill Intro ................................... 152
Kill Melodist............................. 152
Kill Soloist................................ 152
License.......................................... 2
loading
songs....................................................................38
styles ..................................................................105
302
loading songs .............................. 15
local off............................. 122, 290
Local On
automatic ...........................................................122
Looping .................................... 138
lyrics ........................................... 67
Main Screen
instrument settings...............................................33
overview ..............................................................31
piano keyboard ....................................................32
status bar..............................................................32
synthesizer window .............................................32
Melodies
Recording ..........................................................172
Melodist...................................... 59
64 bar form ........................................................151
A2 Transpose.....................................................151
Allow Style Changes .........................................151
Auto-Titles.........................................................151
Favorites ............................................................153
Form ..................................................................151
Generate Less than a Complete Song ................153
Generating Complete Songs ..............................153
Go To #..............................................................152
Insert Bass Pedals ..............................................151
JukeBox .............................................................154
Kill Intro ............................................................152
Kill Melody .......................................................152
Kill Soloist.........................................................152
Memo.................................................................152
Minor Key % .....................................................151
Number of Choruses..........................................151
Preset Buttons....................................................151
Replace Thru Form............................................152
Selection Dialog ................................................149
Solo in Middle Choruses ...................................151
Using .................................................................153
Write To Track ..................................................153
Melodist Maker
Anticipations in Phrases ....................................248
Choose Unusual Chord Progressions.................247
Chord Substitutions Throughout the Form ........248
Dialog ................................................................245
Force Long Phrases ...........................................247
Mix Minor and Major Chord Progressions........248
Number of Variations ........................................248
Simple 1st and 2nd endings .................................247
Tempo Range.....................................................248
Transpose A2 Section........................................248
Unique Themes..................................................247
Unusual Placed Phrasing ...................................247
Melody
Step Edit ............................................................174
Melody Embellisher ........... 35, 164
advanced settings...............................................168
anticipations.......................................................167
auto embellish....................................................166
button.................................................................164
checkbox............................................................164
dialog .................................................................165
doubled notes.....................................................167
extra notes..........................................................167
grace notes .........................................................167
humanize............................................................167
memo .................................................................166
octave.................................................................167
presets ................................................................166
settings.......................................................164, 167
turns ...................................................................167
vibrato................................................................168
Melody menu............................ 271
Melody track............................. 175
memo .................................. 67, 130
Menus
GS......................................................................289
Melody...............................................................271
Soloist................................................................276
Song...................................................................264
Windows............................................................291
MIDI
Channels
Setting............................................................131
drivers ................................................................131
Files
Standard.........................................................175
Note Offs ...........................................................133
settings...............................................................131
setup...................................................................130
sync....................................................................133
MIDI chord entry........................ 13
MIDI drivers............................. 253
Apple DLS.........................................................255
CoreMIDI ..........................................................253
MIDI file
choose tracks .....................................................117
options ...............................................................117
Save ...................................................................117
MIDI File Chord Interpretation Wizard...........60, 196
MIDI normalize ........................ 123
MIDI Thru ................................ 209
MIDI tracks .............................. 117
MultiStyles ............................... 108
mute tracks................................ 117
Nashville Solos ......................... 175
New features
convert 3/4 to 4/4...............................................275
New Features .............................. 19
new song..................................... 61
Notation .................................... 137
context menu .....................................................139
convert harmony ................................................145
editable notation mode.......................................140
modes.................................................................140
options ...............................................................142
staff roll notation mode......................................141
standard mode....................................................140
standard notation mode......................................139
toolbar................................................................137
note colors ................................ 133
Note Offs .................................. 133
octave........................................ 167
Octaves ..................................... 131
omit lead-in............................... 119
opening styles ............................. 15
output chords ............................ 134
Pan ............................................ 132
Panic Button ............................... 37
panning ..................................... 175
Panther...................................... 256
parameters................................. 177
song ...................................................................116
Part markers................................ 41
303
part settings................................. 32
Part settings .............................. 112
paste chords ................................ 62
patch changes............................ 175
Patches
Allowing ............................................................133
Change at Bar ....................................................101
fill ......................................................................116
higher banks.........................................................33
saving with songs...............................................115
searching..............................................................47
patches popup ............................. 32
Patents .......................................... 2
Pause song ................................ 111
PG Music chords ...................... 104
PG Music Inc............................ 299
piano display............................. 133
play ............................................. 17
play along ................................... 44
Play button................................ 111
Play from .................................. 111
Play from any bar ..................... 111
playing songs .............................. 43
Playing songs............................ 111
Plug-in mode ............................ 126
options ...............................................................128
Plug-in settings ......................... 128
possible substitutions................ 212
PowerTracks Pro ...................... 239
Preferences ............................... 117
more...................................................................121
Preferences 2 ............................ 121
Preview button.......................... 212
preview chords.......................... 101
Printing ..................................... 145
lead sheet ...........................................................147
print options.......................................................148
QuickStart Tutorial ..................... 13
read in chords ........................... 104
RealCharts .................................. 70
RealDrums
how to hear ..........................................................78
RealDrums Picker................. 48, 79
RealStyles ................................. 107
304
RealTracks.................................. 69
3 ways to use .......................................................72
Assign RealTracks...............................................72
auto substitute ......................................................71
folder ...................................................................71
in Band-in-a-Box .................................................72
list ........................................................................20
more.....................................................................77
saving...................................................................77
settings...........................................................50, 69
shots, holds, pushes .............................................93
using in songs ......................................................72
RealTracks Settings .............. 50, 69
recently played styles.................. 40
record melody............................. 65
Recording ................................. 172
step edit..............................................................174
Wizard ...............................................................175
ReFresh Soloist......................... 159
Registration Form ..................... 307
Reharmonist...................... 169, 202
reharmonizing............................................170, 204
re-harmonizing ......................... 209
Rendering audio........................ 180
normalize ...........................................................181
Replay....................................... 111
Replay button............................ 111
Reverb parameters .................... 125
Reverb presets .......................... 126
Reverb Settings......................... 124
Roland RA ................................ 134
root.................................... 102, 213
Save MIDI file .......................... 117
select MIDI file......................... 196
Select Song by Title.................... 43
sequencers................................. 239
settings
song ...................................................................117
shortcut.txt ................................ 130
Shrink ....................................... 128
slash-note.......................... 102, 213
Slide tracks ............................... 129
Smart Notes ........................ 34, 185
solo around melody .................. 157
Soloist
10 steps ..............................................................244
custom solo........................................................157
demo ..................................................................136
phrasing .............................................................243
RealTracks.........................................................155
selecting.............................................................155
slash chords .......................................................158
style ...................................................................155
technical notes ...................................................158
using ..................................................................158
wizard ..........................................................34, 185
Wizard ...............................................................157
Soloist menu ............................. 276
Soloist Preferences ................... 123
solos............................................ 54
Song
entering chords ....................................................13
save settings.......................................................117
saving...................................................................67
song endings option .................... 87
song memo.......................... 67, 130
Song menu ................................ 264
Song settings............................... 85
choruses ...............................................................88
intros....................................................................88
key signature........................................................88
main settings........................................................85
tempo ...................................................................88
SongPicker.................................. 43
Songs
Embelleshment ..................................................266
Embellishment .....................................................87
framing ................................................................17
Intros....................................................................88
loading .................................................................15
Patches
Allowing ........................................................133
save options .......................................................115
saving.................................................................115
Substyles
Changing..........................................................98
Tempo
Change at bar .................................................100
spacing...................................... 177
standard MIDI file .................... 158
status
bar........................................................................32
Status bar .................................... 32
Stop button................................ 112
Stopping songs.......................... 112
Stuck Note .................................. 37
STY button ............................... 100
Style
Changing..............................................................15
Loading................................................................15
Style Change............................. 100
StyleMaker
assignments........................................................237
Bass
Making Patterns.............................................229
Beat Mask..........................................................231
Chord playback..................................................234
Chord Type................................................231, 233
Drum Fill On Substyle.......................................229
Drums
Alternate notes...............................................227
Entering Notes ...............................................227
Late Triplets...................................................229
Making Patterns.............................................226
Screen ............................................................227
Tempo Changes .............................................227
Timebase........................................................227
Editing existing styles........................................224
Embellish Patterns .............................................234
Half Octave Range.............................231, 233, 234
Importing Patterns .............................................238
Interval to Next Chord...............................231, 233
Macro Notes (Bass) ...........................................231
Macro Notes (Piano)..........................................233
Making new styles .............................................226
misc. style settings.......................................75, 218
Overview ...........................................................218
Patch Changes ...................................................235
Pattern
Weight of 9 ....................................................225
Patterns
Erasing...........................................................223
305
Lengths ..........................................................222
Piano,Guitar,Strings...........................................231
Playback Bar Mask............................228, 230, 232
Playback Beat Mask ..........................................233
Pushed Patterns..................................................231
Pushing Patterns ................................................235
RealDrums in styles...........................................219
RealTracks in styles.....................................75, 220
Relative Weight .................................228, 230, 232
Roman Numeral Mask...............................231, 233
Selecting a Style to Edit.....................................224
Soloists in styles ................................................220
styles with RealTracks.................................76, 220
Time Signatures.........................................223, 224
timing offset.................................................76, 221
Transpose Down Limits.....................................234
Voice Leading ...................................................234
Riff based.......................................................234
Smooth...........................................................234
volume offset ...............................................76, 221
StylePicker.............. 15, 46, 63, 106
asterisk symbol ..................................................109
caret symbol.......................................................109
choosing styles...................................................109
MultiStyles ........................................................108
prototype............................................................107
RealStyles ..........................................................107
rebuild list..........................................................109
styles with RealDrums.......................................108
styles with RealTracks.......................................107
third party styles ................................................110
Styles
about ....................................................................15
aliases ................................................................110
applying .............................................................104
filter ...................................................................107
LS3 files.............................................................110
selecting.............................................................106
Styles with RealDrums ............. 108
Styles with RealTracks ............. 107
306
substitutions.............................. 210
SubStyles
Changing..............................................................98
System requirements..................... 7
Technical Support..................... 299
tempo .......................................... 17
Tempo......................................... 65
Change at bar.....................................................100
tap ........................................................................65
Thru harmony ............................. 45
Thru part ..................................... 44
Thru velocity boost................... 134
Ticks ......................................... 176
Title window............................... 38
Tone control.............................. 112
Toolbars
main .....................................................................35
track type .................................. 175
Trademarks ................................... 2
Transport Controls...................... 36
tritone substitution .................... 209
turns .......................................... 167
Tutorial
CoreMIDI and QuickTime ................................253
Unfold....................................... 129
User Settings............................. 117
vibrato....................................... 168
voicings ............................ 209, 239
Volume
Allowing Changes .............................................133
Changes .............................................................112
window title ................................ 32
Windows menu ......................... 291
Wizard ................................ 34, 185
instrument ....................................................34, 185
playing .........................................................34, 185
recording......................................................34, 186
smart notes...................................................34, 185
Wizard play along....................... 54
Registration Form
Please register your program. Registering your PG Music software entitles you to free, unlimited technical support,
advance notice of product upgrades, and news about new product releases. If you haven't registered your PG Music
software yet, please take a few moments and do so now.
How to Register
Mail to PG Music Inc., 29 Cadillac Avenue, Victoria, BC V8Z 1T3, Canada
Fax to 1-250-475-2937 or toll-free to 1-877-475-1444.
On-line at www.pgmusic.com
Telephone 1-250-475-2874, toll-free in North America at 1-800-268-6272, or toll-free at
+ 800-4746-8742 with Universal International Freephone Service access.
Name ________________________________________________________________________________________
Address ______________________________________________________________________________________
City _________________________________________________________________________________________
State/Province ________________________________________________________________________________
Zip/Postal Code _______________________________________________________________________________
Country ______________________________________________________________________________________
Telephone ______________________________________ Fax __________________________________________
E-mail address ________________________________________________________________________________
Computer (check):
PC
MAC
Model ___________________________________________________
Operating system (e.g. Windows XP, Vista; Macintosh OS X) __________________________________________
What MIDI interface are you using? ________________________________________________________________
What primary synth/sound card do you use? _________________________________________________________
Favorite Styles: Jazz ___ Rock ___ Pop ___ Country ___ Other __________________________________________
Purchased from _______________________________________________________________________________
Date of purchase _______________________________________________________________________________
Comments/Suggestions__________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
Registration Form
307

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement